Owner’s manual
QUATTROPORTE
Owner's Manual
Dear Customer,
Thank you for choosing a Maserati.
This vehicle represents the result of Maserati's great experience in the design and production of sports, touring and
racing vehicles.
The purpose of this manual is to provide an understanding of the equipment, systems and controls of the vehicle and
how they work.
With this manual you will acquaint yourself with the equipment and options of your Maserati in order to take advantage
of its full potential.
Before driving your vehicle for the first time we suggest reviewing the Quick Guide in order to become familiar with the
commands and functions of your Quattroporte. The Owner's Manual, the Maserati Touch Control and the Rear Seat
Entertainment (optional equipment) guide can also be viewed via DVD directly from the display screen or PC. In
additional to these, on the DVD you can find the “Other Documentation” folder with a pdf copy of the certifications and
other documents.
In a dedicated section of this manual you will also find instructions for basic maintenance procedures, in order to ensure
optimal levels of performance, quality and safe driving.
Keep in mind that proper maintenance is an essential factor to help preserve the value of the vehicle over time and
protect the environment.
For “Scheduled Maintenance” or any other questions, please contact your Authorized Maserati Dealer: Our trained
technical staff is constantly providing the latest updates in order to ensure your vehicle is serviced properly.
The Quick guide and DVD are integral parts of the vehicle and should always be kept on board.
If you are the first owner of this vehicle, you can require a printed copy of the documents available on the DVD directly
at an Authorized Maserati Dealer.
Maserati is committed to protecting the environment and natural resources; which is why we chose to develop Owner’s
documentation in digital format instead of printing paper, thus reducing consumption of materials deriving from wood.
2
3
4
Introduction
1
Before Starting
2
Understanding the Vehicle
3
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
4
Driving
5
In an Emergency
6
Maintenance and Care
7
Features and Specifications
8
Index
9
5
6
1 – Introduction
Consulting the Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Abbreviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Updating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Service and Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Suggestions for Obtaining Service for Your Vehicle. . . . 10
If You Need Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Warranty Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Parts Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Aftermarket Parts & Accessories Statement
Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
11
12
13
13
14
Warnings when driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Maserati Roadside Assistance Program
(available for USA and Canada only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Vehicle Identification Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
7
Introduction
Consulting the Manual
1
This Owner's Manual illustrates
maintenance and useful information
related to V8 motorization model,
indicated as (V8 Engine), and V6
motorization model, indicated as (V6
Engine). If not otherwise specified, the
information is valid for both models.
For an easy identification of the topics,
this Manual is divided into sections.
Within the text, important warnings
and notes are easily identified through
icons.
WARNING!
Failure to comply with the instructions
could cause HAZARDOUS SITUATIONS
involving personal and vehicle safety.
ENVIRONMENTAL!
This note indicates the best practices
when using the vehicle to protect the
environment.
8
Abbreviations
CAUTION!
Aimed at preventing any damage to
the vehicle and thus hazards involving
the safety of people.
Some descriptions and terms with
particular meanings are found in this
manual in abbreviated form.
A/C
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM.
NOTE:
ABS
Additional information regarding the
subject and/or the operation
described.
ANTI-LOCK BRAKING
SYSTEM.
ALR
AUTOMATIC LOCKING
RETRACTOR.
ATC
AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE
CONTROL.
AWD
ALL-WHEEL DRIVE.
BAS
BRAKE ASSIST SYSTEM.
CAN
CONTROLLER AREA
NETWORK.
DRL
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHTS.
EBD
ELECTRONIC BRAKE-FORCE
DISTRIBUTION.
ECU
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT.
EDR
EVENT DATA RECORDER.
EPB
ELECTRIC PARKING BRAKE.
ESC
ELECTRONIC STABILITY
CONTROL.
ETC
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE
CONTROL.
HSA
HILL START ASSIST.
• “Left” and “right” in this manual,
always refer to the driving direction.
• All indications and images in this
Manual refer to a vehicle with
left-hand drive. On right-hand drive
vehicles, some controls are built
differently than shown in the
illustrations.
• If not otherwise specified, the
instrument cluster shown in the
images belongs to the V8 model –
however the indications given are
also valid on V6 model.
Introduction
HBA
HYDRAULIC BRAKE
ASSISTANCE.
ICE
INCREASE CONTROL
EFFICIENCY.
LATCH
LOWER ANCHORS AND
TETHER FOR CHILDREN.
MIL
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR
LIGHT.
MTC
MASERATI TOUCH
CONTROL.
OBD
ON BOARD DIAGNOSTICS.
RAB
READY ALERT BRAKING.
RBS
RAIN BRAKE SUPPORT.
RKE
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY.
RWD
REAR-WHEEL DRIVE.
SRS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT
SYSTEM.
TCS
TRACTION CONTROL
SYSTEM.
TFT
THIN FILM TRANSISTOR.
TPMS
TIRE PRESSURE
MONITORING SYSTEM.
VIN
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION
NUMBER.
Updating
Service and Warranty
Constant improvements are being
performed to maintain this vehicle's
high level of quality. Therefore, there
may be differences between this
manual and your vehicle.
Maserati reserves the right to carry
out design and functional changes
and to provide updates or
improvements.
This Owner's Manual illustrates and
describes all versions of the current
vehicle model. Therefore, some of the
equipment and accessories in this
publication may not appear on your
vehicle; please only consider the
information related to your vehicle.
All specifications and illustrations
contained in this manual are as of the
Manual publishing date.
The information provided in this
manual is limited to instructions and
indications that are strictly required
for vehicle use and proper
maintenance.
By following these instructions
carefully, the vehicle will meet the
owner's satisfaction and best results.
We advise to have all service and
inspections completed only by an
Authorized Maserati Dealer, where
you will find a specially trained staff
and the proper equipment to repair
your vehicle.
Please visit the www.maserati.com to
find the nearest Authorized Maserati
Dealer.
All features and accessories installed
on the vehicle have been designed by
Maserati engineers and have
successfully passed rigorous tests,
submitted in all conditions of use.
Installing aftermarket components or
accessories not approved by Maserati
may interfere with the vehicle
electronics and compromise driving
safety, voiding the warranty coverage.
Nor do the warranties cover the costs
of repairing damage or conditions
caused by any changes to your vehicle
NOTE:
The updated version of the on-board
documentation can also be consulted
by accessing the section “SERVICES”
on the website www.maserati.com or
by using the specific apps developed
for the more common Tablet and
Smartphone.
1
9
Introduction
1
that do not comply with Maserati’s
specifications.
An Authorized Maserati Dealer is at
your complete disposal for any
information and questions you may
have.
WARNING!
CALIFORNIA proposition 65.
Engine exhaust, some of its
constituents, and certain vehicle
components contain or emit chemicals
known to the state of California to
cause cancer, and birth defects or
other reproductive harm. In addition,
certain fluids contained in vehicles and
certain products of component wear
contain or emit chemicals known to
the State of California to cause cancer,
and birth defects or other
reproductive harm.
Suggestions for Obtaining
Service for Your Vehicle
Prepare for the Appointment
If warranty work is required, be sure to
have the right papers with you and
take your warranty folder. Not all work
being performed may be covered by
the warranty: therefore discuss
additional charges with the service
manager. It is advisable to keep a
maintenance log of your vehicle’s
service history, as this can often
provide a clue to the current problem.
Prepare a List
Make a written list of your vehicle’s
problems or the specific work you wish
to be performed. If the vehicle has had
an accident or work done that is not
indicated on the maintenance log,
please communicate this to the service
advisor.
Optimize the Requests
If there are a number of items needing
attention, it is advisable to discuss this
with your service advisor to agree on
the order of priorities.
At many Authorized Dealers/Service
Centers, it is possible to obtain a
loaner vehicle or a rental vehicle at a
10
minimal daily charge. If you need a
rental vehicle, it is advisable to make
these arrangements prior to the visit,
for example when you call to set the
appointment.
Introduction
If You Need Assistance
The manufacturer/Maserati and its
Authorized Dealers/Service Network
set highest priority to the client’s
satisfaction with the products and
services.
Warranty service must be performed
by an Authorized Maserati
Dealer/Service Center.
Should there be any issues, please
keep in mind that most matters can be
resolved with the following process.
Contact:
MASERATI North America, Inc.
250 Sylvan Avenue
Englewood Cliffs
NJ 07632
Phone: (201) 816–2600
Warranty Information
Please refer to the Warranty booklet,
included in the Owner’s
documentation kit and on the DVD,
for the terms and provisions of
Maserati warranties applicable to this
vehicle and market.
1
• If for some reason you are still not
satisfied, please contact the general
manager or owner of the Service
Center, it is their responsibility to
assist you.
• If a Service Center is unable to
resolve the issue, you may contact
Maserati Customer Center.
Any communication to the Maserati
Consumer Affairs should include the
following information:
• Owner’s name and address.
• Owner’s telephone number (home
and office).
• Maserati Service Center name.
• Vehicle Identification Number (VIN).
• Vehicle delivery date and mileage.
11
Introduction
1
Reporting Safety Defects
in addition to notifying Maserati North
America, Inc.
NHTSA’s Toll-free Auto Safety
Hotline
Transport Canada can be contacted at:
1-800-333-0510
Teletypewriter (TTY): 613 990-4500
Fax: 1-819-994-3372
Mailing Address: Transport Canada Road Safety, 80 rue Noël, Gatineau,
(Quebec) J8Z 0A1.
If you believe that your vehicle has a
defect which could cause a crash,
injury or death, immediately inform
the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to
notifying Maserati North America, Inc.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it
may open an investigation, and if it
finds that a safety defect exists in a
group of vehicles, it may order a recall
and remedy campaign. However,
NHTSA cannot become involved in
individual problems between you, your
dealer, or Maserati North America, Inc.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the
Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at
1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153),
go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write
to: Administrator, NHTSA, Washington,
D.C. 20590. You can also obtain other
information about motor vehicle
safety from http://www.safercar.gov.
Reporting safety defects in Canada
If you believe your vehicle has a defect
that could cause a crash or could cause
injury or death, you should
immediately inform Transport Canada
12
In Canada
If you believe that your vehicle has a
safety defect, contact the Customer
Service Department immediately.
Canadian customers who wish to
report a safety defect to the Canadian
government should contact Transport
Canada, Motor Vehicle Defect
Investigations and Recalls at
1-800-333-0510 or go to
http://www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety/
Introduction
Parts Service
Genuine parts keep the reliability,
comfort and performance of your new
car unchanged throughout its life.
For service and scheduled
maintenance Maserati suggests
requesting genuine parts since they
are the result of constant research,
development, and reliability.
For the above mentioned reasons and
because they are specifically designed
for this vehicle, rely on genuine parts.
Always ask for genuine parts and
make sure they are used for all
services.
Aftermarket Parts &
Accessories Statement
Modification of the vehicle or
installation of any accessory or
components attached to the vehicle
which alters the original engineering
and/or vehicle operating
specifications, or which result in
damage to the other original
components, electrical interference,
electrical short(s), radio static, water
leaks and wind noise may result in
damage to genuine components,
compromise the safety of the vehicle
and affect the validity of the new car
warranty on the vehicle.
Non-genuine Maserati Parts
Non-genuine Maserati Parts (while
you may elect to use non-genuine
Maserati parts for maintenance or
repair services), Maserati North
America, Inc. is not obligated to pay
for repairs that include non-genuine
Maserati parts or for any damage
resulting from the use of non-genuine
parts.
Maserati will not accept any liability
for any parts and accessories not
approved by Maserati, including
Dealer-installed accessories not
distributed by Maserati North
America, Inc.
1
13
Introduction
Symbols
1
There are specific colored plates on or
near some of the components on your
Maserati designed to attract user’s
attention. Important warnings
concerning all specific devices that the
user must consider, are reported on
the internal lid cover central label (see
“Vehicle Identification Data” in this
section).
All symbols reported on the plate and
inside the vehicle, as well as the
component for which the symbols
stand, are summarized in the
following list. These symbols are
divided into categories according to
their meaning.
Danger Symbols
Battery
Corrosive liquid.
Battery
Explosion.
Blower
May start automatically
even with engine off.
14
Coolant expansion
reservoir
Do not open cap with
engine warm.
Coil - headlights
High voltage.
Belts and pulleys
Moving parts, keep body
and clothing clear.
Air-conditioning lines
High pressure gas, do not
open.
Symbols of Prohibitions and
Compulsory Measures
Battery
Keep away from flames.
Battery
Keep out of children’s
reach.
Heat guards - belts pulleys - fans
Do not touch.
Battery
Wear eye protection.
Battery - jack
Refer to the owner manual.
Warning Symbols
Engine - Engine Oil Filler
Cap
Engine oil. We recommend
using an oil with the
characteristics indicated in
chapter “Refillings” in
Section 8.
Hydraulic steering reservoir
Power steering fluid. Do
not exceed max. level. We
recommend using a liquid
with the characteristics
indicated in chapter
“Refillings” in Section 8.
Brake fluid reservoir
Brake fluid type DOT 4. Do
not exceed max. level. We
recommend using a fluid
with the characteristics
indicated in chapter
“Refillings” in Section 8.
Introduction
Radiator coolant expansion
reservoir
Use antifreeze liquid for
radiators. We recommend
using a liquid with the
characteristics indicated in
chapter “Refillings” in
Section 8.
Windshield washer fluid
reservoir
Windshield washer. We
recommend using a liquid
with the characteristics
indicated in chapter
“Refillings” in Section 8.
Warnings when driving
Always comply with local traffic
regulations wherever you drive.
Failure to operate this vehicle correctly
may result in loss of control or a
collision.
Operating this vehicle at excessive
speed or in an altered state or while
intoxicated may result in loss of
control, going off the road, or
overturning. In all these situations a
collision with other vehicles or objects
is more likely to happen with the risk
to cause an accident that may lead to
serious injury.
In case of an accident, failure to use
seat belts causes the driver and
passengers a greater risk of injury or
death. Use your seat belt at all times.
This Owner's Manual contains
warnings against operating
procedures that could result in a
collision, injury or damage to the
environment. It also contains cautions
against procedures that could damage
the vehicle.
Important information may be missed
for not reading this manual in its
entirely. Carefully consider all
warnings and cautions.
WARNING!
• It is the driver’s responsibility to
operate the vehicle in a safe way: if
you are distracted while driving you
can lose control and cause serious
accidents.
1
• Maserati strongly recommends you
use particular care when operating
the features and tools that may
distract you.
• Mobile phones, PC, portable audio
device or other features operated
while the vehicle is moving can be
very dangerous and can cause
serious accidents.
• It is very dangerous to send text
messages while driving; do so only
when the vehicle is not moving.
• In some Countries the use of mobile
phone when driving is forbidden: it
is the driver’s sole responsibility to
respect local regulations.
15
Introduction
1
Maserati Roadside
Assistance Program
(available for USA and
Canada only)
Welcome to Maserati and the benefits
and security of the Maserati Roadside
Assistance Program. Please take a
moment to review the benefits listed
below and available to you through
the Maserati Roadside Assistance
Program.
Emergency Roadside Services
In the event you require Roadside
Assistance, please call 1-888-371-1802,
24 hours a day, 365 days a year. You
will be connected with a Roadside
Assistance representative who will
dispatch a local towing vendor.
Information needed for when
you call
When you call, please be prepared to
provide the following information:
• Your Name.
• Vehicle Identification Number (VIN).
• Location of your vehicle.
• Nature of your call (for example; you
require a tow, vehicle will not start,
out of gas, tire service, etc.).
16
Summary of Program Benefits
and Services
• Towing of a disabled registered
Maserati vehicle. In the event a
registered vehicle becomes disabled
in connection to a warranty related
concern it will be transported to the
nearest Authorized Maserati
Dealership. You may request that the
vehicle be taken to a different
Authorized Maserati Dealer, as long
as it is no more than 50 miles further
away from the nearest authorized
dealer (one tow per disablement).
• Battery jump start.
• Flat tire change providing the vehicle
is equipped with a spare tire.
• Fuel delivery (up to 2 gallons).
• Lockout Services.
• Rental Car allowance: in the event
your vehicle is disabled due to a
warranty related concern, we will
reimburse you up to $50 per day. A
five (5) day or $250 maximum
applies. In order to receive
reimbursement, you must supply the
following information within 20 days
of the rental car transaction to the
address listed below; the original
pre-printed rental car receipt, which
must include your name, address,
telephone number, VIN, rental dates
and the corresponding warranty
repair order.
Maserati Roadside Assistance ATTN:
Maserati Rental Car Claims Dept.
P.O. Box 8140 Ft.
Washington, PA 19034
NOTE:
An authorized licensed driver must be
driving at the time of the disablement.
Items excluded from coverage:
• Parts, labor, tire repair, rental of
towing equipment, storage fees, or
any labor performed at the service
facility.
• Any form of impound towing, or
towing by someone other than a
licensed service station or garage.
• Assistance from a private citizen.
Introduction
NOTE:
Membership is intended to cover
emergencies and is not intended to be
a substitute for proper vehicle
maintenance or repair. Repeated calls
which are considered by Maserati
North America, Inc. Signature Motor
Club, Inc. or Signature Motor Club of
California, Inc. to be excessive may, at
our discretion, result in cancellation of
the membership.
Emergency road service providers are
independent contractors and are not
employees, agents or representatives
of Maserati North America, Inc.
Signature Motor Club, Inc. or
Signature Motor Club of California,
Inc.
• NEW VEHICLES: Your membership
begins on the date the Registered
Vehicle was originally sold (in service
date) and continues until the
expiration date of the New Car
Limited Warranty or unless
terminated by Maserati North
America, Inc. for cause.
• PRE OWNED VEHICLES: Your
membership begins on the date the
registered vehicle was sold (in service
date) and continues until the
expiration date of the Maserati
Certified Pre-Owned Limited
Warranty or unless terminated by
Maserati North America, Inc for
cause.
Address Inquiries to
General Inquiries:
Maserati Roadside Assistance
P.O. Box 968008
Schaumburg, IL 60173
1
Rental Car Reimbursements:
Within 20 days of your rental car
transaction, the original pre-printed
rental car receipt, which must include
your name, address, telephone
number, VIN, rental dates and the
corresponding warranty repair order
should be submitted to:
Maserati Roadside Assistance ATTN:
Maserati Rental Car Claims Dept.
P.O. Box 8140
Ft. Washington, PA 19034
Under this Agreement
• You will not be required to pay any
sum for services up to the mileage
limit on towing.
• Your registered Maserati vehicle is
the vehicle covered. The Vehicle
Identification Number (VIN) that
appears on the vehicle represents
your identification number with
Signature Motor Club, Inc. or
Signature Motor Club of California,
Inc.
17
Introduction
1
Vehicle Identification Data
Labels
Vehicle Identification Number
Overview label with cautions and
warning notes
The vehicle's identification number
(VIN) is punched on the foot platform,
in front of the passenger front seat.
The centrally attached label placed
inside the engine lid cover displays
cautions, warnings, and symbols.
For further information refer to
“Symbols” in this section.
NOTE:
When ordering spare parts or making
inquiries, always note the vehicle
identification number.
To read the number, lift the mat and
slide the guard.
The VIN Number is also visible from
the outside through the windshield on
the front left corner of the dashboard.
18
Introduction
Passenger Air bag Labels
The labels are applied on the external
side of passenger's sun visor and
behind it, on the dome.
Vehicle Emission Control Information
Label
This label applied on the lower right
side of the engine compartment lid
shows the Vehicle Emission Control
Information (VECI).
Tire and Loading Information Label
This paper label is applied on the
driver's side rear door pillar.
1
NOTE:
Vehicle Homologation Label
This label applied on the driver's side
rear door pillar attests the compliance
with safety standards.
Paint Identification Label
This label is applied onto the trunk lid.
For further informations see “Tire
Safety Information” in section 5.
Fuel Warning Label
The label is applied inside the fuel
filler door.
19
Introduction
20
2 – Before Starting
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Sentry Key Immobilizer System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Vehicle Security Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Illuminated Entry/Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Unlock Power Doors and Trunk Lid with Key fob . . . . . 32
Requiring and Setting Additional Key fobs . . . . . . . . . 33
Remote Start System (optional) . . . . . . . . . . .
Doors Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Passive Entry System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power Sunshades on the Rear Door Windows
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
36
38
40
43
46
Rear Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Trunk Compartment Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Trunk Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Lid Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Occupant Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) — Air bags
Child Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
51
51
52
60
67
72
ParkSense Park Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
ParkView Rear View Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Safety Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
21
Before Starting
2
Keys
Keyless Ignition Device
This vehicle is equipped with a Remote
Keyless Entry transmitter and a Keyless
Ignition Node, to enter, start and
protect the vehicle.
This device allows the driver to
operate the ignition switch with the
push of a button, as long as the
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter
is inside the vehicle.
The Keyless Ignition Node (KIN) has
three operating setups indicated on
the outer ring. Pressing and releasing
the middle button, allows the driver to
switch from one setup to the next
without starting the engine, the
“switched on” indication will turn
amber.
The engine will start by pushing the
center button START/STOP with the
brake pedal pressed and the device set
in any of the three operating setups.
22
In case the ignition switch does not
change by pushing the button, the
RKE transmitter (key fob) may have a
low or discharged battery. If this occurs
it is necessary to replace the battery in
order to operate the ignition switch
(see “Requiring and Setting Additional
Key fobs” in this section).
Before Starting
It is possible to operate the ignition
device using the key fob RKE
transmitter with discharged battery by
pressing the nose side (side opposite
of the emergency key) of the key fob
on the START/STOP button.
Key fob
This vehicle is provided with two
programmed key fobs.
The key fob contains a Remote Keyless
Entry (RKE) transmitter and an
emergency key that is inserted in to
the remote.
The emergency key allows you to
open the vehicle by inserting into the
lock of the opening handle on the
driver's door, in case the battery of the
vehicle or the key fob go dead.
You can keep the emergency when
using valet parking.
To remove the emergency key:
• hold the mechanical latch on the
back of the key fob sideways;
• simultaneously remove the
emergency key by sliding laterally
towards the end of the remote
control.
Shift Ignition Device to OFF
Alert
Opening the driver's door to exit the
vehicle when the ignition device is set
in ACC or RUN (engine not running), a
beep will remind you to cycle the
ignition to OFF.
The audio sound is followed by a
dedicated message displayed on the
instrument cluster.
With the MTC System, the power
window switches, radio, power
sunroof, and power outlets will
remain active for up to 10 minutes
after the ignition switch is cycled to
the OFF position. Opening either front
door will cancel this feature, it is
possible to set the timing of this
feature.
NOTE:
NOTE:
You can insert either side of the
emergency key into the lock cylinder.
Refer to “MTC Settings” in Section 4
for further information.
2
WARNING!
• When leaving the vehicle, always
remove the key fob and lock your
vehicle.
(Continued)
23
Before Starting
(Continued)
• Never leave children alone in a
vehicle, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle.
2
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle
unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others
could be seriously or fatally injured.
Children should be warned not to
touch the parking brake switch,
brake pedal or the shift lever,
causing the vehicle to roll away.
• Do not leave the key fob in or near
the vehicle, and do not leave the
ignition switch in the ACC or RUN
mode. A child could operate power
windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
• Do not leave children or animals
inside parked vehicles in hot
weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury or death.
• An unlocked car is an invitation to
thieves. Always remove the key fob
from vehicle, cycle the ignition
switch to OFF and lock all doors
when leaving the vehicle
unattended.
24
Sentry Key® Immobilizer
System
The Sentry Key® Immobilizer System
prevents unauthorized vehicle
operation by disabling the engine. The
system does not need to be armed or
activated. Operation is automatic,
regardless of whether the vehicle is
locked or unlocked.
The system uses a key fob with Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, an
ignition switch and a RF (Radio
Frequency) receiver to prevent
unauthorized vehicle operation.
Therefore, only key fobs expressly
programmed can be used to start and
operate the vehicle.
After placing the ignition in the RUN
position, the Vehicle Security Light (see
picture) will light up for a three second
bulb check.
If the light remains on after the bulb
check, it indicates that there is a
problem with the electronics: this
condition will result in the engine
being shut off after two seconds.
If the Vehicle Security Light turns on
during normal vehicle operation
(engine running for longer than 10
seconds), an electronic fault is
detected. Should this occur, contact an
Authorized Maserati Dealer as soon as
possible for assistance.
CAUTION!
The Sentry Key® Immobilizer system is
not compatible with some remote
starting systems that can be installed
in after-market.
Use of remote starting systems may
result in vehicle starting problems and
loss of security protection.
All key fobs provided with the new
vehicle have been updated with the
vehicle electronics and are therefore
able to guarantee correct functioning
and protection.
Before Starting
General Information
Replacement Key fobs
This device complies with Part 15 of
the FCC rules and RSS 210 of Industry
Canada.
Operation is subject to the following
conditions:
NOTE:
• This device may not cause harmful
interference.
• This device must accept any
interference that may be received,
including interference that may
cause undesired operation.
Only key fobs that are updated with
the vehicle electronics can be used to
start and operate the vehicle. Once a
key fob is programmed to a vehicle, it
cannot be programmed to any other
vehicle.
NOTE:
• When having the Sentry Key®
Immobilizer System serviced, bring
all key fobs provided with the
vehicle with you to the Maserati
Service Center.
• When selling the vehicle, it is
necessary to provide the new owner
with all key fobs.
2
WARNING!
• Always remove the key fobs from
the vehicle and lock all doors when
leaving the vehicle unattended.
• Always remember to cycle the
ignition switch to OFF.
Duplication of key fobs may be
performed by an Authorized Maserati
Dealer only.
This procedure consists of
programming a key fob that has never
been programmed to the vehicle’s
electronics.
25
Before Starting
Arming the System
Vehicle Security Alarm
2
26
The vehicle security alarm monitors the
vehicle doors and trunk lid for
unauthorized entry and the
START/STOP button for unauthorized
operations.
The system also includes a dual
function anti-intrusion sensor and
vehicle anti-lift sensor. The
anti-intrusion sensor monitors the
vehicle interior for motion. The vehicle
anti-lift sensor monitors the vehicle for
any lifting or tilting actions (tow away,
tire removal, ferry transport, etc). A
siren with battery backup which senses
interruptions of power and
communications is also included.
While the vehicle security alarm is
enabled, interior door locks switches,
trunk lid and fuel filler door release
are disabled. If something triggers the
alarm, the vehicle security alarm will
provide the following audible and
visible signals: intermittent buzzer,
park lights and/or turn signals and the
vehicle security light on the dashboard
will flash.
This light will fast flash for
approximately 15 seconds, when the
vehicle security alarm is being armed,
and will then flash slowly until the
vehicle is disarmed.
Follow these steps to arm the vehicle
security alarm.
• Make sure the vehicle ignition switch
is OFF.
• Perform one of the following
methods to lock the vehicle:
Rearming the System
If something triggers the security
alarm, and no quick action is taken to
disarm it, the vehicle security alarm
will turn off the beeper after 29
seconds, and turn off all of the visual
signals after 31 more seconds; the
vehicle security alarm will then rearm
itself.
• Press the lock button on the
interior power door lock switch
located on the driver door trim
panel with the driver and/or
passenger door open.
Before Starting
To disarm the System
Use any of the following steps to
disarm the vehicle security alarm.
• Press the button on the exterior
Passive Entry door handle having a
valid key fob RKE transmitter in
the same exterior zone (see
“Passive Entry System” in this
section for further information).
• Press the lock button on the key
fob RKE transmitter.
• If any door is open, close it.
In any of these situations, if one or
more windows are open, will remain
open. To close the windows press
again the lock button and hold it
until their closure.
Each time the vehicle security alarm is
armed, the anti-intrusion and anti-lift
sensors actively monitor the vehicle.
When arming the security alarm, it is
possible to disable these sensors by
pressing the button on the remote
control three times within 5 seconds
from the moment the system has been
armed (meanwhile the security alarm
telltale flashes rapidly).
• Press the button on key fob RKE
transmitter.
• Grasp the Passive Entry unlock door
handle (see “Passive Entry System” in
this section for further information).
• Press the START/STOP button so as
to release the OFF position.
2
NOTE:
When the vehicle security alarm is
armed, the interior power door lock
switch will not allow unlocking of the
doors.
The vehicle security alarm is designed
to protect your vehicle; however, you
can create conditions where the
system will give you a false alarm. If
one of the previously described
arming sequences has occurred, the
vehicle security alarm will arm
regardless of whether you are in the
vehicle or not. If you remain in the
vehicle and open a door, the alarm
will activate. If this occurs, disarm the
vehicle security alarm.
If the vehicle security alarm is armed
and the battery becomes
disconnected, the vehicle security
27
Before Starting
Illuminated Entry/Exit
alarm will remain armed when the
battery is reconnected; the exterior
lights will flash, the buzzer will
activate. If this occurs, disarm the
vehicle security alarm.
2
Using the Panic Alarm
To turn the panic alarm feature on or
off, press and hold the
button on
the key fob RKE transmitter for at least
one second and release. When the
panic alarm is on, the headlights will
turn on, the park lights will flash, the
horn will pulse on and off, and the
courtesy & dimmable lights will turn
on.
The panic alarm will remain activated
for three minutes unless you turn it off
by either:
• pressing the
button a second
time;
• or drive the vehicle at a speed of
5 mph (8 km/h) or faster.
In both situations the panic alarm will
immediately turn off.
28
Lights will turn on and off when you
enter/exit the vehicle and operate the
buttons on the key fob RKE
transmitter and/or on the Passive Entry
system as follows:
Tamper Alert
If something has triggered the vehicle
security alarm in your absence, the
horn will sound three times when you
disarm the vehicle security alarm.
Check the vehicle for tampering.
• If the lock command is enabled by
pressing the specific button on the
key fob RKE transmitter or by the
Passive Entry system, the
“illuminated entry” mode will
activate. Courtesy & dimmable
internal lighting, night front seats
lighting, and approach lighting will
stay on for 27 seconds.
Before Starting
• If the lock command of the car is
enabled by pressing the specific
button on the key fob RKE
transmitter or by the Passive Entry
system, when the key fob RKE
transmitter is moved out of range,
all the lights will turn off within 3
seconds, if they were previously on.
2
• If the trunk lid command is enabled
by the specific
button on the key
fob RKE transmitter or by the Passive
Entry system, when pressing the
trunk lid external button in between
the license plate lights, the inner
trunk light will turn on and will stay
on for 10 minutes before turning off.
Light will immediately turn off when
closing the lid.
29
Before Starting
2
• If the
button is pressed on the
key fob RKE transmitter, the
headlights, park lights and the
courtesy & dimmable lights will turn
on. Refer to “Using the Panic Alarm”
in this section for further
information.
30
Before Starting
Vehicle Lighting with
Open/Closed Doors
Vehicle Headlight Switch
Function
• If one or more doors are open, the
central light, front/rear domelights
(main and spot light), the instrument
panel, the MTC display and the night
front seats lighting and the ignition
switch backlight will turn on and
remain lit for 27 seconds.
• If the doors are closed, all lights will
turn off (within 3 seconds) with the
exception of the console display and
the ignition switch backlight, which
will turn off after 27 seconds.
Vehicle lighting can be operated from
the key fob RKE transmitter, the
Passive Entry system and from the
headlight switch on the left side of
the dashboard (refer to “Lights” in
section 3 for further information).
• If the headlight switch is in the “0”
(OFF) mode all switch backlights and
the front seat lighting will turn off.
• If the headlight switch is in the
position (Park mode) and the
ignition switch is in OFF or ACC
position, only the front low intensity
LEDs of the external headlight will
turn on.
• If the headlight switch is in
position (Park mode) and the
ignition switch is in RUN position, no
lighting feature will be available.
• If the headlight switch is in
position (Low beam mode) the
front domelight LED (if enabled), the
switch backlights, the instrument
panel’s display and the night front
seats lighting will turn on. The front
domelight LED and the night
lighting of the front seats will light
up with the intensity set by the
right-hand regulator. If the regulator
is to "0" (OFF) position, the night
lighting will turn off.
• If the headlight is switched to
“AUTO” position (on/off AUTO
mode) and the ignition is switched
to RUN position, as in “low beam
mode”, all lights turn on either in
“DAY” or “NIGHT” mode according
to the twilight sensor. In “DAY”
2
31
Before Starting
mode the switch backlights will be at
100% intensity, in “NIGHT” mode
they will be as set by the left dimmer
control switch.
2
NOTE:
In “DAY” mode, the switches are not
backlit, except the windows and
steering switches.
Light Dimmer Controls
The light dimmer controls are part of
the headlight switch and are
positioned beside the switch itself (see
“Lights” in section 3 for further
information).
Unlock Power Doors and
Trunk Lid with Key fob
The RKE system allows you to lock or
unlock the doors and the fuel filler
door, open the trunk, turn the
approach and courtesy lights on from
a distance up to approximately 33 ft
(10 m). The key fob RKE transmitter
does not need to be pointed at the
vehicle to activate the system. See
“Illuminated Entry/Exit” in this section
for further information.
Press and release the unlock button
on the key fob RKE transmitter once
to unlock the driver's door or twice
within five seconds to unlock all doors
and the fuel filler door. The turn signal
lights will flash for the unlock signal
recognition. The illuminated entry/exit
system will also turn on. See “Passive
Entry System” in this section for
further information.
Unlock Driver Door/All Doors with
Remote Key 1st Press
This feature allows you to program the
system to unlock either the driver's
door or all doors and the fuel filler
door by the first press of the unlock
button on the key fob RKE
transmitter. To change the current
setting, see “MTC Settings” in section
4.
NOTE:
Driving at speeds 5 mph (8 km/h) and
above disables the system from
responding to all key fobs RKE
transmitter buttons.
32
Unlock the Doors and Fuel Filler
Door
Lock/Unlock Doors Flash Lights
This feature will cause a flash of the
turn signal lights when the doors are
locked or unlocked with the key fob
RKE transmitter. This feature can be
turned on or off. To change the
current setting, see “MTC Settings” in
section 4.
Before Starting
Turn Headlights On with Remote key
This feature activates the headlights
for up to 90 seconds when the doors
are unlocked with the key fob RKE
transmitter. The duration can be set as
desired. To change the current setting,
see “MTC Settings” in section 4.
Locking Doors and Fuel Filler
Door
Press and release the lock button on
the key fob RKE transmitter to lock all
doors and the fuel filler door. The turn
signal lights will flash for signal
recognition.
Refer to “Passive Entry System” in this
section for further information.
Locking Doors Sound Alarm
This feature will cause the alarm to
activate when the doors are locked
with the key fob RKE transmitter. This
feature can be enabled or disabled. To
change the current setting, see “MTC
Settings” in section 4.
Steering Lock (for
versions/markets, where
provided)
The vehicle can be equipped with an
electric steering lock that is
automatically activated when the
ignition device is switched to OFF. To
check activation, turn the steering
wheel until it stops.
When the ignition device is switched
to RUN, the steering lock
automatically deactivates
Requiring and Setting
Additional Key fobs
Provide your Authorized Maserati
Dealer the following when ordering
additional key fob RKE transmitters:
2
• all key fobs RKE transmitters in your
possession;
• a personal ID;
• the identification and registration
documents proving ownership of the
vehicle.
Setting new key fobs or re-setting the
original ones can only be performed
at an Authorized Maserati Dealer.
NOTE:
Codes of any key fob RKE transmitters
that are not present when the new
setting procedure is done will be
deleted from the memory to prevent
lost or stolen key fobs transmitters
being used to disarm the electronic
alarm system.
To Unlatch the Trunk
Press the button
on the key fob
RKE transmitter two times within five
seconds to unlatch the trunk.
See “Passive Entry System” in this
section for further information.
33
Before Starting
Key fob Battery Replacement
NOTE:
2
• Separate the two lateral covers from
the remote control case.
• Separate both parts of the remote
control case.
A low charge level of the key fob
battery will be indicated on the
instrument cluster display.
The recommended replacement
battery type is: CR2032.
To replace the battery proceed as
follows:
• Remove the emergency key as
indicated in “Keys” chapter of the
current section.
• Loosen the lateral screw that
connects the two side covers with a
small screwdriver.
34
• Remove the card with PCB (Printed
Circuit Board).
Before Starting
• Remove the battery from its seat and
replace with a new recommended
type of battery.
certain fluids contained in vehicles
and certain products of component
wear contain or emit chemicals
known to the State of California to
cause cancer, and birth defects or
other reproductive harm.
NOTE:
Avoid touching the new battery with
your fingers. Skin oils may cause
battery deterioration. If you touch a
battery, clean with alcohol.
ENVIRONMENTAL!
Batteries contain dangerous materials
that could harm the environment.
Please dispose of them according to
local regulations or at the Authorized
Maserati Dealer.
WARNING!
CALIFORNIA proposition 65.
Engine exhaust, some of its
constituents, and certain vehicle
components contain or emit chemicals
known to the state of California to
cause cancer, and birth defects or
other reproductive harm. In addition,
• Match the + sign on the battery to
the + sign on the inside of the
battery clip, located on the back
cover.
• Replace the printed circuit board by
using the indicated pin for the
sealing of the two covers.
• Assemble the key fob case and
reassemble the two lateral covers: a
click will indicate successful sealing.
• Combine the disassembled parts
with clamping screw and reassemble
the emergency key.
Radio Frequency RKE
Transmitter - General
Information
This device complies with Part 15 of
the FCC rules and RSS 210 of Industry
Canada.
The current device feature is subject to
following conditions:
2
• This device may not cause harmful
interference.
• This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause
undesired operation.
If your key fob RKE transmitter fails to
operate from a normal distance, check
for these two conditions:
• A weak battery in the key fob RKE
transmitter. The expected life of the
battery in normal use is a minimum
of three years.
• Closeness to a radio transmitter such
as a radio station tower, airport
transmitter, and some mobile or CB
radios.
35
Before Starting
Remote Start System
(optional)
2
This system enables the key fob RKE
transmitter to start the engine
conveniently from outside the vehicle
while still maintaining security. The
system has a range of approximately
300 ft (91 m). Obstructions between
the vehicle and the key fob may
reduce this range.
General Information
This device complies with Part 15 of
the FCC rules and RSS 210 of Industry
Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
• This device may not cause harmful
interference.
• This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause
undesired operation.
NOTE:
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user's
authority to operate the equipment.
If your RKE transmitter fails to operate
from a normal distance, check for
these conditions:
36
• A weak battery in the RKE
transmitter. The expected life of the
battery is a minimum of three years.
• Closeness to a radio transmitter such
as a radio station tower, airport
transmitter, and some mobile or CB
radio.
• Obstructions between the vehicle
and the Key Fob.
How to use Remote Start
All of the following conditions must be
met before the engine will remote
start:
• System not disabled from previous
remote start event.
• Vehicle Security alarm not active.
• Doors closed.
• Engine lid closed.
• Trunk lid closed.
• Hazard lights switch off.
• Brake pedal not pressed by any
passenger remaining in the vehicle.
• Battery at an acceptable charge level.
WARNING!
• Do not start or run an engine in a
closed garage or confined area.
Exhaust gas contains Carbon
Monoxide (CO) which is odorless and
colorless.
• Keep key fobs RKE transmitter away
from children. Operation of the
Remote Start System, windows, door
locks or other controls could cause
serious injury or death.
Engine Remote Start Abort
Message on Instrument Cluster
The following messages will display on
the instrument cluster if the vehicle
fails to remote start or exits remote
start prematurely:
• “Remote Start Cancelled Door
Open”.
• “Remote Start Cancelled Hood
Open”.
• “Remote Start Cancelled Trunk
Open”.
• “Remote Start Cancelled Fuel Low”.
• “Remote Start Cancelled Time
Expired”.
• “Remote Start Disabled Start Vehicle
to Reset”.
The message on the instrument cluster
stays active as long as the ignition
switch is in RUN position.
Before Starting
To enter Remote Start Mode
NOTE:
On the remote control of vehicles with
button is
this feature, the
replaced by the remote start button
.
Press and release the button
on the
key fob RKE transmitter twice within
five seconds. The vehicle doors will
lock, parking lights will flash and the
horn will ring twice (if set). Then, the
engine will start and the vehicle will
remain in the “Remote Start” mode
for a 15-minute cycle.
• The park lamps will turn on and
remain lit during “Remote Start”
mode.
• For security reasons, power window
and power sunroof operation (if
equipped) are disabled when the
vehicle is in the “Remote Start”
mode.
• The engine can be started two
consecutive times (two 15-minute
cycles) with the key fob RKE
transmitter. However, the ignition
must be cycled to the RUN position
before you can repeat the start
sequence for a third cycle.
To exit Remote Start Mode
without Driving the Vehicle
Press and release the button
one
time or allow the engine to run for
the entire 15 minute cycle.
NOTE:
NOTE:
• In case of an engine fault or low fuel
level, the vehicle will start and then
shut down in 10 seconds.
To avoid unintentional shutdowns, the
system will disable the one time press
of the button
for two seconds after
receiving a valid “Remote Start”
request.
To exit Remote Start Mode and
Drive the Vehicle
Before the end of 15 minute cycle,
press and release the button on the
key fob RKE transmitter to unlock the
doors and disarm the vehicle security
alarm. Then, prior to the end of the 15
minute cycle, press and release the
START/STOP button.
2
NOTE:
The message “Push Start Button” will
display in the instrument cluster until
you push the START/STOP button.
Auto-On Comfort with Remote
Start
The driver's heated and ventilated
seat and the heated steering wheel (if
equipped) can be programmed to
come on during a remote start. Refer
to “Auto-On Comfort & Remote Start”
function in chapter “MTC Setting”,
section 4, for further information.
37
Before Starting
Doors Locking
2
WARNING!
• For personal security and safety in
the event of an accident, or robbery
lock the vehicle doors before you
drive as well as when parking and
leaving the vehicle unattended.
Doors Manual Lock
To lock each door, push the door lock
knob on each door trim panel
downward.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle
unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others
could be seriously or fatally injured.
Children should be warned not to
touch the parking brake trigger,
brake pedal or the shift lever.
• Do not leave the key fob in or near
the vehicle, and do not leave
ignition switch in the ACC or RUN
mode. A child could operate power
windows, other controls, or start the
engine and the vehicle.
38
Power Doors Locking/
Unlocking
A power door lock switch and a
power door unlock switch are
positioned on the front door trim
panel. Use this switches to lock or
unlock the doors.
• When leaving the vehicle, always
remove the key fob RKE transmitter
and lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a
vehicle, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle.
Therefore, make sure the key fob RKE
transmitter is not inside the vehicle
before closing the door.
To unlock the front doors, pull the
inside door handle to the first detent.
To unlock the rear doors, pull the door
lock knob on the door trim panel
upward.
If the door lock knob is down when
you shut the door, the door will lock.
Before Starting
If the vehicle has been locked from
inside with the above figured
switches, the fuel filler flap remains
unlocked.
The doors can also be locked and
unlocked with the Passive Entry
system. For further information, see
“Passive Entry System” in this section.
If you press the power door lock
switch while the ignition switch is in
the ACC or RUN position, and any
front door is open, the power locks
will not operate. This prevents you
from accidentally locking the key fob
RKE transmitter in the vehicle.
Cycling the ignition to the OFF
position or closing the door will allow
the locks of the doors and fuel filler
door to operate. If a door is open with
the key fob RKE transmitter inside the
cabin and the ignition is in the ACC or
RUN position, a beep will draw the
driver’s attention.
Automatic Door Unlock on Exit
The doors will unlock automatically on
vehicles with power door locks if:
• The automatic unlock doors on exit
feature is enabled.
• The transmission is in gear and the
vehicle speed is 0 mph (km/h).
• The transmission is in N (Neutral) or
P (Park).
• The driver door is open.
• The doors were not previously
unlocked.
• The vehicle speed is 0 mph (km/h).
Set Automatic Door Unlock on Exit
Child-Protection Door Lock
System — Rear Doors
To provide a safer environment for
small children sitting in the rear seats,
the rear doors are equipped with a
child-protection door lock system.
2
Engage or Disengage the
Child-Protection Door Lock
• Open the rear door.
• Insert the tip of the emergency key
into the lock and rotate to the lock
or unlock position.
• Repeat the first two steps on the
opposite rear door.
To change the current setting, see
“MTC Settings” in section 4.
NOTE:
Use the automatic unlock doors on
exit feature in accordance with local
regulations.
Automatic Locking Doors
The auto door lock feature default
condition is disabled. When enabled,
the door locks will lock automatically
when the vehicle's speed exceeds
15 mph (24 km/h). The auto door lock
feature can be enabled or disabled by
an Authorized Maserati Dealer only
which can also service the vehicle.
39
Before Starting
Passive Entry System
2
WARNING!
Avoid trapping anyone in a vehicle in
a collision. Remember that the rear
doors can only be opened from the
outside when the child-protection
locks are engaged (locked).
NOTE:
For emergency exit from the rear seats
when the child-protection door lock
system is engaged, manually raise the
door lock knob to the unlocked
position, roll down the window, and
open the door using the outside door
handle.
40
The Passive Entry system is an
enhancement to the vehicle’s Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) system. This
feature allows you to lock and unlock
the vehicle’s door(s) without having to
press the key fob RKE transmitter lock
or unlock buttons. The Passive Entry
system upon request can also be
extended to the external opening
handles of the rear doors.
NOTE:
• Passive Entry may be programmed to
on/off; see “MTC Settings” in section
4 for further information.
• If wearing gloves, or if it has been
raining on the Passive Entry door
handle, the unlock sensitivity can be
affected, resulting in a slower
response time.
Unlock Door from the Driver
Side
With a valid key fob RKE transmitter
within 5 ft (1.5 m) of the driver's door
handle, grip the driver’s door outside
handle to unlock the door
automatically. The interior door panel
lock knob will rise when the door is
unlocked.
Before Starting
NOTE:
NOTE:
If “Unlock All Doors 1st Press” is
programmed all doors will unlock
when you grip the front driver’s door
handle. To select between “Unlock
Driver Door 1st Press” and “Unlock All
Doors 1st Press”, see “MTC Settings” in
section 4.
All doors will unlock when you grip
the front passenger door handle
regardless of the driver’s door unlock
preference setting (“Unlock Driver
Door 1st Press” or “Unlock All Doors
1st Press”).
Unlock Door from the
Passenger Side
With a valid key fob RKE transmitter
within 5 ft (1.5 m) of the passenger
door handle, grip the front passenger
outside door handle to unlock all four
doors automatically.
The interior door panel lock knob will
rise when the door is unlocked.
Preventing Inadvertent Locking
of the Key fob RKE Transmitter
inside the Vehicle
To minimize the possibility of
unintentionally locking a key fob RKE
transmitter inside your vehicle, the
Passive Entry system is equipped with
an automatic door unlock feature
which will function if the ignition
switch is in the OFF position.
If one of the vehicle doors is open and
the door panel switch is used to
lock the vehicle, once all open doors
have been closed the system checks
the inside and outside of the vehicle
for any valid key fobs RKE transmitter.
If one of the vehicle's key fobs RKE
transmitter is detected inside the
vehicle, and no other valid key fobs
RKE transmitter are detected outside
the vehicle, the Passive Entry system
automatically unlocks all vehicle doors
and chirps the horn three times (on
the third attempt ALL doors will lock
and the key fob RKE transmitter will
be locked in the vehicle).
NOTE:
The vehicle unlocks the doors under
any of the following conditions:
2
• the doors are manually locked using
the door lock knob positioned on
the door panel;
• there is a valid key fob RKE
transmitter inside the vehicle;
• there is a not valid key fob RKE
transmitter outside the vehicle.
NOTE:
The vehicle will not unlock the doors
under any of the following conditions:
• the doors are locked using the key
fob RKE transmitter;
(Continued)
41
Before Starting
Manual Door Lock from
Outside
(Continued)
• the doors are locked using the
button on the Passive Entry front
door handles;
With one of the vehicle’s key fobs RKE
transmitter within 5 ft (1.5 m) of the
driver or passenger front door handles,
press the outside door handle button
to lock all four doors.
2
NOTE:
• there is a valid key fob RKE
transmitter outside the vehicle and
within 5 ft (1.5 m) of either Passive
Entry front door handle;
• three attempts are made to lock the
doors using the door panel switch
and then close the doors.
To enter the Trunk
With a valid key fob RKE transmitter
within 3 ft (1 m) of the trunk lid, press
the button on the lid between the
license plate lights. The light inside the
trunk will turn on and will stay lit for
10 minutes. The light will immediately
turn off if you lock the trunk lid before
10 minutes.
42
NOTE:
If you inadvertently leave your
vehicle's key fob RKE transmitter in the
trunk and try to close the lid it will
automatically unlatch, unless another
one of the vehicle’s key fob RKE
transmitters is outside the vehicle and
within 3 ft (1 m) of the trunk lid.
• After pressing the outside door
handle button, you must wait two
seconds before you can lock or
unlock the doors using this door
handle. By pulling the outside door
handle, you can check if the car
remains locked, without Passive Entry
system reacting and unlocking the
doors.
• The Passive Entry system will not
operate if the key fob RKE
transmitter battery is dead.
Before Starting
The vehicle doors can also be locked
by using the key fob RKE transmitter
lock button or the lock button
located on the vehicle’s inner door
panel.
Power Windows
The window controls on the driver's
door panel governs all the door
windows.
2
There are single window controls on
each passenger door trim panel, which
operate the corresponding window.
The window controls will operate only
when the ignition switch is in the ACC
or RUN position.
43
Before Starting
NOTE:
2
• The power window switches will
remain active for up to 10 minutes
after the ignition switch is cycled to
the OFF position. Opening either
front door will cancel this feature.
The time lapse can be set. See “MTC
Settings” in section 4 for further
information.
• Frequent activations of the power
windows could result in a temporary
lock of their starters. In this case,
wait a moment before a new
activation.
WARNING!
Improper use of the power windows
and the sunroof can be dangerous,
even with the anti-pinch prevention
system. Before and during activation
of the power window, always check
that the passengers are not exposed
to the risk of injury both by the
moving window and by personal
objects that could be dragged or hit
by it. Do not leave unattended
children in a vehicle with a key fob
RKE transmitter inside. When getting
out the vehicle, always remove the
key fob RKE transmitter to prevent the
windows being accidentally activated,
44
posing a risk to passengers remaining
onboard.
Auto-Down Feature
The driver door power window switch
has an auto-down feature. Some
models feature a passenger auto-down
feature as well.
Press the window switch to the second
detent, release, and the window will
go completely down automatically.
To open the window part way, press
the window switch to the first detent
and release it when you want the
window to stop.
To stop the window from going all the
way down during the auto-down
operation, pull up on the switch
briefly.
Auto-Up Feature with
Anti-Pinch Protection
Lift the window switch to the second
detent, release, and the window will
go all the way up automatically.
To stop the window from going all the
way up during the auto-up operation,
push down on the switch briefly.
To close the window part way, lift the
window switch to the first detent and
release it when you want the window
to stop.
NOTE:
• If the window runs into an obstacle
during auto-closure, it will reverse
direction and then go back down.
Remove the obstacle and use the
window switch again to close the
window.
• Any impact due to rough road
conditions may trigger the auto
reverse function unexpectedly during
auto-closure. If this happens, pull the
switch lightly to the first detent and
hold to close the window manually.
• Frequent activations of the
anti-pinch function could disable the
auto-down and auto-up function of
the windows. In order to re-activate
this function proceed with a reset
cycle as described in the next
paragraph.
WARNING!
There is no anti-pinch protection when
the window is almost closed. Be sure
to clear all objects from the area
before closing the window.
Before Starting
Reset Auto-Up/Down
NOTE:
Should the auto-up/down feature stop
working, the window probably needs
to be reset.
To reset auto-up/down, pull the
window switch up to close the
window completely and push the
window switch down to open the
window completely.
If the sunroof was open, it will close
completely when performing the
above indicated “Closing” procedure.
However, if it was closed, when
performing the “Opening” procedure
it will still remain closed (refer to
“Power Sunroof with Sunshade” in
Section 3 for further information).
Open and Close the Windows
with RKE Transmitter and
Ignition Off
Rear Window and Sunshade
Lockout Button
When the ignition switch in is OFF
position, windows can be opened or
closed by pressing the buttons on the
RKE transmitter.
Opening:
• press the button and release it;
• press a second time the button
and keep it pressed until complete
opening of the window.
The window lockout button on the
driver's door trim panel allows to
disable the window control on the
rear passenger doors and the rear
window sunshade control at the rear
of the central console, by pressing the
window lockout button (setting it in
the down position).
To enable the controls previously
described, press the window lockout
button again (setting it in the up
position).
Wind Buffeting
Wind buffeting can be described as
the perception of pressure or a
helicopter-type sound. Your vehicle
may exhibit wind buffeting with the
windows down, or the sunroof in
open or partially open positions. This
is a normal occurrence and can be
minimized. If the buffeting occurs
with the rear windows open, open the
front and rear windows together to
minimize the buffeting. If the
buffeting occurs with the sunroof
open, then adjust the sunroof opening
to minimize the buffeting.
2
Closing:
• press the button and release it;
• press a second time the button
and keep it pressed until complete
closure of the window.
45
Before Starting
Power Sunshades on the
Rear Door Windows
sunshade and the door panel, during
lowering.
NOTE:
2
Operation of the rear windows and
related sunshades is done by pressing
or pulling the window switch and
depends on the position of the
windows prior to the command
operation.
As described for the opening and
closing functions of the power
windows (see chapter “Power
Windows” in this section), the window
switch has two functioning modes:
press and release the switch to the first
detent to partially move the window;
press and release the switch to the
second detent to move the window all
the way up or down.
46
CAUTION!
Before activating the sunshade, make
sure that no objects can interfere with
its travel.
• On vehicles provided with power
sunshades on the rear windows, the
window switches also operate the
sunshades.
• The rear window lock button also
operates the rear power sunshades.
• Window and sunshade controls only
operate if the ignition switch is in
ACC or RUN position.
The following images and the
subsequent text show the possible
starting positions (A, B, C and UP,
DOWN) and function of the window
and the sunshade, to be independently
activated by pressing or lifting the
control switch to the first (1) or
second (2) detent.
Operations
WARNING!
Rear seat passengers must be careful
when operating the sunshades, since
there is the risk of being pinched
between the top of the sunshade and
the headlining, during raising, and
between the top edge of the
Before Starting
A. Sunshade fully unrolled (UP
position) and Window closed (UP
position)
• Pulling the control up to 1 or 2
detent: no action (NOP).
1.1 Pressing the control to 1 detent:
the sunshade rolls down
completely and the window
stay closed.
1.2 Pressing the control again to 1
detent: the window open
partially until the control is
released and the sunshade stay
down (pressing the control to 2
detent: the window opens
completely).
2.1 Pressing the control to 2 detent:
the sunshade rolls down
completely while the window
stay closed.
2.2 Pressing the control again to 2
detent: the window opens
completely.
2
B. Sunshade fully rolled down (DOWN
position) and Window closed (UP
position)
• Pulling the control up to 1 or 2
detent: the sunshade unrolls
completely and the window stay
closed.
• Pressing the control to 1 or 2 detent:
the window opens partially or
completely and the sunshade
remains rolled.
C. Sunshade fully rolled down (DOWN
position) and Window completely
open (DOWN position)
• Pulling the control to 1 or 2 detent:
the window closes partially or
completely and the sunshade
remains rolled.
• Pressing the control to 1 or 2 detent:
no action (NOP).
47
Before Starting
Rear Window
Rear Window Defroster
2
The rear window defroster button is
located on the climate control panel.
See “Air Conditioning Controls” in
section 4.
• Within 15 seconds, press the “Rear
Sunshade” soft-key to raise the
power sunshade.
• Within 15 seconds, press the “Rear
Sunshade” soft-key a second time to
lower the sunshade.
seats. This button can be operated by
the rear passengers.
• Press the button to raise the
sunshade.
• Press the button a second time to
lower the sunshade.
Power Rear Sunshade (optional
on V6 Engine model)
A power sunshade reduces the amount
of sunlight entering through the rear
window.
The sunshade is rolled up and stored
inside a cover located behind the rear
seats. When this is activated, it rolls
out upwards.
The power sunshade is operated using
the MTC system.
• Press the “Controls” soft-key.
48
If the sunshade is the raised position
and the gear lever is positioned in R
(Reverse), the sunshade will
automatically lower.
When the gear lever is shifted out of R
(Reverse) the sunshade will
automatically return to the fully raised
position after approximately five
seconds.
The trigger button of the rear
sunshade is positioned at the rear of
the central console, or for vehicles
equipped with the “Comfort Luxury”
rear seats, is located on the rear
central console between the two rear
“Comfort Luxury” rear seats
Before Starting
NOTE:
The rear sunshade controls, power
windows switches together with the
sunshades on the rear windows, can
be locked by pressing the lockout
button indicated on the driver side
door panel.
Trunk Compartment
Operation
The trunk lid can be opened from
inside the vehicle by pressing the
release button on the door trim panel.
NOTE:
The shift lever must be in P (Park)
before the button can operate.
to keep the RKE transmitter within 3
ft (1 m) from the trunk lid, with
“Passive Entry” function enabled or
disabled from the MTC menu.
• When the car is locked , to open
the trunk lid:
2
• if the “Passive Entry” function has
been enabled from the MTC menu,
it is necessary to keep the RKE
transmitter within 3 ft (1 m) from
the trunk lid;
• if the “Passive Entry” function has
been disabled from the MTC
menu, the trunk lid does not open
even with the RKE within 3 ft (1 m)
from the trunk lid.
The trunk lid can be released from
outside the vehicle by pressing the
button on the key fob with RKE
transmitter twice within five seconds
or by using the external release
button located on the lower side of
the trunk ledge, between the license
plate lights under the following
conditions:
• When the car is unlocked , to
open the trunk lid it is not necessary
49
Before Starting
With the ignition device in the OFF
position, the trunk open symbol and
message will display until closure.
2
To close the trunk lid use the handle as
indicated beside the closing
mechanism.
See “Passive Entry System” in this
section for more information on trunk
operation with the Passive Entry
feature.
Trunk Lid Emergency Release
With the ignition switch in RUN
position, the red symbol
will
display on the instrument panel with
the message indicating that the trunk
is open. Once the trunk is closed both
symbol and message will disappear
from the display.
50
If accessing the trunk from the rear
seats, operate the emergency release
lever (see the chapter "Trunk Safety"
in this section) in order to lower the
rear seat backrest (see "Cargo Area" in
section 3). If the power release control
operated by pressing the button on
the door trim panel fails, which may
occur when the battery is low on
voltage, it is possible to temporarily
power the system by using the battery
remote poles located inside the engine
compartment (see “Auxiliary
Jump-Start Procedure” in section 6).
Thus it is possible to normally open the
trunk lid by using the RKE remote
control. Have the vehicle checked by
an Authorized Maserati Dealer center
in order to solve the failure.
Before Starting
Trunk Safety
Engine Lid Operation
Opening
WARNING!
Do not allow children to have access
to the trunk. Always close the trunk
lid when your vehicle is unattended.
Once in the trunk, young children may
not be able to escape. If trapped in
the trunk, children can die from
suffocation or heat stroke.
Two latches must be released to open
the lid.
• From inside the vehicle, pull the
engine lid release lever located
under the left lower side of the
dashboard.
2
Trunk Lid Emergency Release
from inside the Trunk
As a security measure, an internal
trunk emergency release lever is built
into the trunk latching mechanism. In
the event of a person trapped inside
the trunk, the trunk lid can be simply
opened by pulling on the
phosphorescent handle attached to
the trunk latching mechanism.
• Move to the outside and stand in
front of the vehicle front grille.
51
Before Starting
• Slightly lift the engine lid and push
the safety catch as indicated by the
arrow. The safety catch is located in
the center of the lid.
Closing
Lower the engine lid, and then drop it.
This should secure the inclusion of
both latches.
2
CAUTION!
To prevent possible damage, do not
slam the engine lid to close it.
• Lift the engine lid completely: this
operation is facilitated by two gas
struts keeping the lid in the fully
open position.
With the ignition switch in RUN
position, the red symbol
will
display on the instrument panel with
the message indicating that the engine
lid is open.
52
WARNING!
• Be sure the engine lid is fully latched
before driving away. If the lid is not
fully latched, it could open when the
vehicle is in motion and block your
vision. Failure to follow this warning
could result in serious injury or
death.
• Gear shifting is always active and
may be performed even when one
or more doors, the engine or the
trunk lids are open. Therefore, in
these conditions, take great care to
avoid moving the gearshift lever and
so accidentally engage gears.
Occupant Restraint
Systems
Occupant restraint systems are some of
the most important safety features in
your vehicle:
• Three-point seat belts (also called lap
and shoulder belts) for the driver and
all passengers.
• Advanced front air bags for driver
and passenger.
• Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable
Curtains (SABIC) for the driver and
passengers seated next to a window.
• Supplemental seat-mounted side air
bags.
• An energy-absorbing steering
column and steering wheel.
• Front and rear outer seat belts
incorporate pretensioners that may
enhance occupant protection by
managing the energy created during
an impact.
• All seat belt systems (except the
driver’s) include Automatic Locking
Retractors (ALR), which lock the seat
belt webbing into position by
extending the belt all the way out
and then adjusting the belt to the
desired length to restrain a child seat
or secure a large item in a seat. Items
Before Starting
should not be placed in front
passenger seat.
Please pay close attention to the
information in this section. It tells you
how to use your restraint system
properly, to keep you and your
passengers as safe as possible.
If you are carrying children too small
for adult-sized seat belts, the seat
belts or the Lower Anchors and Tether
for CHildren (LATCH) feature also can
be used to hold infant and child
restraint systems. For more
information on LATCH, refer to
“Lower Anchors and Tether for
CHildren (LATCH)” in this section.
WARNING!
To help provide maximum protection,
you are advised to keep the seatback
in the most upright position possible
and the seat belt close to your chest
and pelvis. If the seat belt is loose, in
the event of an accident you could
move too far forward and could be
injured. Travelling with the seatback
too far reclined could also be
dangerous: even if the seat belts are
fastened, they may not work
correctly. In fact, the belt itself may
not be close enough to your body
and, if it is in front of you, it could
cause neck wounds or other injuries in
an accident. Additionally, in an
accident, the lower section of the belt
could press against the upper part of
your stomach rather than the pelvic
area, causing serious internal injuries.
NOTE:
The advanced air bags have a multi
stage inflator. This allows the air bag
to have different stages of inflation
based on the severity and type of
collision.
Here are some simple steps you can
take to minimize the risk of harm
from a deploying air bag:
• Children 12 years old and under
should always ride buckled up in a
rear seat.
WARNING!
Infants in rear facing child restraints
should never ride in the front seat of
a vehicle with a passenger Advanced
Front Air Bag. An air bag deployment
can cause severe or fatal injury to
infants in that position.
Do not use child seats or child booster
cushions/backrests in the front
passenger seat. Occupants in the front
passenger seat must never sit on the
edge of the seat, leaning toward the
dashboard or otherwise sit out of
position. The occupants’ back must be
as upright as comfort allows, and
must rest against the seatback with
the seat belt properly fastened. Feet
must be on the floor (i.e. not on the
dashboard, seat or out of the
window).
2
Children that are not big enough to
wear the vehicle seat belt properly
(see “Child Restraints System” in this
section) should be secured in the rear
seat in child restraints seats or
belt-positioning booster seats. Older
children who do not use child
restraints seats or belt-positioning
booster seats should ride properly
buckled up in the rear seat. Never
allow children to slide the shoulder
belt behind them or under their arm.
If children 1 to 12 years old (not in a
rear facing child seat) must ride in the
front passenger seat, move the seat as
far back as possible and use the
proper child restraint (Refer to “Child
Restraints System” in this section).
You should read the instructions
provided with your child restraint
system to make sure that you are
using it properly.
53
Before Starting
2
• All occupants should always wear
their lap and shoulder belts properly.
• The driver and front passenger seats
should be moved back as far as
possible to allow the Advanced
Front Air Bags room to inflate.
• Do not lean against the door or
window. Your vehicle has
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable
Curtains (SABIC) and Supplemental
Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SAB),
and if deployment occurs, the SABIC
and SAB air bags will inflate
forcefully into the space between
you and the door.
• If the air bag system in this vehicle
needs to be modified to
accommodate a disabled person,
contact an Authorized Maserati
Dealer.
WARNING!
In an accident, all occupants can suffer
much greater injuries not properly
buckled up. You can strike the interior
of your vehicle or other occupants or
you can be thrown out of the vehicle.
Always be sure you and others in your
vehicle are buckled up properly.
Buckle up even though you are an
excellent driver, even on short trips.
54
Someone on the road may be a poor
driver and cause an accident that
includes you. This can happen far
away from home or on your own
street.
Statistics report that seat belts save
lives and reduce the seriousness of
injuries in an accident. Some of the
worst injuries happen when people are
thrown from the vehicle. Seat belts
reduce the possibility of ejection and
the risk of injury caused by striking the
inside of the vehicle.
Everyone in a motor vehicle should be
belted at all times.
Three-Point Seat Belts
All seating positions in your vehicle are
equipped with combination lap and
shoulder belts.
The belt retractor is designed to lock
during very sudden stops or impacts.
This feature allows the shoulder part
of the belt to move freely with you
under normal conditions, conforming
to the body of the occupants.
However, in an accident, the belt will
lock and reduce your risk of striking
the inside of the vehicle or being
thrown out.
The driver is responsible for respecting,
and ensuring that all the other
occupants of the car also observe the
local regulations concerning the use of
seat belts. Always fasten the seat belts
before starting the vehicle.
Seat belts are designed to be used by
persons whose physical characteristics
(age, height, weight) are provided for
by established legislation in each
country. Anyone who does comply
with these provisions may not travel in
the front passenger seat. This also
applies to children. Their heads are
proportionally heavier and larger than
those of adults, while their bones and
muscles are relatively undeveloped. To
help protect them in case of a collision,
they must use special restraint or
safety systems, even in the rear seat
area.
WARNING!
• It is forbidden and dangerous to ride
in a cargo area. In an accident,
people riding in these areas are more
likely to be seriously injured or
killed.
• Do not allow any person to ride in
any area of your vehicle that is not
equipped with seats and seat belts.
(Continued)
Before Starting
(Continued)
• Be sure all passengers are in a seat
and using a seat belt properly.
enough to fit, insert the latch plate
into the buckle until you hear a
“click.”
• Wearing your belt improperly could
make your injuries in an accident
much worse. You might suffer
internal injuries, or you could even
slide out of part of the belt. Follow
these instructions to wear your seat
belt properly and to keep your
passengers safe, too.
• Two people should never be belted
into a single seat belt. People belted
together can crash into one another
in an accident, hurting one another
severely. Never use a lap/shoulder
belt for more than one person.
• Remember that, in the event of an
accident, the rear seat passengers
not wearing the seat belts are not
only subject to personal injuries but
also represent a serious danger for
the front seat occupants.
Three-Point Seat Belts Use Instructions
• Enter the vehicle and close the door.
Sit back and adjust the seat.
• The seat belt latch plate is above
your seat on the external side.
• Hold the latch plate and pull the belt
across you, make the belt go around
your body and when the belt is long
ride too high on your body, possibly
causing internal injuries. Always
latch your belt into the
corresponding buckle.
• A belt that is too loose will not
protect you properly. In a sudden
stop, you could move too far
forward, increasing the possibility of
injury. Wear your seat belt
comfortably.
WARNING!
• The seat belts height must be
adjusted only with the vehicle
stationary.
• Do not bring sharp edges in contact
with a seat belt. This could reduce
their initial strength and cause them
to tear in the event of a crash.
• If a seat belt has been brought in
contact with a sharp edge, or has
been used to pin something to it,
have it immediately replaced by our
Authorized Maserati Dealer.
• A belt that is latched into the wrong
buckle will not protect you properly.
The lap portion of the belt could
2
• A belt that is worn under your arm
is dangerous. Your body could strike
the inside surfaces of the vehicle in
an accident, increasing head and
neck injury. A belt worn under the
arm can also cause internal injuries.
• The lower part must adhere to the
pelvis rather than the abdomen of
the occupant. To fasten the lap belt
pull the diagonal portion of the
shoulder belt up slightly. To loosen
the lap belt if too tight, tilt the latch
plate and pull on the lap belt. A
snug belt reduces the risk of sliding
under the belt in an accident.
WARNING!
• A lap belt worn too high can
increase the risk of internal injury in
(Continued)
55
Before Starting
(Continued)
an accident. Always wear the lap
belt as low as possible and keep it
comfortable.
2
• A twisted belt will not protect you
properly. In a collision, it could even
cut into you. Be sure the belt is
straight. If you can't straighten a
belt in your vehicle, take it to an
Authorized Maserati Dealer
immediately.
• Do not use devices (clips, fastenings
etc.) that prevent the seat belts from
laying close to the occupants bodies.
• Do not carry children on a
passenger’s lap using only one seat
belt for protecting both.
• Position the shoulder belt on your
chest so that it is comfortable and
not resting on your neck. The
retractor will withdraw any slack in
the belt.
• To release the belt, push the red
button on the buckle. The belt will
automatically retract to its stowed
position. If necessary, guide the seat
belt with your hand while it is
rewinding, to prevent it from
twisting.
56
WARNING!
A frayed or torn belt could break in an
accident and leave you with no
protection. Inspect the belt system
periodically, checking for cuts, frays, or
loose parts. Damaged parts must be
replaced immediately.
Do not disassemble or modify the
system. Seat belt/retractor assemblies
must be replaced by the Authorized
Maserati Dealer after an accident if
they have been damaged (bent
retractor, torn belt, etc.).
Three-Point Seat Belt Height
Adjustment
Push the indicated button above the
shoulder belt guide to release the
anchorage, then move the belt slider
up or down to the position that fits
you best.
WARNING!
After the adjustment, always check
that the slider to which the oscillating
ring is fixed, is locked into one of the
positions provided. With the handgrip
released, push again downward to
allow the anchoring device to click
into place, in the event that it has not
been released in one of the positions
provided.
WARNING!
The seat belts height must only be
adjusted when the vehicle is
stationary.
The vehicle has a shoulder belt height
adjuster for the driver and right front
passenger seating positions.
Adjust the guide so the shoulder
portion of the belt is on the shoulder
and not falling off of it. The belt
should be close to, but not contacting,
the neck.
When you release the anchorage try to
move the belt slider up and down to
make sure that it is locked in position.
Before Starting
Three-Point Seat Belt
Untwisting Procedure
Use the following procedure to
untwist a twisted three point belt.
• Position the latch plate as close as
possible to the anchor point.
• At about 0.5 to 1 ft (15 to 30 cm)
above the latch plate, grasp and
twist the belt 180 degrees to create
a fold that begins immediately
above the latch plate.
• Slide the latch plate upward over the
folded belt. The folded belt must
enter the slot at the top of the latch
plate.
• Continue to slide the latch plate up
until it clears the folded belt.
Passenger Seat Belts
All passenger seat belts are equipped
with Automatic Locking Retractors
(ALR) and can be used to secure a
child restraint system. For additional
information, see “Installing Child
Restraint Systems using the Vehicle
Seat Belt equipped with ALR” under
“Child Restraint Systems” in this
section.
If the passenger belt with ALR is used
for normal usage: only pull the belt
out far enough to comfortably wrap
around the occupant so as to not
activate the ALR. If the ALR is
activated, you will hear a ratcheting
sound as the belt retracts. In this case,
allow the belt to retract completely
and then carefully pull out only the
amount of belt necessary to
comfortably wrap around the seat
occupant.
Slide the latch plate into the buckle
until you hear a "click".
WARNING!
• Remember that, in the event of a
violent impact, the passengers on
the rear seats that are not wearing
the seat belts are not only subject to
personal injury but they also
represent a danger for passengers
sitting in the front seats.
• Always fasten the seat belts.
• Travelling without the seat belts
fastened significantly increases the
risk of serious injury in the event of
a collision, even with the air bags.
• In the event of a collision, the seat
belts help reduce the possibility of
the vehicle’s occupants being
thrown against the structures of the
passenger compartment or out of
the vehicle.
• The air bags are designed to work
together with the seat belts, not to
substitute them. The front air bags
only deploy in the event of certain
head-on collisions of sufficient
intensity. They may not be activated
if the vehicle rolls over, or in the
event of rear bumps or minor frontal
collisions, or non-frontal collisions.
2
Using Seat Belt in Automatic
Locking Retractor (ALR) Mode
Use the seat belt automatic locking
mode anytime a child safety seat is
installed in a seating position that has
a belt with this feature.
Children under 5 ft (1.50 m) in height,
should be properly buckled up in a
child restraint system.
Automatic Locking Mode Setting
• Buckle the lap and shoulder belt.
• Grasp the shoulder portion and pull
downward until the entire belt is
extracted.
• Allow the belt to retract. As the belt
retracts, you will hear a clicking
sound. This indicates the safety belt
is now in the automatic locking
mode.
57
Before Starting
Automatic Locking Mode Unsetting
2
Unbuckle the three point seat belt and
allow it to retract completely to
disengage the automatic locking mode
and activate the vehicle emergency
locking mode.
WARNING!
• The belt and retractor assembly must
be checked by the Authorized
Maserati Dealer and must be
replaced if the Automatic Locking
Retractor (ALR) feature or any other
seat belt function is not working
properly.
• Failure to replace the belt and
retractor assembly could increase the
risk of injury in collisions.
Seat Belt Pretensioners
The car is equipped with front and
rear outer seat belt pretensioners, that
reduce slack in the belts in the event
of a severe frontal impact. This
guarantees the perfect adherence of
the seat belts to the occupants bodies
before the restraining action begins.
This car is also equipped with a second
pretensioner in the front kick plate
area. Its activation is signalled by the
58
shortening of the metal cable and
curling of its protective sheath.
Pretensioners work for all size
occupant restraint systems, including
the child restraint systems.
NOTE:
To obtain the highest degree of
protection from the action of the
pretensioning device, wear the seat
belt tight to the chest and pelvis.
Pretensioners are triggered by the
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC). A
pretensioner may be used only once.
Pretensioners do not require any
maintenance or lubrication: any
changes to its original conditions will
invalidate its efficiency. If, due to
unusual natural events (floods, sea
storms, etc.), the device has been
affected by water and mud, it must be
replaced.
WARNING!
It is strictly forbidden to remove or
tamper with the pretensioner
components. Any service intervention
must be carried out only by qualified
and authorized personnel. Always
contact an Authorized Maserati
Dealer.
CAUTION!
Operations which lead to impacts,
vibrations or localized heating (over
212°F/100°C for a maximum of 6 hours
max.) in the area around the
pretensioners may damage or deploy
them erroneously. These devices are
not affected by vibrations caused by
uneven road surfaces or low obstacles.
Contact an Authorized Maserati
Dealer for any intervention that may
be required.
Before Starting
Enhanced Seat Belt Use
Reminder System (BeltAlert®)
BeltAlert® is a feature intended to
remind the driver and front passenger
to fasten their seat belts. The feature
activates whenever the ignition is on.
If the driver or front seat passenger is
unbelted, the seat belt reminder light
and message will turn on and
remain on until both front seat belts
are fastened.
The BeltAlert® warning sequence
begins after the vehicle speed is over
5 mph (8 km/h) for more than 19
seconds, by blinking the seat belt
reminder light and message and by
sounding an intermittent chime.
Once the sequence starts, it will
continue for the entire duration or
until the respective seat belts are
fastened. After the sequence
completes, the seat belt reminder light
and message remains illuminated
until the respective seat belts are
fastened.
If the opened front door on the driver or
passenger side is closed and the occupant
presence sensor detects a status change
from occupant not present to occupant
present the system will repeat the
warning sequence. The driver should
instruct all other occupants to fasten
their seat belts.
If a front seat belt is unbuckled while
traveling at speeds greater than
5 mph (8 km/h), BeltAlert® will
provide both audio and visual
notification.
The front passenger seat BeltAlert® is
not active when the front passenger
seat is unoccupied. BeltAlert® may be
triggered when a pet or heavy object
is placed on the front passenger seat.
It is recommended to restrain pets in
the rear seat, in pet harnesses or pet
carriers that are secured by seat belts,
and properly stow cargo.
Seat Belts and Pregnant
Women
Seat belts should be worn by pregnant
women: the risk of injury in the event
of an accident is greatly reduced for
them and the unborn child if they are
wearing a seat belt. The best way to
protect the fetus is to protect the
mother.
Pregnant women must position the
lower part of the belt below the belly
so that it passes over the pelvis and
under the abdomen (see figure).
2
When a safety belt is worn properly, it is
more likely that the baby will not be hurt
in a crash. For pregnant women, as for
anyone, the key to making safety belts
effective is wearing them properly.
WARNING!
Pregnant women should observe the
above indications, as well as local
regulation concerning the use of seat
belts. In addition, pregnant women
should consult a doctor with regards
to the vehicle operation and seat belt
usage.
59
Before Starting
Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) — Air bags
2
This vehicle has advanced front air
bags for both the driver and front
passenger as a supplement to the seat
belt restraint systems.
The driver's advanced front air bag is
mounted in the center of the steering
wheel in the area shown in the
picture. On this area is embossed the
word “SRS AIRBAG” for easier
recognition.
The passenger's advanced front air bag
is mounted in the dashboard, above
the glove compartment in the area
shown in the picture.
NOTE:
These air bags are certified to
regulations for advanced air bags.
60
The advanced front air bags have a
multistage inflator design. This allows
the air bag to have different rates of
inflation based on the severity and
type of collision.
This vehicle is equipped with driver
and front passenger seat track position
sensors that may adjust the inflation
level of the advanced front air bags
based upon seat position.
This vehicle is also equipped with a
front passenger seat belt buckle sensor
that detects whether the front
passenger seat belt is fastened. The
seat belt buckle sensor may adjust the
inflation rate of the advanced front air
bag.
This vehicle is equipped with
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable
Curtains (SABIC) to protect the heads
of front and rear outer occupants. The
SABIC air bags are located above the
side windows and their covers are also
labeled “AIR bag”.
This vehicle is also equipped with
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air
Bags (SAB) for driver and passenger
pelvis-chest-shoulder protection during
a side impact. The Supplemental
Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags are
mounted on front seats and are
located in the outboard side of the
front seats.
NOTE:
After any accident, the vehicle should
be taken to an Authorized Maserati
Dealer immediately.
Air Bag System Components
Your vehicle may be equipped with the
following air bag system components:
• Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC);
• Air bag warning light on the
instrument cluster;
• Steering wheel and column;
• Instrument cluster;
• Driver advanced front air bag;
• Passenger advanced front air bag;
• Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air
Bags (SAB);
• Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable
Curtains (SABIC);
• Front and side impact sensors;
• Front and rear outer seat belt
pretensioners;
• Seat belt buckle switch and seat
track position sensors;
• Pyrotechnical charge to cut power
from the battery; it is located on the
positive battery terminal.
Before Starting
WARNING!
The air bag is not a substitute for the
seat belts. Correct use of the seat
belts, in combination with the air bag,
will offer protection for the driver and
passenger in the front seat in the
event of a head-on collision.
Advanced Front Air Bags
Properties
The advanced front air bag system has
multistage driver and front passenger
air bags. This system provides air bag
inflation rates which are appropriate
to the severity and type of collision as
determined by the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC), which may receive
information from the front impact
sensors.
The first stage inflator is triggered
immediately during an impact that
requires air bag deployment. This
inflation rate is used in less severe
collisions. A higher energy output,
inflation rate, is used for more severe
collisions.
CAUTION!
• The electronic control unit provides
for the activation of the
pretensioners, front air bags or side
air bags (front and rear) based on
different criteria, according to the
type of impact. Failure of one or
more systems to activate is not
indicative of a system malfunction.
• The front and/or lateral air bags may
inflate if the vehicle suffers a violent
impact involving the underbody
area, for example in case of violent
impacts against steps, sidewalks,
speed bumps, or when the vehicle
falls into potholes, or similar.
WARNING!
• Never place objects (e.g. mobile
phones, toys, folders, tablets, etc..)
on the passenger side of the
dashboard since they could interfere
with correct inflation of the
passenger air bag and also cause
serious injury to the occupants.
• Do not put anything on or around
the air bag covers or attempt to
open them manually. You may
damage the air bags and you could
be injured because the air bags may
no longer be functional. The
protective covers for the air bag are
designed to open only when the air
bags are inflating.
2
• Always drive with your hands on
the steering wheel rim, so that the
air bag can inflate freely if required.
During the drive your back must be
as upright as comfort allows and be
against the seat back with the seat
belt properly fastened.
• Do not apply stickers or other
objects on the steering wheel, on
the dashboard in the passenger’s
side air bag area, on roof side trims
or on the seats.
• Do not travel with objects in your
lap, in front of your chest or
especially with a pipe, pencil or
other objects in your mouth. In the
event of a collision, the deployment
of the air bag could result in serious
injury.
• EXTREME HAZARD! Do not place a
rearward-facing infant seat onto the
front seat in front of a not
deactivated air bag (see warning
plate on the dashboard and above
and behind the sun visors).
(Continued)
61
Before Starting
(Continued)
Deployment of the air bag in an
accident could cause fatal injuries to
the infant regardless of the severity
of the collision.
2
Supplemental Seat-Mounted
Side Air Bags (SAB)
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air
Bags (SAB) protect the pelvis, chest
and shoulder area of the occupants in
the event of a side impact of
medium/high severity. The SAB is
marked with an “AIRBAG” label sewn
into the outboard side of the front
seats.
When the air bag deploys, it opens the
seam between the front and side of
the seat's trim cover. Each air bag
deploys independently.
Supplemental Side Air Bag
Inflatable Curtain (SABIC)
SABIC air bags are designed to protect
the head of front and rear occupants
in the event of a side impact, thanks to
the wide cushion inflation surface.
62
Each air bag features inflated
chambers placed adjacent to the head
of each outboard occupant that
reduce the potential for side-impact
head injuries. The SABIC deploy
downward, covering both windows on
the impact side.
WARNING!
• Side air bags also need room to
inflate. Do not rest your head, arms
or elbows on the door, windows or
the area in which the window bag is
located to avoid possible injury
during air bag inflation. Sit upright
in the center of the seat.
• Do not cover the front seatbacks
with seat covers or anything that
may adversely affect or impair the
performance of the air bag. Do not
use accessory seat covers or place
objects between you and the side air
bags; the performance could be
adversely affected and/or objects
could cause serious injury.
• Do not add roof racks that require
permanent attachments (bolts or
screws) for installation on the
vehicle roof. Do not drill into the
roof of the vehicle for any reason.
Before Starting
Air Bag Deployment Sensors
and Controls
Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC)
The Occupant Restraint Controller
ORC determines if deployment of the
front and/or side air bags in a frontal
or side collision is required. Based on
the impact sensor's signals, a central
electronic ORC deploys the advanced
front air bags, SABIC and SAB air bags,
and front seat belt pretensioners, as
required, depending on the severity
and type of impact.
Beyond what is previously described,
the characteristics of the collision
registered by the sensors and sent to
the control unit of the ORC can also
cause a sudden cut of the power from
the battery, “blowing” the
pyrotechnical charge located on the
positive battery terminal.
CAUTION!
After a collision that has caused the
blowing up of the pyrotechnical
charge, this must be replaced at an
Authorized Maserati Dealer.
Advanced front air bags are designed
to provide additional protection by
supplementing the seat belts in
certain frontal collisions depending on
the severity and type of collision.
Advanced front air bags are not
expected to reduce the risk of injury in
rear, side, or rollover collisions.
The advanced front air bags will not
deploy in all frontal collisions,
including those that may produce
substantial vehicle damage, for
example, some pole collisions, truck
under rides, and corner impacts. On
the other hand, depending on the
type and location of impact, advanced
front air bags may deploy in crashes
with little vehicle front-end damage
but that produce a severe initial
deceleration.
The side air bags will not deploy in all
side collisions. Side air bag
deployment will depend on the
severity and type of collision. Because
air bag sensors measure vehicle
deceleration over time, vehicle speed
and damage alone are not good
indicators of whether or not an air
bag should have deployed.
Seat belts are necessary for your
protection in all accidents, and also
are needed to help keep you in
position, away from an inflating air
bag. The ORC monitors the readiness
of the electronic parts of the air bag
system whenever the ignition switch is
in the RUN position. If the ignition
switch is in the OFF position, in the
ACC position, or not active, the air bag
system is not activated and the air
bags will not inflate.
The ORC contains a backup power
supply system that may deploy the air
bags even if the battery has low
power or it becomes disconnected
prior to deployment. When starting
the vehicle, ORC turns on the air bag
warning light
on the instrument
cluster for approximately 4 to 8
seconds for a test.
After the test, the air bag warning
light will turn off. If the ORC, during
the diagnosis phase detects a
malfunction that could affect the air
bag system, it turns on the air bag
warning light and the “Service Airbag
System” message either momentarily
or continuously. The diagnostics also
record the nature of the malfunction.
A beep will sound if the light
illuminates again after initial startup.
2
63
Before Starting
not an indication of a system
malfunction.
2
The air bag warning light monitors the
internal circuits and interconnecting
wiring associated with air bag system
electrical components.
• Ignoring the air bag warning light
and message in your instrument
cluster could mean you won't have
the air bags to protect you in a
collision. If the light does not come
on as a bulb check when the ignition
is first turned on, stays on after you
start the engine, or if it comes on as
you drive, have an Authorized
Maserati Dealer service the air bag
system immediately.
Front Air Bag Inflator Units
WARNING!
• If the ignition switch is in RUN
position, the engine is off and the
vehicle is in complete stop, the air
bags can be deployed in case of
collision. For this reason, children
must never occupy the front seat in
a rearward facing seat even if the car
is not moving. Deployment of the air
bag following an impact could cause
fatal injuries to the child. Please note
that when the ignition switch is in
the OFF or ACC position or is turned
off, the air bag will not deploy in
case of collision. Therefore, in these
cases, lack of air bag deployment is
64
When the ORC detects a collision
requiring the advanced front air bags,
it signals the inflator units. A large
quantity of nontoxic gas is generated
to inflate the advanced front air bags.
The steering wheel hub trim cover and
the upper right side of the dashboard
separate and fold out of the way as
the air bags inflate to their full size.
The air bags then quickly deflate while
helping to restrain the driver and front
passenger. The advanced front air bag
gas is vented through the vent holes in
the sides of the air bag. In this way,
the air bags do not interfere with your
control of the vehicle.
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air
Bag (SAB) Inflator Units
The ORC unit determines if a side
collision requires the side air bags to
inflate, based on the severity and type
of collision. Based on the severity and
type of collision, the side air bag
inflator on the crash side of the vehicle
may be triggered, releasing a quantity
of nontoxic gas.
The inflating SAB exits through the
seat seam into the space between the
occupant and the door. The side air
bag moves at a very high speed and
with such a high force that it could
injure you if you are not seated
properly, or if items are positioned in
the area where the side air bag
inflates. This especially applies to
children.
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable
Curtain (SABIC) Inflator Units
During collisions where the impact is
confined to a particular area of the
side of the vehicle, the ORC may
deploy the SABIC air bags, depending
on the severity and type of collision. In
these events, the ORC will deploy the
SABIC only on the impact side of the
vehicle. A quantity of non-toxic gas is
generated to inflate the side curtain
air bag.
Before Starting
The inflating side curtain air bag
pushes the head/s of the occupant/s
seating in the outside seats from the
edge of the headliner out of the way
and covers the window. The air bag
inflates with enough force to possibly
injure you if you are not belted and
seated properly, or if items are
positioned in the area where the side
curtain air bag inflates. This especially
applies to children.
Front and Side Impact Sensors
In front and side impacts, impact
sensors can aid the ORC in
determining appropriate response to
impact events.
Enhanced Accident Response System
In the event of an impact causing air
bag deployment, if the
communication network and the
power remains intact, depending on
the nature of the accident, the ORC
will determine whether the enhanced
accident response system will have to
perform the following functions:
• cut off fuel to the engine;
• turn hazard lights and interior lights
on as long as the battery has power
or until the ignition switch is turned
off;
• unlock the doors automatically;
• disconnect the battery with a
pyrotechnic charge.
Air Bag Deployment Result
The advanced front air bags are
designed to deflate immediately after
deployment.
If you do have a collision which
deploys the air bags, any or all of the
following may occur:
• The nylon air bag material may
sometimes cause abrasions and/or
skin reddening to the driver and
front passenger as the air bags
deploy and unfold.
• As the air bags deflate, you may see
some smoke-like particles. The
particles are a normal by-product of
the process that generates the
non-toxic gas used for air bag
inflation. These airborne particles
may irritate the skin, eyes, nose, or
throat. If these particles settle on
your clothing, follow the garment
manufacturer's instructions for
cleaning. Do not drive your vehicle
after the air bags have deployed. If
you are involved in another collision,
the air bags will not be in place to
protect you.
ENVIRONMENTAL!
Air bag inflation releases a small
amount of powder. This powder is not
harmful to the environment.
2
WARNING!
• Deployed air bags and seat belt
pretensioners cannot protect you in
another collision. Have the air bags,
seat belt pretensioners, and the
front seat belt retractor assemblies
replaced by a Maserati Service
Center. Also, have the Occupant
Restraint Controller (ORC) system
serviced as well.
• Have the air bag checked, serviced
and replaced only by an Authorized
Maserati Dealer.
Air Bag System Maintenance
WARNING!
• Modifications to any part of the air
bag system could cause it to fail;
thus you could be injured if the air
bag system is not there to protect
you. Do not modify the components
(Continued)
65
Before Starting
(Continued)
or wiring. Do not modify the front
bumper, vehicle body structure, or
add aftermarket side steps or
running boards.
2
• It is dangerous to try to repair any
part of the air bag system without
the necessary know-how.
• Do not attempt to modify any part
of your air bag system. The air bag
may inflate accidentally or may not
function properly if modifications
are made. Take your vehicle to the
Authorized Maserati Dealer for any
air bag system service. If your seat
including your trim cover and
cushion needs to be serviced in any
way (including removal or
loosening/tightening of seat
attachment bolts), take the vehicle
to the Authorized Maserati Dealer.
• Only Maserati manufacturer
approved seat accessories may be
used. If it is necessary to modify the
air bag system for persons with
disabilities, contact the Authorized
Maserati Dealer.
• If the speedometer, Rev Counter, or
any engine related gauges are not
working, the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC) may also be
disabled. The air bags may not be
66
ready to inflate for your protection.
Promptly check the fuse block for
blown fuses. To identify the air bag
fuse see “Fuse Replacement” in
section 7. See the Authorized
Maserati Dealer if the fuse is
efficient.
• As long as the air bag is activated,
persons with disabilities are advised
not to travel in the front seat in
order to avoid the risk of serious
injuries or death, even in minor
crashes.
Event Data Recorder (EDR)
Transport of persons with
disability
If it is necessary to modify the
advanced air bag system of your
vehicle to accommodate a person with
disabilities, contact an Authorized
Maserati Dealer.
WARNING!
• The advanced air bag system of your
vehicle is not designed to protect
adults with disabilities that require
deactivation of the passenger or
driver air bag.
• If you or another occupant is an
adult with a medical condition that
requires air bag deactivation, please
contact an Authorized Maserati
Dealer. For further information on
disabled driver or passengers see
http://www.safercar.gov.
This vehicle is equipped with an event
data recorder (EDR). The main purpose
of an EDR is to record, in certain crash
or near crash-like situations, such as an
air bag deployment or hitting a road
obstacle, data that will assist in
understanding how a vehicle’s systems
performed.
The EDR is designed to record data
related to vehicle dynamics and safety
systems for a short period of time,
typically 30 seconds or less.
The EDR in this vehicle is designed to
record such data as:
• how various systems in your vehicle
were operating;
• whether or not the driver and
passenger safety belts were
buckled/fastened;
• how far (if at all) the driver was
depressing the accelerator and/or
brake pedal; and
• how fast the vehicle was traveling.
Before Starting
These data can help provide a better
understanding of the circumstances in
which crashes and injuries occur.
NOTE:
EDR data are recorded by your vehicle
only if a non-trivial crash situation
occurs; no data are recorded by the
EDR under normal driving conditions
and no personal data (e.g., name,
gender, age, and crash location) are
recorded. However, other parties, such
as law enforcement, could combine
the EDR data with the type of
personally identifying data routinely
acquired during a crash investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR,
special equipment is required, and
access to the vehicle or the EDR is
needed.
In addition to the vehicle
manufacturer, other parties, such as
law enforcement, that have the
special equipment, can read the
information if they have access to
vehicle or the EDR.
Child Restraint Systems
Everyone in your vehicle must be
buckled up all the time, including
babies and children. Every state in the
United States and all Canadian
provinces require that small children
ride in proper restraint systems. Please
be reminded that you can be
prosecuted for ignoring this law.
Children 12 years or younger should
ride properly buckled up in a rear seat,
if available. According to crash
statistics, children are safer when
properly restrained in the rear seats
rather than in the front.
WARNING!
In a collision, an unrestrained child,
even a tiny baby, can become a
projectile inside the vehicle. The force
required to hold even an infant on
your lap could become so great that
you could not hold the child, no
matter how strong you are. The child
and others could be badly injured.
Any child riding in your vehicle should
be in a proper restraint system
suitable for the child’s size.
There are different sizes and types of
restraint systems for children from
newborn size to the child almost large
enough for an adult safety belt.
Always refer to the manual provided
with child seat to ensure it is the
proper type according the travelling
child. Use the restraint system that is
correct for your child.
2
Infants and Child Restraints
Safety experts recommend that
children ride rearwardfacing in the
vehicle until they are two years old or
until they reach either the height or
weight limit of their rear facing child
seat.
Two types of child restraint systems
can be used rearward-facing: infant
carriers and convertible child seats.
The infant carrier is only used
rearward-facing in the vehicle. It is
recommended for children from birth
until they reach the weight or height
limit of the infant carrier.
Convertible child seats can be used
either rearward-facing or
forward-facing in the vehicle.
Convertible child seats often have a
higher weight limit in the
rearward-facing direction than infant
carriers do, so they can be used
rearward-facing by children who have
outgrown their infant carrier but are
67
Before Starting
2
still younger than at least two years
old.
Children should remain rearwardfacing until they reach the highest
weight or height allowed by their child
seat. Both types of child restraint
systems are fixed to the car by the
lap/shoulder belt or the LATCH child
restraint anchor system. Refer to
“Lower Anchors and Tether for
CHildren (LATCH)” in this section.
WARNING!
• Never place a rear facing infant seat
in front of an air bag. A deploying
Passenger Advanced Front Air Bag
can cause death or serious injury to a
child 12 years or younger, including a
child in a rearward facing infant
seat.
• Only use a rearward-facing child
restraint in a vehicle with a rear seat.
Older Children and Child
Restraints
Children who are two years old or who
have outgrown their rear-facing child
seat can ride forward-facing in the
vehicle. Forward-facing child seats and
convertible child seats used in the
forward-facing direction are for
68
children who are over two years old or
who have outgrown the rear-facing
weight or height limit of their
rear-facing child seat.
Children should remain in a
forward-facing child seat with a
harness for as long as possible, up to
the highest weight or height allowed
by the child seat. These child seats are
also fixed to the car by the
lap/shoulder belt or the LATCH child
restraint anchorage system. Refer to
“Lower Anchors and Tether for
CHildren (LATCH)” in this section.
All children whose weight or height is
above the forward-facing limit for the
child seat should use a belt-positioning
booster seat until the vehicle’s seat
belts fit properly. If the child cannot sit
with knees bent over the vehicle’s seat
cushion while the back is against the
seatback, they should use a
belt-positioning booster seat.
The child and belt-positioning booster
seat are fixed to the car by the
lap/shoulder belt.
Children Too Large for Booster
Seats
Children who are large enough to
wear the shoulder belt comfortably
and whose legs are long enough to
bend over the front of the seat when
their back is against the seatback
should use the lap/shoulder belt in a
rear seat.
• Make sure that the child is upright in
the seat.
• The lap portion should be low on the
hips and as snug as possible.
• Check belt fit periodically. A child’s
squirming or slouching can move the
belt out of position.
• If the shoulder belt contacts the face
or neck, move the child closer to the
center of the vehicle. Never allow a
child to put the shoulder belt under
an arm or behind their back.
NOTE:
For additional information, refer to
www.seatcheck.org or call
1–866–SEATCHECK. Canadian residents
should refer to Transport Canada’s
website for additional information:
http://www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety/
safedrivers/childsafety/index.htm
WARNING!
• Improper installation can lead to
failure of an infant or child restraint.
It could come loose in a collision. The
(Continued)
Before Starting
(Continued)
child could be badly injured or killed.
Follow the manufacturer’s directions
exactly when installing an infant or
child restraint.
• A rearward-facing child restraint
should only be used in a rear seat. A
rearward-facing child restraint in the
front seat may be struck by a
deploying passenger air bag, which
may cause severe or fatal injury to
the infant.
Here are some tips on getting
the most out of your child
restraint
• Before buying any restraint system,
make sure that it has a label
certifying that it meets all applicable
Safety Standards. Maserati also
recommends that you make sure
that you can install the child
restraint in the vehicle where you
will use it before you buy it.
• The restraint system must be
appropriate for your child’s weight
and height.
• Check the label on the restraint
system for weight and height limits.
• Carefully follow the instructions that
come with the restraint system.
• If installed improperly, it may not
work when needed.
• Fit the child into the seat according
to the child restraint manufacturer’s
directions.
WARNING!
When your child restraint system is
not in use, secure it in the vehicle with
the seat belt or remove it from the
vehicle. Do not leave it loose in the
vehicle. In a sudden stop or accident,
it could strike the occupants or
seatbacks and cause serious personal
injury.
Installing Child Restraint
Systems using the Vehicle Seat
Belt equipped with ALR
The passenger seat belts are equipped
with an Automatic Locking Retractor
(ALR) to secure child protection
through a Child Restraint System
(CRS). These types of seat belts are
designed to keep the lap portion of
the seat belt tight around the child
restraint seat avoiding to use a locking
clip.
The ALR will make a ratcheting noise
if the entire belt is pulled out of the
retractor in order to enable the belt to
retract subsequently. For additional
information on ALR, see “Using Seat
Belt in Automatic Locking Retractor
(ALR) Mode ” in “Occupants Restraint
Systems” in this section.
To install a Child Restraint System with
ALR, pull enough of the belt out of
the retractor leading it through the
belt path of the protection device.
Slide the latch into the buckle until it
clicks, then remove the entire safety
belt from the retractor in order to
rewound. While rewinding a click will
indicate the safety belt is now in
Automatic Locking mode.
Exert then a traction on the exceeded
lap section of the belt in order to
tighten it around the child restraint
seat. All seat belts will loosen over
time, it is therefore necessary to check
them periodically and set them
properly.
2
Lower Anchors and Tether for
Children (LATCH)
Your vehicle's rear seats are all
equipped with the child restraint
anchorage system called LATCH.
The LATCH system allows the child
restraint systems to be fixed without
using the vehicle's seat belts, instead
fixing the child restraint system to the
69
Before Starting
vehicle structure, using lower A
anchorages and upper tether strap B.
of the seatback and seat cushion
surfaces.
LATCH-Compatible child restraint
systems are now available. You should
never install LATCH child seats so that
two seats share a common lower
anchorage.
If your child restraints are not
LATCH-Compatible, install the
restraints using the vehicle's seat belts.
In addition, there are tether strap
anchorages behind each rear seat. The
anchorages are located in the panel
between the rear seatback and the
rear window and are under a plastic
cover (indicated in the figure) with the
anchorage symbol on it.
2
• Route the seat belt to provide the
most direct path between the
anchorage and the child restraint
system passing it over the headrest.
• Attach the hook of the top tether
strap (provided with the child
restraint system) to the anchor.
Installing a LATCH- Compatible Child
Restraint System
Follow the child restraint
manufacturer's instructions provided
with the child restraint system.
The lower LATCH anchorages are “U”
metal rings located on the rear seat
where the cushion meets the seatback
and are located just below the symbol
shown in the picture, but are not
visible. You will easily feel them if you
run your finger along the intersection
70
• Secure the child seat to the “U”
lower metal rings positioned on the
rear seat;
• Fix the upper belt, also called Top
Tether (provided with the child seat),
to the attachments located in the
rear part of the backrest.
• Lift the plastic cover fitted behind
the seat where you want to install
the child restraint system.
To fix a LATCH-Compatible child
restraint seat proceed as follows.
Before Starting
NOTE:
For any further details on installation
and/or use, refer to the instructions
provided with the child seat.
• Tighten upper strap until you reach
the tension level recommended by
the restraint system manufacturer.
To fix a child restraint system on
center seating position introduce the
hook end of the tether strap between
the seatback and adjustable headrest
(with the headrest in the full up
position) then attach the hook to the
anchor located in the panel between
the rear seatback and the rear
window.
WARNING!
• A child seat should be fitted only
when the car is stationary. Follow
the instructions for assembly,
disassembly and positioning that
the manufacturer must supply with
the child restraint system.
• An incorrectly anchored tether strap
could lead to increased head motion
and possible injury to the child. Use
only the anchor position directly
behind the child seat to secure a
child restraint top tether strap.
WARNING!
• Improper installation of a child
restraint system to the LATCH
anchorages can lead to failure of an
infant or child restraint. The child
could be badly injured or killed.
Follow the child restraint
manufacturer's directions exactly
when installing an infant or child
restraint system.
2
• Child restraint anchorages are
designed to withstand only those
loads imposed by correctly fitted
child restraints. Under no
circumstances are they to be used
for adult seat belts, harnesses, or for
attaching other items or equipment
to the vehicle.
NOTE:
• Ensure that the tether strap does not
slip into the opening between the
seatbacks as you remove slack in the
strap.
• When using a LATCH-Compatible
child restraint system, please ensure
that all seat belts not being used for
occupant restraints are stowed and
out of reach of children.
71
Before Starting
2
72
Transporting Pets
ParkSense® Park Assist
Park Assist Sensors
Air bags deploying in the front seat
could harm your pet. An unrestrained
pet will be thrown about and possibly
injured, or injure a passenger during
panic braking or in an accident.
Pets should be restrained in the rear
seat in pet harnesses or pet carriers
that are secured by the vehicle seat
belts.
The ParkSense® Park Assist (hereafter
called “Park Assist”) system provides
visual and audible indications of the
distance between the rear and/or front
bumper and a detected obstacle when
backing up or moving forward, e.g.
during a parking maneuver.
Refer to “Park Assist System Usage
Precautions” for limitations of this
system and recommendations.
Park Assist system will retain the last
system state (enabled or disabled)
from the last ignition cycle when the
ignition is changed to the RUN
position.
The Park Assist system is active only
when the shift lever is in R (Reverse) or
D (Drive).
If Park Assist is enabled at one of these
shift lever positions, the system will
remain active until the vehicle speed is
increased to approximately 7 mph
(11 km/h) or above. The system will
become active again if the vehicle
speed is decreased to speeds less than
approximately 6 mph (9 km/h).
The four Park Assist sensors, located in
the rear bumper, monitor the area
behind the vehicle that is within the
sensor's field of view. The sensors can
detect obstacles up to approximately
60 in (150 cm) from the rear bumper in
the horizontal direction, depending on
the location, type and orientation of
the obstacle.
The six Park Assist sensors, located in
the front bumper, monitor the area in
front of the vehicle that is within the
sensor's field of view.
Before Starting
The sensors can detect obstacles up to
a distance of approximately 50 in
(120 cm) from the front bumper in the
horizontal direction, depending on
the location, type and orientation of
the obstacle.
Park Assist Warning Messages
Display
The Park Assist Warning screen will
only be displayed if “Sound and
Display” is selected from the MTC
System. Refer to “MTC Settings” in
section 4 for further information.
The Park Assist Warning screen is
located on the instrument cluster
display.
It provides visual warnings to indicate
the distance between the front/rear
bumper and the detected obstacle.
The warning display will turn on
indicating the system status (Ready or
Off) when the vehicle is in R (Reverse)
or in D (Drive) and an obstacle has
been detected.
2
The system will indicate a detected
obstacle by displaying three fixed light
arcs while beeping for a one-half
second. The color indicates the
distance and the arc indicates the
position of the detected obstacle. The
amber color of the arc indicates the
medium and maximum distance, while
the red color indicates the minimum
distance.
As the vehicle moves closer to the
object the instrument cluster will
display the arc moving towards the
vehicle and the sound tone will
change from slow, to fast, to
continuous.
The vehicle is close to an obstacle
when the instrument cluster displays
one flashing red arc only, combined
with a continuous sound.
73
Before Starting
The following chart shows the warning
alert visualization when the system is
detecting an obstacle.
NOTE:
Park Assist will turn off the front park
assist audible alert (chime) after
approximately 4 seconds when an
obstacle has been detected, the vehicle
is stationary, and brake pedal is
applied.
2
Warning Alerts
Rear distance
More than 60 in (150 cm)
60-40 in (150-100 cm)
Front distance
More than 50 in (120 cm)
50-40 in (120-100 cm)
40-24 in
(100-60 cm)
40-14 in
(60-35 cm)
Less than 14 in
(35 cm)
Audible Alert
None
Single (rear only)
Slow (rear only)
Fast
Continuous
Arc-Type lights number
None
3 - Solid
3 - Flash
2 - Flash
1 - Flash
-
Amber
Amber
Amber
Red
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Arc color
Radio Mute
74
Before Starting
Enabling and Disabling Park
Assist
Park Assist can be enabled and
disabled using the MTC System. The
available choices are: “Off”, “Sound
Only”, or “Sound and Display”. See
“MTC Settings” in section 3 for further
information.
When the Park Assist soft-key is
pressed to disable the system, the
instrument cluster will display the
“Park Assist System disabled” message
for approximately five seconds. See
“Instrument Cluster” in section 4 for
further information.
When the shift lever is moved to R
(Reverse) or to D (Drive) at a speed of
7 mph (11 km/h) or below and the
system is disabled, the instrument
cluster will display the “Park Assist
off” message for approximately five
seconds in R (Reverse) or for 5 seconds
when the vehicle is in D (Drive).
Servicing Park Assist System
In case of malfunction of the Park
Assist System, the instrument cluster
will actuate a single sound, once per
ignition cycle. The instrument cluster
will display a message when any of
the rear or front sensor(s) are blocked
by snow, mud, or ice and the vehicle is
shifted into R (Reverse) or D (Drive).
The instrument cluster will display the
“Service Park Assist Sensors” message
when any of the rear or front sensors
are damaged and require service.
When the shift lever is moved to R
(Reverse) or D (Drive) and the system
has detected a faulted condition, the
instrument cluster will display the
corresponding message for the time
lapse the vehicle is in R (Reverse) or D
(Drive) at speeds less than 7 mph
(11 km/h). Under this condition Park
Assist will not operate. See
“Instrument Cluster” in section 4 for
further information.
If “...Wipe Off...” displays on the
instrument cluster make sure the
outer surface and the underside of the
rear bumper and/or front bumper is
clean and clear of snow, ice, mud, dirt
or other obstruction and then cycle
the ignition switch. If the message
continues to appear contact an
Authorized Maserati Dealer.
2
If “Service Park Assist Sensors” or
“Park Assist Unavailable Service
Required” display on the instrument
cluster, contact an Authorized
Maserati Dealer.
Cleaning the Park Assist
Sensors
When cleaning the sensors, take
special care not to scratch or damage
them; therefore, do not use dry, rough
or hard cloths.
The sensors must be washed with
clean water, possibly adding car
shampoo.
Should you need to repaint the
bumper or in case of paint touch-ups
in the sensor area, please contact an
Authorized Maserati Dealer. Incorrect
paint application could affect the
parking sensors operation.
75
Before Starting
Park Assist System Usage
Precautions
looks over his/her shoulder when
using Park Assist.
NOTE:
2
• Jackhammers, large trucks, and other
vibrations could affect the
performance of Park Assist.
• Objects such as bicycle carriers, trailer
hitches, etc., should not be placed
within 12 in (30 cm) from the rear
bumper while driving the vehicle.
Failure to do so can result in the
system misinterpreting a close object
as a sensor problem, causing the
Service Park Assist message to be
displayed in the instrument cluster.
CAUTION!
• Park Assist is only a parking aid and
is unable to recognize every obstacle,
including small ones. Parking curbs
might only be temporarily detected
or not detected at all. Obstacles
located above or below the sensors
will not be detected when they are
in close proximity.
• The vehicle must be driven slowly
when using Park Assist in order to be
able to stop in time when an
obstacle is detected. When backing
up, it is recommended that the driver
76
WARNING!
Drivers must be careful when backing
up even when using the Park Assist
system. Always check carefully behind
your vehicle, look behind you, and be
sure to check for pedestrians, animals,
other vehicles, obstructions, and blind
spots before backing up. You are
responsible for safety and must
continue to pay attention to your
surroundings. Failure to do so can
result in serious injury or death.
ParkView® Rear View
Camera
This vehicle is equipped with the
ParkView® Rear View Camera that
allows the driver to see an image on
the MTC screen of the rear
surroundings of the vehicle when the
gear lever is put into R (Reverse).
The image is displayed along with a
caution note to “Check Entire
Surroundings” across the top of the
screen. After five seconds this note will
disappear.
The ParkView® camera is located in
the rear of the vehicle above the
license plate.
When the gear lever is shifted out of R
(Reverse), the rear camera mode is
exited and the navigation or audio
screen appears again.
When displayed, static grid lines will
illustrate the width of the vehicle
while a dashed center-line will indicate
the center of the vehicle to assist with
parking or aligning to a hitch/receiver.
The static grid lines will show separate
zones in different colors that will help
indicate the distance to the rear of the
vehicle.
Before Starting
The following table shows the
approximate distances for each zone
and color:
Zone
Distance to the rear of the
vehicle
Red
0 - 12 in (0 - 30 cm)
Yellow
12 - 40 in (30 cm - 1 m)
Green
40 in (1 m) or greater
surroundings and must continue to be
careful while reversing. Failure to do
so can result in serious injury or
death.
CAUTION!
• To avoid vehicle damage, ParkView®
should be used only as a parking aid.
The ParkView® camera is unable to
view every obstacle or object in your
driving path.
• To avoid vehicle damage, the vehicle
must be driven slowly when using
ParkView® to be able to stop in time
when an obstacle is seen. It is
recommended that the driver look
frequently over his/her shoulder
when using ParkView®.
ParkView® On/Off
• Turn the MTC on.
• Press and release the “Settings”
soft-key.
• Press and release the “Safety &
Driving Assistance” soft-key.
• Press the check box soft key next to
“Parkview Backup Camera” to
enable/disable it.
2
NOTE:
WARNING!
Drivers must be careful when
reversing even when using the
ParkView® Rear View Camera. Always
check carefully behind your vehicle,
and be sure to check for pedestrians,
animals, other vehicles, obstructions,
or blind spots before reversing. You
are responsible for the safety of your
If snow, ice, mud, or any other
substance builds up on the camera
lens, clean the lens, rinse with water,
and dry with a soft cloth. Do not cover
the lens.
77
Before Starting
Safety Tips
Exhaust Gas
Transporting Passengers
2
WARNING!
• Do not leave children or animals
inside parked vehicles in hot
weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury.
• It is extremely dangerous to ride in a
cargo area, inside of a vehicle. In a
collision, people riding in these areas
are more likely to be seriously
injured.
• Do not allow people to ride in any
area of your vehicle that is not
equipped with seats and seat belts.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in
a seat and using a seat belt properly.
WARNING!
Exhaust gases can injure. They contain
carbon monoxide (CO), which is
colorless and odorless. Breathing it
can make you unconscious and can
eventually poison you. To avoid
breathing (CO), follow these safety
tips:
• Do not run the engine in a closed
garage or in confined areas any
longer than needed to move your
vehicle in or out of the area.
• If it is necessary to sit in a parked
vehicle with the engine running,
adjust your heating or cooling
controls to force outside air into the
vehicle. Set the blower at high
speed.
• If you are required to drive with the
trunk/liftgate open, make sure that
all windows are closed and the
climate control blowers switch is set
at high speed. DO NOT use the
recirculation mode.
78
The best protection against carbon
monoxide entry into the passenger
compartment is a properly maintained
engine exhaust system.
Whenever detecting a change in the
sound of the exhaust system or
eventual exhaust fumes inside the
vehicle have an Authorized Maserati
Dealer inspect the complete exhaust
system and adjacent body areas for
broken, damaged, deteriorated, or
mispositioned parts.
Open seams or loose connections could
permit exhaust fumes to seep into the
passenger compartment.
WARNING!
CALIFORNIA proposition 65.
Engine exhaust, some of its
constituents, and certain vehicle
components contain or emit chemicals
known to the state of California to
cause cancer, and birth defects or
other reproductive harm. In addition,
certain fluids contained in vehicles and
certain products of component wear
contain or emit chemicals known to
the State of California to cause cancer,
and birth defects or other
reproductive harm.
Before Starting
Vehicle Safety Checks
Seat Belts
• Inspect the belt system periodically,
checking for cuts, frays, and loose
parts. Damaged parts must be
replaced immediately.
• Do not disassemble or modify the
system.
• If the belt has been sharply pulled,
for example as the result of an
accident, the safety belt, together
with the anchoring devices, the
anchoring device mounting screws
and the pretensioner (if available)
must be completely replaced. Even if
the belt does not present any
exterior signs of wear or damage, it
may have lost its restraining
properties.
Air Bag Warning Light
The
light should illuminate and
remain lit for a few seconds bulb
checking when the ignition switch is
pushed in RUN position (see
“Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
— Air bags” chapter in this section).
• If the light
does not illuminate
while starting, contact an
Authorized Maserati Dealer.
• If the light stays on, flickers, or
comes on while driving, have the
system checked by an Authorized
Maserati Dealer.
WARNING!
Certain components of this vehicle
such as air bag modules, seat belt
pretensioners, adaptive steering
columns, and button cell batteries
may contain Perchlorate material.
Special handling may apply for service
or vehicle end of life disposal. See
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/
perchlorate.
Floor Mats
Always use floor mats designed to fit
the footwell of your vehicle. Use only
floor mats that leave the pedal area
unobstructed and that are firmly
secured so that they cannot slip out of
position and interfere with the pedals
or impair safe operation of your
vehicle in other ways.
2
NOTE:
The Authorized Maserati Dealer can
provide you with any information
about the available Maserati floor
mats included in the Genuine
Accessories range.
Defroster
Check operation by selecting the
defrost mode and place the blower
system on high speed (see “Air
Conditioning Controls” chapter in
section 4).
You should be able to feel the air
directed against the windshield and
front side windows. Contact an
Authorized Maserati Dealer for service
if your defroster is inoperable.
WARNING!
Pedals that cannot move freely can
cause loss of vehicle control and
increase the risk of serious personal
injury.
• Always make sure that floor mats
are properly attached to the proper
fasteners.
• Never place or install floor mats or
other floor coverings in the vehicle
that cannot be properly secured to
prevent them from moving and
(Continued)
79
Before Starting
(Continued)
interfering with the pedals or the
ability to control the vehicle.
2
• Never put floor mats or other floor
coverings on top of already installed
floor mats. Additional floor mats and
other coverings will reduce the size
of the pedal area and interfere with
the pedals.
• Check mounting of mats on a regular
basis. Always properly reinstall and
secure floor mats that have been
removed for cleaning.
• Always make sure that objects
cannot fall into the driver footwell
while the vehicle is moving. Objects
can become trapped under the brake
pedal and accelerator pedal causing
a loss of vehicle control.
• Mounting posts must be properly
installed, if not equipped from the
factory. Failure to properly follow
floor mat installation or mounting
can cause interference with the
brake pedal and accelerator pedal
operation causing loss of control of
the vehicle.
80
Tires
Lights and Indicator Lights
• Examine tires for excessive tread
wear and uneven wear patterns.
• Check for stones, nails, glass, or other
objects lodged in the tread or
sidewall.
• Inspect tire tread for cuts and cracks.
• Inspect sidewalls for cuts, cracks and
bulges.
• Check lug nuts for tightness.
• Check the tires (see “Tire Inflation
Pressure” chapter in section 8) for
proper cold inflation pressure.
• Have someone observe the operation
of exterior lights while you operate
the controls (see “Lights” chapter in
section 3).
• Check turn signal and high beam
indicator lights on the instrument
panel (see “Instrument Cluster”
chapter in section 4).
WARNING!
Driving over rough or damaged road
surfaces, as well as debris, curbs and
other obstacles can cause serious
damage to wheels, tires, and
suspension parts. This is more likely to
occur with low-profile tires, which
provide less cushioning between the
wheel and the road. Be careful to
avoid road hazards and reduce your
speed, especially if your vehicle is
equipped with low-profile tires.
Fluid Leaks
Door Latches
• Check for positive closing, latching,
and locking of doors and trunk lid
(see “Unlock Power Doors and Trunk
Lid with Key fob” chapter in this
section).
• After parking overnight check under
the vehicle for recent fluid leaks (oil,
fuel, etc.).
• If gasoline fumes are detected or
fluid leaks are suspected, contact an
Authorized Maserati Dealer.
3 – Understanding the Vehicle
Interior Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Driver Memory Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
“Comfort Luxury” Rear Seats (optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Power Tilt/Telescoping Steering Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Adjustable Pedals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Rear-View Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Windshield Wipers and Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Interior Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Cargo Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Power Sunroof with Sunshade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
HomeLink (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Air Conditioning Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
81
Understanding the Vehicle
Interior Components
Dashboard Components
3
82
Understanding the Vehicle
1
Adjustable side air outlets.
2
Engine START/STOP button.
3
Headlight switch.
4
Light dimmer controls.
5
Steering wheel controls.
6
Instrument cluster.
7*
Right shift paddle +.
8*
Left shift paddle –.
Central Console Components
4
Cover for compartment with
AUX and USB port.
5
Cover for cup holder and
power socket compartment.
6
Unlock button for central
console with cup holder and
power outlet.
7
Central console covers with
armrest function.
Air outlets (adjustable).
9
Hood release.
8
10
Adjustable central air outlets.
9
11
Analog clock.
Rear power sunshade and rear
seats comfort controls panel.
12
MTC display.
10
Storage compartment.
13
Hazard lights switch.
11
14
Climate controls.
Rear climate controls panel for
four-zone air conditioner
(optional).
15
SD Memory card slot.
16
CD/DVD slot.
17
Internal rear view mirror.
18
Front dome console.
19
Storage compartment handle.
20
Storage compartment.
21
Dashboard glove box handle.
22
Dashboard storage
compartment.
(*) If foreseen.
Dual-zone A/C
3
Four-zone A/C
1
Automatic transmission shift
lever.
2
Drive mode switches.
3
Electric Parking Brake lever.
83
Understanding the Vehicle
Components between the Rear
Seats
11*
12 V, 115 V power outlet and
USB port.
(*) For optional “Comfort Luxury”
rear seats version.
3
“Comfort Luxury” rear seats
1
Armrest cup holder covers
unlock button.
2
Armrest compartment unlock
button with power outlet.
“Comfort Luxury” rear seats
84
3*
Cup holder compartment lid.
4*
Rear seats comfort controls
panel on rear storage
compartment.
5*
Front and rear right seat
adjustment controls.
6*
Left rear seat adjustment
control.
7*
Four-zones A/C controls panel
(*).
8*
Unlock button for covers on
rear central console.
9*
Storage covers with armrest
function.
10*
Reclining shelf to access
storage box between the rear
seats.
Understanding the Vehicle
Front Doors Components
Rear Doors Components
4
Passenger power window
switch.
5
Power door unlocks/locks,
passenger door.
6
Trunk lid release.
7
Loudspeakers.
8
Storage compartment.
9
Internal door lock/unlock knob.
10
Door panel grip.
11
Reflex reflector.
12
Outside door handle.
13
Door lock button with “Passive
Entry” function.
1
Inside rear door handle.
2
Grip.
14
Door outboard opening lock.
3
Loudspeaker.
4
Door storage pockets.
5
Power window and power
doors lock/unlock buttons.
6
“Child protection” door lock
system.
3
7
Inside door lock/unlock knob.
1
Inside door handle.
8
Reflex reflector.
2
Driver’s seat and rear mirrors
memory switch.
9
Outside door handle.
3
Rear view mirrors, power
windows and power switches
door unlocks/locks switches
panel.
85
Understanding the Vehicle
Front Seats
To manually lift or lower the head
restraints press the indicated lateral
button.
Seats and seat belts are part of the
Occupant Restraint System of the
vehicle.
3
WARNING!
Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a
seat and using a seat belt properly.
Seat Forward/Rearward Adjustment
Front Power Seats
The switches of the power seats are
located on the outboard side of the
seat cushion.
Use these two front switches to move
the driver's seat up or down, forward
or rearward or to recline the seat
cushion and the seatback.
Use the rear switch to adjust the
lumbar support.
The seat can be adjusted both forward
and rearward.
Push the seat switch 1 forward or
rearward, the seat will move in the
direction of the switch.
Release the switch 1 when the desired
position is reached.
Seat Up/Down Adjustment
The height of the seat can be adjusted
up- or downward. Grip switch 1 from
the back side and push it down or up.
Release the switch 1 when the desired
position is reached.
CAUTION!
If the seat's movement does not work,
make sure that the corresponding fuse
is not tripped (see chapter “Fuse
Replacement” in section 7).
WARNING!
• Sitting in a reclining position while
the vehicle is in motion could be
dangerous. The seatback should not
be tilted back too far.
• The 3–point shoulder/lap belt must be
firmly secured against the occupant's
body in order to function properly.
Therefore, both the driver's and
passenger's reclining seatbacks must
always be in an upright position while
the vehicle is in motion; otherwise the
3–point shoulder/lap belt would not
remain firmly positioned against the
occupant's body. Serious injury could
result!
(Continued)
86
Understanding the Vehicle
(Continued)
• Remember that the head restraints
must be positioned so that their
upper edge is aligned with the top
of the occupant’s head. In fact, only
in this position can they provide the
support required in the event of a
bumper-to-tail collision.
Seat Tilt Control (Up/Down)
The angle of the seat cushion can be
adjusted in four directions.
Pull upward or push the front of the
switch 1, to move the front cushion
seat in the direction of the switch.
Release the switch 1 when the desired
position is reached.
Power Lumbar
Push the switch 3 forward or rearward
to increase or decrease the lumbar
support.
Push the switch 3 upward or
downward to raise or lower the
lumbar support.
WARNING!
• Never adjust the seat while driving.
You could lose control of the vehicle.
Moving the seat could distract you
or make you press a pedal
unintentionally.
• Seats should be adjusted before
fastening the seat belts and while
the vehicle is parked.
3
• Do not ride with the seatback
reclined so that the shoulder belt is
no longer resting against your chest.
In a collision you could slide under
the seat belt, which could result in
serious injury or death.
Seat Back Tilt Control
The angle of the seatback can be
adjusted forward or rearward.
Push the seatback switch 2 forward or
rearward, the upper seatback will
move in the direction of the switch.
Release the switch 2 when the desired
position is reached.
CAUTION!
Do not place any object under a
power seat or obstruct its movement
as it may cause damage to the seat
controls. Seat movement may become
limited if there is an obstruction.
87
Understanding the Vehicle
3
Front Heated Seats
Front Seats Heat Function
The front seats are equipped with
heaters in both seat cushions and
seatbacks.
The front seats heating is operated by
the MTC System.
NOTE:
WARNING!
• Persons with low skin sensitivity
because of advanced age, chronic
illness, diabetes, spinal cord injury,
medication, alcohol use, exhaustion
or other physical conditions must be
careful when using the seat heater. It
may cause burns even at low
temperatures, especially if used for
long periods of time.
• Do not place anything on the seat
that insulates against heat, such as a
blanket or cushion. This may cause
the seat heater to overheat. Sitting
in a seat that has been overheated
could cause serious burns due to the
increased surface temperature of the
seat.
88
The engine must be running for the
heated seats to operate.
• Touch the “Controls” soft-key on the
lower part of the MTC display.
• Within 15 seconds, touch the
“Driver” or “Passenger” seat soft-key
once to select HI-level heating.
NOTE:
Once a heat setting is selected, heat
will be felt within two to five minutes.
• Within 15 seconds, touch the same
soft-key a second time to select
LO-level heating.
• Within 15 seconds, touch the same
soft-key a third time to shut the
heating elements OFF.
When the HI-level setting is selected,
the heater will provide a boosted heat
level during the first four minutes of
operation.
Then, the heat output will drop to the
normal HI-level.
If the HI-level setting is selected, the
system will automatically switch to
LO-level after a maximum of 60
minutes of continuous operation.
At that time, the display will indicate
the change from HI to LO.
The LO-level setting will turn OFF
automatically after a maximum of
approximately 45 minutes.
Understanding the Vehicle
Front Ventilated Seats
(optional)
Driver Memory Seat
NOTE:
The engine must be running for the
ventilated seats to operate.
To enhance occupant's comfort by
high external temperatures, both the
driver and passenger seats, on request,
can be ventilated.
Small fans are located in the seat
cushion and seatback, that draw air
from the seat surface through fine
perforations in the seat cover to help
keep the driver and front passenger
cooler when the temperature is high.
The ventilated seats are operated with
the MTC System.
Front Ventilated Seats Function
• Touch the “Control's” soft-key on
the lower part of the MTC display.
• Within 15 seconds, touch the
“Driver” or “Passenger” seat
soft-key once to select HI-level
ventilation.
• Within 15 seconds, touch the same
soft-key a second time to select
LO-level ventilation.
• Within 15 seconds, touch the same
soft-key a third time to shut off the
seat ventilation.
This feature allows the driver to store
up to two different memory profiles
for easy recall through a memory
switch. Each memory profile contains
desired position settings for the driver
seat, external side mirrors, adjustable
pedals, power tilt and telescopic
steering column and a set of
programmed radio stations.
Your key fob RKE transmitter can also
be set to recall the same positions by
pressing the button.
3
NOTE:
• Only one key fob RKE transmitter
can be linked to each of the memory
positions.
• Passive Entry door handles cannot be
linked to the memory function. Use
either the memory recall switch or
the key fob RKE transmitter (if
linked to the memory feature) to
recall memory positions 1 or 2.
The memory seat switch is located on
the driver's door trim panel. The
switch consists of three buttons:
• The “S” (SET) button, which is used
to activate the memory save
function.
89
Understanding the Vehicle
• The “1” and “2” buttons which are
used to recall either of two
programmed memory profiles.
• Within five seconds, press and
release the MEMORY button “1” or
“2”. The instrument cluster display
will show which memory position has
been set.
3.
NOTE:
Memory profiles can be set without
the vehicle in P (Park), but the vehicle
must be in P (Park) to recall a memory
profile.
3
Memory Profiles Setting
NOTE:
Saving a new memory profile will
erase an existing profile from memory.
To create a new memory profile,
perform the following:
• Cycle the ignition switch to the RUN
position.
• Adjust all memory profile settings to
desired preferences (i.e., seat, side
mirrors, adjustable pedals, power tilt
and telescopic steering column, and
radio station presets).
• Press and release the “S” button on
the memory switch.
90
Pairing Remote Keyless Entry
Transmitter to Seats Memory
Your key fob with RKE transmitters can
be programmed to recall one of two
programmed memory profiles by
pressing the button on the RKE
transmitter.
To program your key fobs RKE
transmitter, perform the following
actions:
1.
Cycle the ignition switch to the
OFF position.
2.
Select the desired memory
profile that you wish to activate
from the transmitter by pressing
the button “1” or “2”.
4.
Once the profile has been
recalled, press and release the
“S” button on the memory
switch, then press and release
button “1” or “2” accordingly.
“Memory Profile Set” 1 or 2 will
display in the instrument cluster.
Press and release the
button
on key fob RKE transmitter
within 10 seconds.
NOTE:
Your key fobs RKE transmitter can be
unlinked to your memory settings by
pressing the “S” button followed by
the
button on the key fob RKE
transmitter in Step 4 above.
Memory Position Recall
NOTE:
The vehicle must be in P (Park) to recall
memory positions. If a recall is
attempted when the vehicle is not in P
(Park), the message “Memory System
Unavailable Vehicle Not in Park” will
display in the instrument cluster.
Understanding the Vehicle
To recall the memory settings for
driver, press MEMORY button number
“1” or “2” on the driver's door trim
panel or the button on the RKE
transmitter linked to memory position
1 or 2.
A recall can be canceled by pressing
any of the MEMORY buttons (“S”, “1”,
or “2”) during a recall. When a recall
is canceled, the driver seat, external
side mirrors, adjustable pedals and
power tilt and telescopic steering
column stop moving.
A delay of at least one second will
occur before selecting a new recall.
Easy ENTRY/EXIT Seat
This feature provides automatic driver
seat positioning to enhance driver
mobility when entering and exiting
the vehicle.
The distance the driver seat moves
depends on where you have the driver
seat positioned when you place the
ignition switch to the OFF position.
• When you cycle the ignition to the
OFF position the driver seat:
• will move to a position of ca.
0.31 in (8 mm) forward of the rear
stop if the driver seat position is
between 0.9 in (23 mm) and
2.67 in (68 mm) forward of the
rear stop.
• The seat will return to its previously
set position when you place the
ignition into the ACC or RUN
position.
• The Easy Entry/Easy Exit feature is
disabled when the driver seat
position is less than 0.9 in (23 mm)
forward of the rear stop. In this
position, there would be no benefit
to the driver by moving the seat for
Easy Exit or Easy Entry.
Each stored memory setting will have
an associated Easy Entry and Easy Exit
position.
NOTE:
The Easy Entry/Easy Exit feature can be
enabled or disabled using the MTC
System, refer to “MTC Settings” in
section 4 for further information.
Rear Seats
On standard version vehicles, rear
seats can fit three passengers. Side
seats are equipped with heating
resistances.
Seats and seat belts are parts of the
occupant restraint system of the
vehicle.
3
WARNING!
Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in
a seat and using a seat belt properly.
NOTE:
• See chapter “Occupants Restraint
Systems” in section 2 for seat belt
positioning.
• For vehicles equipped with “Comfort
Luxury” rear seats with rear console
storage compartment, refer to
chapter “Comfort Luxury Rear Seats”
in this section.
• will move about 2.36 in (60 mm)
rearward if the driver seat position
is greater than or equal to ca. 2.67
in (68 mm) forward of the rear
stop;
91
Understanding the Vehicle
Rear Head Restraints
3
Side seats are equipped with fixed
head restraints.
The center seat head restraint has two
positions, up or down.
When the center seat is being
occupied the head restraint should be
in the raised position.
When there are no occupants in the
center seat the head restraint can be
lowered in order to provide the driver
maximum visibility.
• To raise the head restraint, pull
upward on the head restraint. For
easier operation, lower the rear
armrest as described in the following
paragraph.
• To lower the head restraint, press the
push button, located at the bottom
of the head restraint, and push
downward on the head restraint.
92
Inside the armrest there is an
illuminated glove or document
compartment. Pressing the opening
button and lifting the cover of the
armrest box you access a 12 V power
outlet and USB port: a tablet plug may
be installed.
Rear Armrest
The rear armrest is mobile and can be
folded up into the seat back.
• To lower it, pull the stripe as
indicated.
• To close it, pull it upwards then push
it back into its seat.
On the front part of the armrest there
are two cup holders (see “Interior
Features” in this section).
• To close the compartment, lower the
cover.
Understanding the Vehicle
CAUTION!
The armrest is not designed to support
the weight of an adult or a child:
please use it only to store beverages,
small objects or documents.
Rear Side Heated Seats
(optional for V6 Engine)
The side rear seats are equipped with
heaters both in seat cushion and
seatback.
Rear seats heating can be adjusted by
operating control devices on the
instrument panel located on the rear
side of the central console. The panel
also includes commands for the rear
window sunshade (see “Power
Sunshades on Rear Windows” in
section 2) and optional commands for
ventilation (see “Comfort Luxury Rear
Seats” in this section).
• Do not place anything on the seat
that insulates against heat, such as
seat covers, blanket or cushion. This
may cause the seat heater to
overheat. Sitting in a seat that has
been overheated could cause serious
burns due to the increased surface
temperature of the seat.
The buttons on the instrument panel
with the resistance icon activate the
heating on one or both seats.
• Push the button once to select the
highest heating level. The upper LED
located on the side of the icon will
illuminate.
• Push the same button a second time
to select the lowest level. The lower
LED will illuminate.
• Push the same button a third time to
shut the heating elements OFF. The
LED will turn off.
NOTE:
• Once a heat setting is selected, heat
will be felt within two to five
minutes.
• The engine must be running for the
heated seats to operate.
By selecting the HI-level setting, the
heater will provide a boosted heat
level during the first four minutes of
operation. Then, the heat output will
drop to the normal HI-level.
By setting the HI-level, the system will
automatically switch to LO-level after
a maximum of 60 minutes of
continuous operation. The LO-level
setting will turn off automatically
after a maximum of approximately 45
minutes.
3
WARNING!
• Persons with skin sensitivity or
other physical conditions must be
careful when using the seat heater.
It may cause burns even at low
temperatures, especially if used for
long periods of time.
93
Understanding the Vehicle
“Comfort Luxury” Rear
Seats (optional)
3
This vehicle can be equipped with two
rear seats equipped with ventilation
and a heating power regulation
system. In this version, the center rear
seat is occupied by a central console
with several features, a compartment
and a small instrument panel to
control rear seats, four-zones air
conditioning and the sunshade on the
rear window.
A reclining shelf positioned centrally
between both back rests enables
access to power outlets and USB port.
Beside the heating regulation system
designed for a better comfort at high
external temperatures, as described in
the previous paragraph, the rear seats
can be ventilated as well. The seat
cushion and seatback are equipped
with small fans drawing air from the
seat surface through fine perforations
in the seat cover to help keep the
driver and front passenger’s bodies
cooler in case of high temperature.
Seat Setting Devices
Rear seat controls operating forward and
backward adjustments are positioned on
both sides of the central console storage
compartment. By moving the seat
forward or backward, you can change
the tilt of the backrest as well.
CAUTION!
If the seat's movement does not work,
make sure that the corresponding fuse
is not tripped (see chapter “Fuse
Replacement” in section 7).
Head Restraint Manual Adjustment
The head restraints can be tilted and
their height adjusted manually in four
positions. Lift the head restraint to the
correct position. To lower it, press the
button located at the bottom of the
head restraint.
The rear passenger sitting on the side
opposite to the driver can move the
front passenger seat by using the rear
command.
WARNING!
Remember that the head restraints
must be positioned so that their upper
edge is aligned with the top of the
(Continued)
94
Understanding the Vehicle
(Continued)
occupant’s head. In fact, only in this
position can they provide the support
required in the event of a
bumper-to-tail collision.
heating. The lower LED will
illuminate.
• Push the same button a third time to
shut the heating and ventilation
elements OFF. The LED will turn off.
Instrument Panel on the Rear
Central Console
Central Console Features
On the front part of the rear central
console there is a cup holder, to open
it press the cover as pointed out in the
picture.
To close it, lower the cover to the
console support.
The instrument panel on the rear
central console storage compartment
is divided into two areas:
3
• The front area with the control
buttons for the rear seats comfort
level and the sunshade on the rear
window (see “Rear Window” in
section 2).
• The rear area with the control
buttons for the four-zone air
conditioning system (see “Air
Conditioning Controls” in section 4).
The buttons labeled with a blowerand a resistance icon are used for
ventilation and/or heating control on
one or on both seats.
• Push the button once to select High
level ventilation and/or heating. The
upper LED beside of the icon will
illuminate.
• Push the same button a second time
to select LO-level ventilation and/or
NOTE:
The engine must be running for the
ventilated seats to operate.
By pressing the indicated button and
opening the half-lids used as armrests,
you can access the internal area of the
storage compartment.
95
Understanding the Vehicle
3
The compartment is supplied with
air-conditioned like the rest of the
passenger compartment.
The illuminated area of the storage
compartment includes: a 12 V power
socket/cigarette lighter, a button to
exclude the air-conditioning of the
compartment and two holders for
bottle, can or cups.
NOTE:
For further information see “Interior
Features” in this section.
Reclining Shelf Rear Accessories
To access devices centrally between the
backrests, tilt the reclining shelf
downwards.
On request, an additional 115 V power
outlet can be fitted.
Behind the reclining shelf, you may
access a power source of 12 V and a
USB high capacity port for charging
portable devices.
NOTE:
For further information see “Interior
Features” in this section.
96
Understanding the Vehicle
Power Tilt/Telescoping
Steering Wheel
This feature allows you to power tilt
the steering column upward or
downward or to lengthen or shorten
it in order to adjust the steering wheel
to an optimized position.
The power tilt/telescoping steering
column/wheel switch is located on the
lower left side of the steering column.
To adjust the tilt of the steering
column/wheel, move the switch up or
down as desired.
NOTE:
You can use your key fob with RKE
transmitter or the memory buttons on
the driver's door trim panel to return
the tilt/telescopic steering
column/wheel to programmed
positions. See “Driver Memory Seat”
in section 3.
WARNING!
Do not adjust the steering
column/wheel while driving.
Adjusting the steering column/wheel
while driving could cause the driver to
lose control of the vehicle. Be sure the
steering column/wheel is adjusted
before driving your vehicle. Failure to
follow this warning may result in
serious injury or death.
The heated steering wheel has only
one temperature setting. Once turned
on, this function will operate for
approximately 58 to 70 minutes
before automatically shutting off.
The heated steering wheel can shut
off early or may not turn on when the
steering wheel is already warm.
The heated steering wheel can be
turned on and off using the MTC
System.
3
• Touch the “Controls” soft-key
located on the lower part of the
MTC display.
• Within 15 seconds, touch the
“Heated wheel” soft-key to turn on
the function.
• Within 15 seconds, touch the
“Heated wheel” soft-key a second
time to turn it off.
Heated Steering Wheel
(optional)
To lengthen or shorten the steering
column/wheel, pull the switch toward
you or push the switch away from you
as desired.
NOTE:
The engine must be running for the
heated steering wheel to operate.
The steering wheel contains a heating
element inside the rim that helps
warm driver’s hands by cold weather.
97
Understanding the Vehicle
Adjustable Pedals
WARNING!
• You must exercise care when using
the steering wheel heater if you
have any sensitivity to heat. It may
cause burns even at low
temperatures, especially if used for
long periods.
3
• Do not place anything on the
steering wheel that insulates against
heat, such as steering wheel covers
of any type of material. This may
cause the steering wheel heater to
overheat.
The adjustable pedals system is
designed to allow greater range of
pedals positions enabling driver
comfort with regard to the steering
wheel tilt and the seat position.
This feature allows the brake and
accelerator pedals to move toward or
away from the driver’s feet.
The switch is located on the front side
of the driver's seat cushion side shield.
The following messages will be
displayed if the driver is attempting to
adjust the pedals when the system is
locked out:
• “Adjustable Pedals Unavailable
While in Reverse”;
• or “Adjustable Pedals Unavailable
While Cruise Engaged”.
NOTE:
For vehicles equipped with driver
memory seat, use your key fob (RKE)
transmitter or the memory buttons on
the driver's door trim panel to return
the adjustable pedals to programmed
positions. See “Driver Memory Seat” in
section 3 for further information.
Press the switch downward to move
the pedals forward (toward the front
of the vehicle).
Lift the switch upward to move the
pedals rearward (toward the driver).
WARNING!
Do not adjust the pedals position
while the vehicle is moving. You could
98
lose control and have an accident.
Always adjust the pedals position
while the vehicle is parked.
CAUTION!
Do not place any object under the
adjustable pedals or obstruct its
movement as it may cause damage to
the pedal controls. Pedal movement
may become limited if there is an
obstruction in the adjustable pedal's
path.
Understanding the Vehicle
Rear-View Mirrors
External Mirrors
External mirrors can be adjusted
electrically and are equipped with anti
fog resistors operated by the air
conditioning system (see “Air
Conditioning Controls” in section 4).
The mirrors can be folded electrically
and will yield in both directions in case
of a collision.
The external mirrors are
electrochromic, which means, they
automatically operate an anti glare
function by gradually shading as the
light hitting the mirrors increases.
The exterior of the rear-view mirror
support is equipped with LEDs,
lighting up when the turn signals and
vehicle entry/exit lights are activated.
Mirrors Positioning
The power mirror controls are located
on the driver's door trim panel.
The power mirror controls consist of
mirror select buttons and a four-way
mirror control switch.
NOTE:
The mirrors can be adjusted
electrically only with the ignition key
in RUN position.
To adjust a rear view mirror, press
either the L (left) or R (right) button to
select the mirror that you want to
adjust. The spin button will illuminate
indicating the rear view mirror is
activated and can be adjusted.
Press the mirror control switch
corresponding to the arrow indicating
the direction of the desired
movement.
For optimal vision orientate the
outside(s) mirror(s) in order to frame
the adjacent lane adjacent and get a
partial overlap with the visible image
on the inside rear-view mirror.
Power mirror preselected positions can
be reset by operating the optional
Memory Driver Seat device. Check
“Driver Memory Seat” in section 3 for
further information.
3
WARNING!
Vehicles and other objects seen in the
external side convex mirror will look
smaller and farther away than they
really are. Relying only on your
passenger side convex mirror could
cause you to collide with another
vehicle or object. Use the inside mirror
to judge the size or distance of a
vehicle seen in the external side
convex mirror.
99
Understanding the Vehicle
manually: it could damage the power
mechanism.
Tilt both Mirrors in Reverse
3
This feature provides automatic
external rear-view mirrors positioning,
allowing the driver to view the ground
area behind the front doors. The
external mirrors will move slightly
downward from the current position
when the shift lever is shifted into
reverse. The external mirrors will then
return to the original position when
the lever is shifted out of the reverse
position. Each memory set of the
driver's seat (see "Driver Memory
Seat" chapter in section 3) corresponds
to a mirrors tilt position in reverse.
Internal Rearview Mirror
The internal rearview mirror can be
manually adjusted, and is equipped
with an accident-prevention release
system operating in the event of a
collision. Internal rearview mirror is
electrochromic: this function is
automatically deactivated in reverse to
ensure maximum visibility of obstacles.
NOTE:
The mirrors tilt in reverse can be
turned on and off using the MTC
System, refer to “MTC Settings” in
section 4.
Folding Mirrors
The switch for the power folding
mirrors is located between the power
mirror switches.
Press the switch once and the mirrors
will fold in; press the switch a second
time to reset the mirrors to the
standard position.
If the mirrors are in the folded
position, and vehicle speed is equal or
greater than 10 mph (16 km/h), they
will automatically unfold.
CAUTION!
Never retract or open the mirrors
100
CAUTION!
To avoid damage to the mirror during
cleaning, never spray any cleaning
solution directly onto the mirror. Apply
the solution onto a clean cloth and
wipe the mirror clean.
Understanding the Vehicle
Lights
Light Switch
The headlight switch located on the
left side of the dashboard is used for
the parking lights, headlights and fog
lights operations. The regulation
devices beside the switch (see “Interior
Lights” in this chapter) can adjust the
brightness of the instrument panel
lights, the doors controls rear lighting
and the interior lighting.
Rotate the headlight switch clockwise
to the first
or to the second
trigger
the instrument cluster will
display the related telltale.
3
NOTE:
If the headlights or position/parking
lights are on after the ignition is
placed in OFF position, an audio signal
will alert the driver while opening the
driver's door.
101
Understanding the Vehicle
Lighting Up External Lights according to the Position of the Headlights Switch, Ignition Device and Transmission and
according to the Engine Status
Ignition
device
position
Engine
status
Transmission
position
OFF
-
-
ACC
Off
P (Park)
RUN
Off
P (Park)
RUN
On
P (Park)
RUN
On
Any position
other than P
(Park)
3
Lights switch position
0
All lights off
Position/parking lights
(1), side marker and
license plate lights on
Low beams, position/parking (1),
side marker and license plate lights
on
All lights off
Position/parking lights
(1), side marker and
license plate lights on (2)
Low beams, position/parking (1),
side marker and license plate lights
on (2)
All lights off
All lights off
Low beams, position/parking (1),
side marker and license plate lights
on (2)
All lights off
All lights off
Low beams, position/parking (1),
side marker and license plate lights
on
DRL (1) on
(if enabled by
MTC)
DRL (1) on (if enabled by
MTC)
Low beams, position/parking (1),
side marker and license plate lights
on
(1) The lighting system uses the same LED with two different levels of intensity: high for DRL and low for position/
parking lights.
(2) The lights are powered up for 30 minutes to preserve the charge of the battery.
102
Understanding the Vehicle
Lighting Up Internal Lights according
to the Headlights Switch and Ignition
Device Position
mode
• When lights switch is in
and ignition switch in RUN, besides
the outdoor lights, the rear Dome
lights LED, the front Dome light (if
enabled), the control backlight, the
lighting of the instrument panel and
front seats night lighting will light
up.
• Besides the external lights, the same
interior lights indicated in the
previous step based on the DAY or
NIGHT mode established by the
Ambient light detecting sensor will
light up. In DAY mode, the control
backlights will have 100% intensity.
In NIGHT mode, the intensity can be
adjusted by the right regulator (see
“Interior Lights" of this chapter).
• When the light switch position is "0"
and the ignition device is in RUN
mode, the control back light and
night lighting will turn off.
NOTE:
During DAY mode, the control
switches are not backlit except the
windows and steering switches.
Automatic Headlights
This system automatically turns the
headlights on or off according to
ambient light intensity detected by
the twilight sensor. To turn the system
on, rotate the lights switch clockwise
to “AUTO” position.
When the automatic system is
activated, the headlight time delay
feature is activated as well. This means
the headlights will stay on for up to 90
seconds after you place the ignition
into OFF position.
To turn the automatic system off,
move the lights switch out of “AUTO”
position.
NOTE:
The engine must be running before
the headlights turn on in automatic
mode.
WARNING!
• The responsibility for turning on the
lights, depending on the daylight
and regulations in force in the
country of use, always lies with the
driver. The automatic system for
switching on and off the external
lights is to be considered as an aid
for the driver.
If necessary, switch the lights on and
off manually.
• In case of fog during the day, the
position lights and low beams will
turn on automatically. The driver
must always be ready to turn the
lights on manually, including the
rear fog lights.
Headlights On with Wipers
3
When this feature is active, the
headlights will turn on in “Adverse
Weather” mode approximately 120
seconds after activation of the wipers,
if the lights switch is placed in the
“AUTO” position. The headlights will
additionally turn off by deactivation
of the wipers if previously activated
with this function.
NOTE:
The Headlights ignition feature with
wipers may be turned on and off using
the MTC System, refer to “MTC
Settings” in section 4.
Headlights Time Delay
This safety feature provides headlight
illumination for up to 90 seconds
(programmable) when leaving your
vehicle in an unlit area. To activate the
delay feature, place the ignition
103
Understanding the Vehicle
3
switch in the OFF or ACC position
while the headlights are still on. Then
turn off the headlights within 45
seconds.
The delay interval begins when the
lights switch is turned off (position
“0”). If you turn the headlights or
parking lights on, or place the ignition
in RUN, the system will cancel the
delay.
If you turn the headlights off (“0”
position) before the ignition, they will
turn off in the normal mode.
NOTE:
• To activate this feature the lights
must be turned off (“0” position)
within 45 seconds of placing the
ignition in the OFF or ACC position.
• The headlight delay time is
programmable using the MTC System,
see “MTC Settings” in section 4.
SmartBeam™ System
The SmartBeam™ system provides
increased forward lighting at night by
automating high beam control (“Auto
Dim High Beams” function) through
the use of a digital camera fitted
behind the rearview mirror.
This camera detects vehicle specific
light and automatically switches from
104
high beams to low beams until the
approaching vehicle or the front
vehicle is out of view.
NOTE:
• This function can be turned on or off
using the MTC System, refer to “MTC
Settings” in section 4 for further
information.
• If the headlights and rear parking
lights of the vehicle in the visual field
of the camera should be broken,
covered in mud or obstructed, high
beam headlights will remain lit for
longer, up to a closer position of the
oncoming or foregoing vehicle. Dirt,
impurities and other obstructions on
the windshield or camera lens can
cause the system to function
improperly.
• By replacing the windshield or
SmartBeam™ mirror, the
SmartBeam™ mirror must be
re-aimed to ensure proper
performance. Please contact
exclusively the Authorized Maserati
Dealer for replacement.
Daytime Running Lights (DRL)
The lighting system uses the same high
or low intensity headlights LED,
respectively, for the DRL lights and
position or parking lights.
DRL lights will turn on when the
engine is running and the shift lever is
moved out of the P (Park) position.
If a turn signal is activated, the DRL
light on the same side of the vehicle
will turn off for the duration of the
turn signal activation. Once the turn
signal is deactivated, the DRL light will
light up again.
NOTE:
Depending on your Country’s
regulations (for example: in Canadian
vehicles DRL lights are always on), DRL
lights may be turned on and off.
Where the regulations permit, the DRL
lights can be turned on and off using
the MTC System, see “MTC Settings” in
section 4 for further information.
Adaptive Bi-Xenon Headlights
The gas-discharge (xenon) headlights
operate with an electric arc saturated
with Xenon gas under pressure,
instead of the incandescent filament.
The light produced is assuredly higher
compared to traditional light bulbs, in
terms of quality (brighter light) as well
as the span and positioning of the
illuminated area.
Understanding the Vehicle
The headlight system combines the
light beam with the steering angle to
assure better visibility of the road
surface when driving in a curve,
steering or in the event of road
deviations.
NOTE:
• Each time the adaptive headlight
system is turned on, the headlights
will perform a self-regulation cycle.
• The adaptive headlight system is
active only when the vehicle is
moving forward.
• “Steering Directed Headlights”
function can be turned on or off
using the MTC System, refer to “MTC
Settings” in section 4 for further
information.
WARNING!
If xenon headlamp replacement is
necessary, contact the Authorized
Maserati Dealer only: DANGER - RISK
OF ELECTRICAL SHOCK.
Fog Lights
The rear fog lights switch is built into
the lights switch.
To activate the rear fog lights, turn the
headlight switch to the low beam
light
or “AUTO” position. Press
the lights switch
to turn on the
rear fog lights.
3
NOTE:
The rear fog lights will NOT activate
automatically when turning on the
low beam
or “AUTO” headlights
if previously deactivated by turning
the lights switch off. The rear fog
lights will only turn on by operating
the switch as previously described.
Pressing again the lights switch will
deactivate the rear fog lights.
Turning the lights switch off (position
“0”) will also deactivate the rear fog
lights.
A dedicated telltale in the instrument
cluster illuminates when the rear fog
lights are turned on.
105
Understanding the Vehicle
Multifunction Lever
NOTE:
The multifunction lever controls the
operation of the turn signals,
headlight beam selection and
overtaking lights.
The multifunction lever is fitted on the
left side of the steering column.
• If either light remains on and does
not flash, or flashes at a fast rate,
check for a defective outside light
bulb. If an indicator fails while
moving the lever, then the indicator
bulb is probably defective.
• A “Turn Signal On” message will
appear in the instrument cluster and
a continuous chime will sound if the
vehicle is driven more than 1 mile
(1.6 km) with either turn signal on.
3
High Beams and Flashing
Turn Signals
Move the multifunction lever all the
way up or down until the stop trigger;
the left or right arrow on respectively
the speedometer and Rev Counter
instrument cluster, flashes to show
proper operation of the front and rear
turn signal lights.
106
To activate lane change function, tap
the lever up or down once, without
moving beyond the detent. The turn
signals (right or left) will flash three
times then automatically turn off.
This function is useful when
overtaking or changing lanes.
To switch on the high beams with the
light switch in headlamp
or
“AUTO” position, shift the
multifunction lever onward.
A related telltale
will illuminate
on the Rev Counter.
Pulling the lever backward (toward the
steering wheel) you switch off the
high beams and switch on the low
beams.
Understanding the Vehicle
Entry/Exit Illumination
The compartment courtesy lights and
the exterior lights can be switched on
and off when entering or exiting the
vehicle by pressing the buttons on the
remote control and/or from the
Passive Entry System. Check
“Illuminated Entry/Exit” in section 2
for further information.
3
Interior Lights
CAUTION!
The high beams can only be switched
on manually by pushing the left lever
forward.
You can signal another vehicle with
your headlights by lightly pulling the
multifunction lever toward you. This
will turn on the high beams headlights
until the lever is released.
Flashing occurs also with lights off
(lights switch in position “0”) if the
ignition switch is RUN position.
WARNING!
If the high beams are activated, they
will turn on automatically every time
the low beams are switched on either
manually or automatically. We
recommend therefore that you switch
them off when they are no longer
necessary and every time the twilight
sensor deactivates the external lights.
The interior and external approach
lights turn on and off when
entering/exiting the vehicle (see
“Illuminated Entry/Exit” in section 2
for further information).
The brightness of the lights can be
manually adjusted with the regulator
positioned beside the multifunction
lever. To protect the battery, the
interior lights will turn off
automatically 10 minutes after the
ignition switch has been shifted to
OFF. This occurs if the interior lights
were turned on manually or by
opening of a door. The glove box
light, share the same characteristics
excepting the trunk light. To reset
interior lighting operation, either turn
the ignition switch out of OFF or
rotate the multifunction lever out of
“0” position.
107
Understanding the Vehicle
Courtesy Dimmable Lights
The following dimmable courtesy
lights, can be set with the regulation
device:
3
108
• instrument cluster dials and display;
• dome light (front/rear);
• inside door handle LED;
• doors and steering wheel backlight
controls LED;
• front footrest light;
• front seats night lighting.
Understanding the Vehicle
Dimmer Controls
3rd
Dimmer controls are located beside
the multifunction light control lever.
Stable position: allows
switching on the main and
the reading lights of the
front dome light.
NOTE:
The left regulator operates only with
park lights or low beams lights on.
The right regulator has 2 different
positions:
The regulation device rotates from
position “0” downward and back
upward performing stable and
dimmable positions.
0
(OFF)
Stable position: front seat
lighting and front dome light
LED are turned off.
1st
Dimmable position: allows
minimum to maximum
brightness tuning of the
front dome light LED and the
front seats lighting.
The left regulator switch has 4
different positions:
0
(OFF)
Stable position: lower level
of the internal lighting.
1st
Dimmable position: allows
minimum to maximum
brightness tuning of the
instrument cluster dials,
display, control switches and
MTC’s backlight, including all
displayed messages.
2nd
Stable position: allows
maximum brightness set.
NOTE:
The right regulator is only active if the
switch is in “AUTO” or in low beam
mode
.
Dome Lights
The front and rear part of the dome,
include each a central and two
reading lights.
The central light automatically turns
on when one of the doors is opened
and turns off when the door is closed
(timed switching off). The light may be
switched on manually by pressing the
central button.
The reading lights are controlled by
the respective side buttons.
If they are turned on by pressing the
button, both central and reading
lights will stay on for about 10
minutes after turning the engine off,
and will then turn off gradually.
When the exterior lights are switched
on, the two night LEDs fitted on the
side of the buttons will light up to
facilitate use of the shift lever and the
central console.
If one or more doors are opened, the
front and rear dome lights will turn on
for 27 seconds. If the door is closed
before this time, the lights will dim
and subsequently switch off after
about 3 seconds.
3
109
Understanding the Vehicle
NOTE:
The dome lights will also turn on by
pressing the or button for
centralized doors unlock and lock on
the key fob RKE transmitter. See
“Illuminated Entry/Exit” section 2 for
further information.
Integrated External Rear View
Mirror Lights
NOTE:
Driver and passenger external mirrors
are supplied with LED turn signals
integrated on the support.
The LED turn signal indicators flash
simultaneously with the corresponding
turn signal lights in the front and rear
of the vehicle. Turning on the hazard
warning lights will also activate these
LEDs.
On the front dome light there are also
the sunroof control and the
HomeLink® controls (if foreseen).
Hazard Warning Flashers
3
Press the indicated button on the
center of the control panel to turn on
the hazard warning flashers. The
operation is independent from the
ignition key position.
Press the button again to turn them
off.
When these lights are on, the turn
signals, the related indicator light on
the instrument cluster and the button
itself will flash.
In the event of a collision causing
automatic interruption of fuel supply,
the dome lights switch on
110
automatically and remain lit for
approx. 15 minutes.
Understanding the Vehicle
Windshield Wipers and
Washers
The multifunction lever operates the
windshield wipers and washer when
the ignition switch is placed in RUN or
ACC position. The multifunction lever
is located on the left side of the
steering column.
The headlight and windshield washers
share the same fluid reservoir, and a
low fluid level is indicated by the same
indicator light
and by the message
on the instrument cluster.
To refill the fluid, see “Maintenance
Procedures” in section 7.
• To turn the wipers off rotate the
lever to “OFF”.
CAUTION!
Windshield Wipers
• Rotate the end of the multifunction
lever to one of the four settings to
activate the automatic intermittent
setting (see “Rain Sensing Wipers”
paragraph in this chapter).
• For low speed wiper operation
(stable position "LO"): rotate the
end of the multifunction control
lever forward to the first trigger
after the intermittent setting.
• Rotate to the second trigger after
the intermittent setting for
high-speed (stable position HI) wiper
operation.
• Rotate the end of the lever
downward to the “MIST” position to
activate a single wipe cycle. The
wipers will continue to operate until
you release the multifunction lever.
• Turn the windshield wipers off when
driving through an automatic car
wash. The windshield wipers may be
damaged if the wiper control is left
in any position other than “OFF”.
• In cold weather, always turn off the
wiper switch and allow the wipers to
return to the park position before
turning off the engine. If the wiper
switch is left on and the wipers
freeze to the windshield, the wiper
motor may be damaged when the
vehicle is restarted.
• Always remove any buildup of snow
that prevents the windshield wiper
blades from returning to the off
position. If the windshield wiper
control is turned off and the blades
cannot return to the off position, the
wiper motor may be damaged.
3
111
Understanding the Vehicle
Rain Sensing Wipers
3
This feature detects moisture on the
windshield through an internal rear
view mirror integrated sensor, which
automatically activates the wipers.
Rotate the end of the multifunction
lever to one of four settings to adjust
the detection system.
Wiper delay position 1 is the least
sensitive, and wiper delay position 4 is
the most sensitive. Setting 3 should be
used for normal rain conditions.
The rain sense wipers will
automatically change between an
intermittent wipe, slow wipe and a
fast wipe depending on the amount of
detected moisture sensed by a
particular area of the windshield.
Place the wiper switch in the “OFF”
position when you do not want to use
the automatic intermittent system.
The rain sensing feature can be turned
on and off using the MTC System, see
“MTC Settings” in section 4 for further
information.
CAUTION!
• The rain sensing feature may not
function properly with ice or dried
salt water on the windshield.
112
• Use of RainX® or products containing
wax or silicone may reduce rain
sensor performance.
The rain sensing system has protective
features for the wiper blades and
arms. It will not operate under the
following conditions:
• Low Temperature Wipe Inhibit: the
rain sensing feature will not operate
when the ignition is in RUN position,
the vehicle is stationary and the
outside temperature is below 32 °F
(0°C), To resume, set the automatic
feature on the multifunction lever,
start the engine and drive or wait
until the outside temperature rises
above freezing.
• Neutral Wipe Inhibit: the rain sensing
feature will not operate when the
ignition is placed in the RUN
position, the transmission shift lever
is in the N (Neutral) position and the
vehicle speed is less than 5 mph
(8 km/h). To resume, set the
multifunction lever to the automatic
function or move the shift lever out
of N (Neutral).
Headlights On with Wipers
When activating this function, the
headlights will light up approximately
10 seconds after the wipers are turned
on if the headlight switch is placed in
“AUTO” position. In addition, the
headlights switch off when the wipers
are turned off (position “OFF”) if they
were previously turned by using this
function. Powering on Headlights with
wipers can be activated and
deactivated with the MTC System, see
“MTC Settings” in section 4 for further
information.
Wipers Blades Maintenance
When the wiper arms are in “P” (park
position) it is not possible to check or
replace the blades (Service position) as
they are folded under the hood. To
service the blades it is necessary to
shift the multifunction lever to “OFF”
and the ignition switch to OFF
position.
Shift the control lever within 15
seconds to the “MIST” panic position
(counterclockwise rotation of the twist
switch) and release. The blades are
brought in a position enabling the
opening of the wiper arms and change
of the blades. It is possible to use the
panic position for a maximum of 3
Understanding the Vehicle
times within two minutes,
corresponding to different the blades
positions on the windshield. When
completed bring the ignition switch in
RUN: the arms will reposition. If
necessary move the multifunction
lever to other required operating
positions.
WARNING!
Operate or service the wiper blades
without deactivating the wipers
(“OFF” position) leaving the ignition
switch in RUN can be dangerous for
the operator since the rain sensor may
suddenly activate the wipers. Always
use “Service” position for any
intervention on the wiper blades.
Windshield and Headlight
Washers
To use the washer, push the end of the
multifunction lever inward (toward
the steering column) and hold it as
long as washer spray is desired.
If you activate the washer while the
windshield wiper control is in the
automatic intermittent range, the
wipers will operate for two wipe
cycles after releasing the lever and
then resume the previously selected
intermittent interval.
If you activate the washer while the
windshield wiper is turned off (OFF)
the wipers will operate for three wipe
cycles and then turn off.
At low external temperatures, the
fluid supply nozzles are heated by
internal resistors to avoid fluid
freezing inside.
WARNING!
• Do not start the windshield washer
during the cold months until the
windshield has warmed up. If it has
not warmed up, the liquid could
freeze on the glass and block your
view.
• Sudden loss of visibility through the
windshield could lead to a collision.
You might not see other vehicles or
other obstacles. To avoid sudden
icing of the windshield during
freezing weather, warm the
windshield with the defroster
before and during windshield
washer use.
3
The multifunction lever also operates
the headlight washers when the
ignition switch is in RUN position and
the headlights are turned on.
The headlight washers will spray a
timed high pressure spray of washer
fluid onto each headlight lens every
11 windshield wipers cycles.
113
Understanding the Vehicle
Interior Features
Electric Power Outlets
3
The vehicle is equipped with three
12 Volt (13 Amp) electric power
outlets, one available for each front
seats, rear seats passengers and one
fitted in the trunk.
In vehicles with “Comfort Luxury” rear
seats, there is an extra 12 V power
outlet inside the rear console storage
compartment and others in the rear of
the reclining shelf between the seats.
All power outlets are supplied only
when the engine is started or the
ignition device set on ACC or RUN.
Power outlets are protected by a fuse.
Insert a cigar lighter or accessory plug
into the power outlets to ensure
proper operation. Otherwise, check
the matching fuse integrity, see “Fuse
Replacement” in section 7 for further
information.
any other object in the power outlets
as this will damage the outlet and
blow the fuse. Damages caused by
improper use of the power outlet are
not covered by the New Vehicle
Limited Warranty.
WARNING!
To avoid serious injury or death:
• Only devices designed for use in this
type of outlet should be inserted
into any 12 Volt outlet.
• Replacing the fuses that protect
power outlets with others of higher
amperage, there is the risk of fire.
• Do not touch with wet hands.
• Close the lids when the plug is not
used and while driving the vehicle.
• If this outlet is mishandled, it may
cause an electric shock and failure.
Power Outlet inside the Cup Holder
CAUTION!
• Do not plug in accessories that
exceed the maximum power of 160
Watts (13 Amps) at 12 Volts or 150
Watts at 115 Volts.
• Power outlets are designed for
accessory plugs only. Do not insert
114
To access the power outlet inside the
cup holder beside the shift lever, press
the cover as indicated to open
completely.
WARNING!
High power consumption items
plugged into this outlet for long
periods may discharge the battery
and/or prevent the engine from
starting.
Understanding the Vehicle
Power Outlets inside the Central
Console
To access the power outlet located
inside the glove box of the central
console you need to open the half-lids
as indicated in the following
paragraph.
3
Rear Power Outlets
A 12 V power outlet both inside the
central console and in the rear of the
reclining shelf, are available for rear
seats passengers (see “Comfort Luxury
Rear Seats” in this section).
In the rear of the reclining shelf, on
request, can be installed a 115 V - AC
(150 W) power outlet.
“Comfort Luxury” Rear Seats
Power Outlet inside the Trunk
The power outlet is positioned on the
right side of the trunk.
If the vehicle is equipped with bench
seats, a 12 V power outlet inside the
armrest between the seats, is available
for rear seat passengers (see “Rear
Seats” in this section).
“Comfort Luxury” Rear Seats
115
Understanding the Vehicle
Cup Holders
The vehicle is equipped with several
cup holders.
CAUTION!
3
• Use light and shatterproof
containers.
• Do not forcefully push unsuitable
containers into the cup holders to
prevent damage to the containers.
• Do not store hot drinks.
Front Seats Cup Holders
Pressing the indicated button, the
half-lids will rise completely enabling
access to the inner compartment
where the two cup holders are
located.
NOTE:
Vehicles equipped with the four-zone
air conditioning system, are not
equipped with cup holders inside the
central console.
The front cup holders are located
within the central console beside the
transmission shift lever.
To access the cup holder, push the lid
as shown in the picture and it will
open completely.
The storage and passenger
compartment share the same air
conditioning even though you may
exclude the air conditioning of the cup
holder compartment by moving the
indicated button.
116
To close one or both of the half-lids,
push them down to the locking
position.
Understanding the Vehicle
Rear Seats Cup Holders
Two cup holders are available in the
frontside of the rear seats central
armrest, press the button as shown in
the picture to access them.
3
“Comfort Luxury” rear seats
AUX and USB Port
The AUX and USB ports are located
inside the compartment behind the
transmission shift lever. To access the
ports, push the lid as indicated: it will
open completely.
On vehicles equipped with the
“Comfort Luxury” rear seats, the cup
holders are located in the front and
rear central storage compartment (see
“Comfort Luxury Rear Seats” in this
section for further information).
The AUX auxiliary port features:
• typical input impedance between
AUX-IN and AUX_REF: 13 Kohm;
• max. applicable voltage: 0.75 Vrms at
1 kHz;
• input compatible only with 3.5 mm
jack connectors (not included).
Any player with these characteristics
and analog audio output (headset
output type) can be served by the MTC
System. The system can recognize the
connection to a player outlet
autonomously enabling access to the
audio functions connected to this
source.
The USB port
, available by
removing protection cap, allows the
data exchange and charge of the
connected source. If there are MP3
files on the USB device, they will
automatically start playing.
117
Understanding the Vehicle
If you are already listening to music
from a different source you need to
select the USB function to start playing
audio contents (refer to the MTC
guide).
NOTE:
3
• Another USB port is present inside
the armrest between the rear bench
seats.
• Optional “Comfort Luxury” rear seats
are equipped with a USB port
beneath the reclining shelf between
the seats (see “Comfort Luxury Rear
Seats” in this section).
• The "Rear Seat Entertainment"
option, includes a AUX and a USB
port in the rear of each front seat
(see “Interior Features” in this
section).
iPod® Connection
An iPod® can be connected to the
system via USB and AUX ports by
means of a special cable (optional).
The MTC will then control the
following functions: play, pause, fast
forward, rewind, next track, previous
track, random or repeat mode,
selection and navigation of
playlist/genre/singer/album/Podcast.
118
CAUTION!
Do not leave your USB device, iPod® or
an external audio source in the vehicle
for extended period of time: extreme
temperatures and humidity can occur
in the vehicle.
Sun Visors
Sun visors can be folded to the front
and to the side of the vehicle. To move
the visor laterally, lower and release it
from its catch as indicated.
By lowering the visor on the
passenger's side you can access the
courtesy mirror with incorporated light
illuminating automatically (with the
ignition switch in RUN) by raising the
mirror protective cover. Before raising
the visor, close the mirror cover.
A paper holder is fitted inside each sun
visor.
Understanding the Vehicle
Smoking Kit (optional)
The kit includes a lighter and a
removable ashtray with cover.
The Smoking kit for front seats
passengers is located inside the box
beside the transmission shift lever and
can be accessed by pressing the cover
as indicated.
The rear seat passengers can use the
removable ashtray by inserting it into
the rear doors pocket, while the
lighter can be inserted into the power
outlet inside the armrest between the
rear seats.
On vehicles equipped with rear seats
“Comfort Luxury” Smoking kit, lighter
and ashtray are fitted inside the
center console between the seats.
CAUTION!
After use, always make sure that the
cigarette lighter is switched off.
WARNING!
• The cigarette lighter reaches high
temperatures. Handle it carefully
and do not allow children to use to
avoid risk of fire and injury!
3
• The cigarette lighter outlet may not
be used as a power.
“Comfort Luxury” Rear Seats
Pressing the central button activates
the cigarette lighter. After about 20
seconds the button returns
automatically to the initial position
and stops the heating: now the
cigarette lighter is ready for use.
119
Understanding the Vehicle
Handholds and Cloth Hooks
Map Pockets
Tables (optional)
Handholds are fitted above the
passenger doors. Once grabbed, they
will lower until the block position.
When released, a return spring will
bring them back to the original
position.
Front seats are fitted with map
pockets, on the rear of the seatbacks,
and accessible by rear passengers.
Tables are fitted in the back of the
front seats.
3
Rear handholds also include a clothes
hook.
CAUTION!
Do not put heavy or sharp objects in
the map pockets.
120
• Opening: press the upper button and
lower the table until the supporting
mechanism snap locks.
• Closing: lift the table until the upper
button snap locks.
Understanding the Vehicle
CAUTION!
As the table is not equipped with cup
holders, do not place open drinks
containers on the tables during the
journey in order not to damage or
stain the surrounding upholstery if
they fall over.
Rear Seat Entertainment
(optional)
See the user guide provided with the
vehicle documentation.
This optional includes the installation
of a screen in the rear of each front
seatback and a remote control to
connect with an external video source
and any audio devices.
iPad Holder (Genuine
Accessory)
The Authorized Maserati Dealer can
provide you with all information
about the “Maserati iPad Holder”
mounted on the rear of the front
seatbacks, available in the Genuine
Accessories range.
3
WARNING!
• When the table is not used, it should
be closed to prevent rear seat
passengers from being hit by its
edges and corners.
• When closing the table, hold it up
carefully in order to avoid pinching
your fingers.
Inside the map pocket on the rear of
the seat-back there are two leds to
illuminate the RSE system outlets.
121
Understanding the Vehicle
Cargo Area
3
WARNING!
To help protect against personal injury,
passengers should not be seated in
the rear cargo area. The rear cargo
space is intended for load carrying
purposes only, not for passengers,
who should sit in seats and use seat
belts.
Do not exceed the specified Gross
Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
front and rear.
The GVWR is the total allowable
weight of your vehicle. This includes
driver, passengers, and cargo.
The total load must be limited so that
you do not exceed the GVWR
indicated on the label.
Vehicle Loading
Vehicle Load Carrying Capacity
The load carrying capacity of your
vehicle is shown on the vehicle
homologation label positioned on the
driver's side rear door pillar.
WARNING!
• Improper weight distribution can
have an adverse effect on the way
the vehicle steers, handles and the
way the brakes operate.
• Never drive with the trunk open.
Exhaust gases can enter the
passenger compartment.
• Do not pile luggage or cargo higher
than the top of the seatback. This
could impair visibility or become
dangerous in a sudden stop or
collision.
The information indicated on the label
concerns passengers and luggage
loading operations.
122
The trunk is the most suitable place to
load bulky and heavy objects onboard
the vehicle. The maximum allowable
load on the floor of the trunk is 440 lb
(200 kg).
To load your vehicle properly, store
heavier items below and be sure you
distribute their weight as evenly as
possible.
Stow all loose items securely before
you start driving as they could move
during the trip.
Light objects can be stored in the net
pocket on the right side of the trunk.
To fasten heavy and bulky luggage
inside the compartment a luggage net
with hooks anchored to the floor is
available upon request. The hooking
eyelets of the net are positioned on
the floor and on the rear wall of the
trunk.
Understanding the Vehicle
NOTE:
To safely store the Ski and Snowboard
Bag, tilt forward the short seatback
side. Secure the rear hook of the bag
to the eyelet located on the rear wall
of the trunk compartment. Wrap the
belt around the seat back of the
folded seat and fasten the belt buckle.
Tighten the belt as much as necessary
to prevent the bag from moving.
3
NOTE:
The Authorized Maserati Dealer can
provide you with information about
the available Genuine Accessories for
the trunk compartment.
Loading with Rear Seatbacks
Down
The 60/40 split-folding rear seat with
folding option on the smaller side
only, provides cargo-carrying
versatility.
The seatback folds down easily by
pulling the tab between the seatback
and the bolster.
The seat folded down, provides a
continuous nearly-flat extension of
the load floor able to accommodate
large sized equipment and objects
(such as the “Maserati Ski and
Snowboard Bag”) that may not fit
with the normal dimensions of the
trunk.
When the seatback is folded to the
upright position, make sure it is
latched by strongly pulling on the top
of the seatback above the seat strap.
WARNING!
• Make sure that the seatback is
securely locked into position.
(Continued)
123
Understanding the Vehicle
(Continued)
If the seatback is not securely locked
into position, the seat will not
provide the proper stability for child
seats and/or passengers. An
improperly latched seat could cause
serious injury.
3
• The cargo area in the rear of the
vehicle with the rear seatbacks in
the folded down position should not
be used as a play area by children
when the vehicle is in motion. They
could be seriously injured in a
collision. Children should be seated
and use proper restraint system.
Power Sunroof with
Sunshade
The sunroof is power controlled and
can only be operated with the ignition
switch in RUN position. It can slide
lengthways and be raised at the rear
(tilting).
By opening the sunroof a front flap
rises automatically in order to deviate
the air flow.
The power sunroof controls are
located between the sun visors on the
overhead console.
The sunshade can be opened manually.
However, the sunshade will open
automatically as the sunroof opens.
The sunshade cannot be closed if the
sunroof is open.
WARNING!
• Improper use of the sunroof can be
dangerous, even if it features a
finger-trap prevention system.
Before and during the sunroof
operation, always make sure that
passengers are not exposed to the
risk of injuries caused by the moving
roof or by personal objects dragged
or hit by the moving sunroof.
• Never leave children in a vehicle
with the key fob RKE transmitter in
the passenger compartment.
(Continued)
124
Understanding the Vehicle
(Continued)
• In a collision, there is a greater risk
of being thrown from the vehicle if
the sunroof is open. Always fasten
your seat belt properly and make
sure all passengers are properly
secured too.
• Do not allow small children to
operate the sunroof. Never insert
fingers, other body parts, or any
object through the opening sunroof.
CAUTION!
• In the event of rain, always close the
sunroof to prevent water
infiltrations from staining the
fabric/leather upholstery.
• Do not open the sunroof if there is
ice on it: risk of damage.
Slide Opening Sunroof
• Full automatic express opening
Press the button rearward for more
than half second and the sunroof
will open automatically regardless
of any previous position. The
sunroof will open fully and stop
automatically. During this
operation, if any sunroof button is
pressed, the sunroof will stop.
• Full or partial manual opening
To open the sunroof manually press
the rearward button for less than
half second to move step by step
the sunroof panel.
Venting Sunroof
Press and release the central button,
and the sunroof will open to the vent
position. This is called “Express Vent”,
and will occur regardless of sunroof
position. During this opening
operation, any movement of the
button will stop the sunroof.
Closing Sunroof
• Full automatic express closing
Press the forward button for more
than half second and the sunroof
will close automatically regardless
of any previous position. The
sunroof will close fully and stop
automatically. During this
operation, if any button is pressed,
the sunroof will stop.
• Full or partial manual closing
To close the sunroof manually press
the forward button for less than
half second to move step by step
the sunroof panel.
Pinch Protect Feature
This feature will detect an obstruction
in the opening of the sunroof during
express close operation. If an
obstruction is detected, the sunroof
will automatically retract. If this
occurs, remove the obstruction then
press the forward button and release
to express close.
3
NOTE:
If three consecutive attempts to close
the sunroof result in pinch protect
reversals, the fourth attempt will be
manual, with pinch protect feature
disabled.
Pinch Protect Override
If any obstruction (ice, debris, etc.)
prevents closing the sunroof, press the
forward button and hold for two
seconds after the reversal occurs. This
allows the sunroof to move toward
the closed position.
NOTE:
Pinch protection is disabled while
pressing the forward button.
125
Understanding the Vehicle
To Close the Power Sunroof
with RKE Transmitter and
Ignition Off
3
When the ignition switch is in OFF
position, if the sunroof is open, it can
be closed together with the windows
by pressing the button on the RKE
transmitter (refer to “Power
Windows” in Section 2).
together to minimize the buffeting. If
the buffeting occurs with the sunroof
open, then adjust the sunroof opening
to minimize the buffeting.
Ignition Off Operation
• Press and release the button.
• Press a second time the button
and keep it pressed until the sunroof
is completely closed.
The power sunroof controls will
remain active for up to approximately
ten minutes after the ignition switch is
in OFF position. Opening either front
door will cancel this feature. The
ignition system timing can be set using
the MTC System (see “MTC Settings” in
section 4).
NOTE:
Sunroof Maintenance
Pressing the button on the RKE
transmitter will only open the
windows but will have no effect on
the sunroof.
Use only a nonabrasive cleaner and a
soft cloth to clean the glass panel.
HomeLink® (Optional)
HomeLink® replaces up to three
hand-held transmitters that operate
automatic devices that open garage
doors and gates, enable/disable the
lighting or security systems. The
HomeLink® unit is powered by your
vehicles 12 Volt battery. The
HomeLink® buttons that are located in
the overhead console designate the
three different HomeLink® channels.
The HomeLink® warning light is
located above the center button.
Wind Buffeting
Wind buffeting can be described as
the perception of pressure or a
helicopter-type sound. Your vehicle
may exhibit wind buffeting with the
windows down, or the sunroof in
certain open or partially open
positions. This is a normal occurrence
and can be minimized. If the buffeting
occurs with the rear windows open,
then open the front and rear windows
126
NOTE:
HomeLink® is disabled when the
vehicle security alarm is active (see
“Vehicle security alarm” in section 2).
Understanding the Vehicle
General Information
WARNING!
• Your motorized door or gate will
open and close while you are
programming the universal
transceiver. Do not program the
transceiver if people, pets or other
objects are in the path of the door
or gate. Only use this transceiver
with a garage door opener that has
a “stop and reverse” feature as
required by Federal safety
standards. This includes most garage
door opener models manufactured
after 1982. Do not use a garage door
opener without these safety
features. Call toll-free 1–800–355–
3515 or, on the Internet at
www.HomeLink.com for safety
information or assistance.
• Vehicle exhaust contains carbon
monoxide, a dangerous gas. Do not
run your vehicle in the garage while
programming the transceiver.
Exhaust gas can cause serious injury
or death.
This device complies with FCC rules
Part 15 and Industry Canada RSS-210.
Operation is subject to the following
two conditions:
• This device may not cause harmful
interference.
• This device must accept any
interference that may be received
including interference that may
cause undesired operation.
NOTE:
• The transmitter has been tested and
it complies with FCC and IC rules.
Changes or modifications not
expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could
void the user’s authority to operate
the device.
• The term IC before the
certification/registration number
only signifies that Industry Canada
technical specifications were met.
Before You Start Programming
HomeLink®
Be sure that your vehicle is parked
outside of the garage before you
begin programming.
For more efficient programming and
accurate transmission of the
radio-frequency signal it is
recommended that a new battery be
placed in the hand-held transmitter of
the device that is being programmed
to the HomeLink® system.
Before starting programming it is
necessary to erase the standard codes
memorized on the HomeLink® device
during the production phase. To erase
such codes:
3
• place the ignition device in the RUN
position without starting the engine;
• press and hold the two outside
HomeLink® buttons (I and III) until
the warning light starts flashing
(after approximately 20 seconds);
• release the buttons.
127
Understanding the Vehicle
3
NOTE:
• Erasing the standard codes should
only be performed when
programming HomeLink® for the
first time. Do not perform this
operation to program additional
buttons.
• If you have any problems, or require
assistance, please call toll-free
1–800–355–3515 or, on the Internet
at www.HomeLink.com for
information or assistance.
System with devices provided
with rolling codes
has been acquired and programmed
correctly by the HomeLink® system.
Programming the hand-held
transmitters
NOTE:
For programming garage door/gate
openers that were manufactured after
1995.
These devices can be identified by the
“LEARN” or “TRAIN” setting button
located where the hanging antenna is
attached to the garage door/gate
opener. It is NOT the button that is
normally used to open and close the
door.
The name and color of the button may
vary by manufacturer.
• Place the ignition device to the RUN
position without starting the engine.
• Place the hand-held transmitter 1 to
3 inches (5 - 30 cm) away from the
HomeLink® button you wish to
program.
• Simultaneously press and hold both
the Homelink® button you want to
program and the hand-held
transmitter button.
• Continue to hold buttons until the
warning light starts flashing quickly;
then release both buttons.
The quick flashing light indicates that
the channel with the new frequency
128
• On the last versions of this device it is
no longer necessary to keep the
button on the transmitter and the
HomeLink® buttons pressed; you just
have to release the HomeLink®
button immediately and keep only
the first one pressed.
• The distance necessary between the
portable hand-held transmitter and
the HomeLink® in the vehicle
depends on the system you wish to
program. Probably it will be
necessary to try several times. Upon
every attempt, keep the setting
position for at least 15 seconds
before trying again.
Synchronizing the rolling codes
At the end of the previously described
programming, if the HomeLink® has
been programmed for a rolling code
system, it will be necessary to
synchronize it to ensure its correct
operation.
• Locate the “LEARN” or “TRAINING”
setting button of the opening motor.
Firmly press it and then release it. On
some garage door openers/devices
Understanding the Vehicle
there may be a light that blinks
when the garage door opener/device
is in the LEARN/TRAIN mode.
NOTE:
You have 30 seconds in which to
initiate the next step after the setting
button has been pressed.
• Return to the vehicle and press the
programmed HomeLink® button for
two seconds and then release it.
• Repeat this operation a second time.
If the garage door opening device
activates, the programming/
synchronization phase is complete.
NOTE:
If the garage door opening device
does not activate, press the button a
third time for two seconds and then
release it to complete the
programming/synchronization phase.
• To program the remaining two
HomeLink® buttons, repeat each
step for each remaining button. DO
NOT erase the channels.
Reprogramming a Single HomeLink®
Button
To reprogram a channel that has been
previously trained, follow these steps:
• Place the ignition device to the RUN
position without starting the engine.
• Press and hold the desired
HomeLink® button.
• Without releasing the button
proceed with “Programming the
hand-held transmitters” from second
step and follow all remaining steps.
System with devices without
rolling code
Programming the hand-held
transmitters
For programming garage door
openers manufactured before 1995.
• Turn the ignition device to the RUN
position without starting the engine.
• Place the hand-held transmitter 1 to
3 inches (5 to 30 cm) away from the
HomeLink® button you wish to
program.
• Simultaneously press and hold both
buttons until the warning light starts
flashing quickly; then release both
buttons.
The quick flashing light indicates that
the channel with the new frequency
has been acquired and programmed
correctly by the HomeLink® system.
NOTE:
The distance necessary between the
portable hand-held transmitter and
the HomeLink® in the vehicle depends
on the system you wish to program.
Probably it will be necessary to try
several times. Upon every attempt,
keep the setting position for at least
15 seconds before trying again.
3
• Press and hold the programmed
HomeLink® button.
If the garage door opener/device
activates, programming is complete.
To program the remaining two
HomeLink® buttons, repeat each step
for each remaining button. Do not
erase the channels.
Reprogramming a Single HomeLink®
Button
To reprogram a channel that has been
previously trained, follow these steps:
• Place the ignition device to the RUN
position without starting the engine.
• Press and hold the desired
HomeLink® button.
• Without releasing the button
proceed with “Programming the
hand-held transmitters” from second
step and follow all remaining steps.
129
Understanding the Vehicle
3
Using HomeLink®
Troubleshooting Tips
To operate, press and release the
programmed HomeLink® button.
Activation will now occur for the
programmed device (i.e., garage door
opener, gate operator, security system,
entry door lock, home/office lighting,
etc.). The hand-held transmitter of the
device may also be used at any time.
If you are having trouble
programming HomeLink®, here are
some of the most common solutions:
Security
It is advised to erase all channels
before you sell or turn in your vehicle.
To erase the channels press and hold
the two outside HomeLink® buttons (I
and III) until the warning light starts
flashing (after approximately 20
seconds).
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver is
disabled when the vehicle security
alarm is active (see “Vehicle security
alarm” in section 2).
130
• Replace the battery in the original
hand-held transmitter.
• Press the LEARN button on the
garage door opener to complete the
training for a rolling code.
• Did you unplug the device for
programming and remember to plug
it back in?
If you have any problems, or require
assistance, please call toll-free
1–800–355–3515 or, on the Internet at
www.HomeLink.com for information
or assistance.
Understanding the Vehicle
Air Conditioning
Distribution
3
A/C Dual-zone
131
Understanding the Vehicle
3
A/C Four-zone
132
Understanding the Vehicle
Adjustable and fixed air vents allow
Air Conditioning System to achieve
the optimal comfort conditions.
• The fixed vents, positioned on the
upper part of the dashboard,
beneath the windshield and above
the front part of the front door
panels are meant to guarantee the
demisting and defrosting of the
windshield and the side windows.
• The fixed vents under the dashboard
and below the front seats aim to
ventilate the lower part of the
passenger compartment.
3
A/C Four-zone floor vent
A/C Dual-zone floor vent
• The adjustable air vents are located
at the center and at the side ends of
the dashboard. They have the
purpose of ventilating the upper
part of the passenger compartment.
Two more vents, adjustable by the
rear passengers, are placed at the
rear end of the central console.
• Optional four-zone air conditioning
provides additional adjustable vents
on the side pillars between the
doors. These vents can be adjusted in
vertical and horizontal direction, by
operating on the central paddle 1, as
indicated in the following pictures.
The rotor 2, located near each air
vent, allows to regulate the airflow,
or to close the vent. Orienting these
vents it is also possible to demist the
rear-door windows.
133
Understanding the Vehicle
3
A/C Four-zone side pillar vent
NOTE:
In order to avoid the obstruction of
the windshield defrost vents, it is
recommended not to place objects on
the dashboard.
134
4 – Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Infotainment System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Audio Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Audio System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
MTC Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Slot for SD Memory Card and CD/DVD . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Dashboard Compartments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Analog Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Air Conditioning Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Phone and Voice Controls on Steering Wheel
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
171
172
172
180
135
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Instrument Cluster
The instrument cluster is divided into
three main areas displaying
information, symbols and text and/or
icon messages.
4
A.
Analogic speedometer. It
indicates the vehicle speed in
MPH.
B.
Rev Counter.
C.
TFT display.
NOTE:
The image shows the instrument
cluster before starting the engine.
V8 Engine
V6 Engine
136
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
In the TFT area, the odometer display
shows the total distance the vehicle
has been driven.
U.S. Federal Regulations requires that
upon transfer of vehicle ownership,
the seller certify to the purchaser the
correct mileage that the vehicle has
been driven.
If your odometer needs to be repaired
or serviced, the repair technician
should leave the odometer reading
the same as it was before the repair or
service. This repair should be
performed by an Authorized Maserati
Dealer.
The odometer setting should be
maintained following the repair or
service.
Keep a record of the odometer
mileage before any repair or service to
ensure that the odometer is properly
reset.
Speedometer and Rev Counter display
the main warning lights (see “Warning
Lights on Analog Instruments” in this
chapter). The other warning lights are
displayed in the lower part of the TFT
display (see “Warning Lights on
Display” in this chapter).
Warning Lights on Analog
Instruments
Warning Lights on Speedometer
The following warning lights are
displayed on the speedometer, and
related messages are visible for 5
seconds on sector 1 of the display,
unless otherwise indicated (see “TFT
Display” paragraph in this chapter).
V6 Engine
Malfunction warning messages will be
stored in “Stored Messages” (see
example in picture).
4
V8 Engine
137
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)
4
138
The Malfunction Indicator
Light (MIL) is part of an
onboard diagnostic system,
called OBD II, that monitors
engine and automatic transmission
control systems.
Under normal conditions, this indicator
should illuminate when the ignition
switch is in RUN position and switch
off once the engine has been started
(the MIL does not shut off
immediately).
This is a sign of the indicator light
working properly. If the indicator
remains lit or switches on while
driving, there is a failure in the fuel
supply/ignition and emission control
systems.
The failure could cause high exhaust
emissions, loss of performance, poor
vehicle handling and high fuel
consumption levels.
Should this occur, proceed with
caution to your Authorized Maserati
Dealer without heavy throttle
application or driving at high speeds.
Obey all applicable local traffic
regulations.
The indicator light will go out if the
problem is no longer present.
The error will be registered by the
system in any case.
WARNING!
Engine exhaust, some of its
constituents, and certain vehicle
components contain or emit chemicals
known to the State of California to
cause cancer and birth defects or other
reproductive harm. In addition, certain
fluids contained in vehicles and certain
products of component wear contain
or emit chemicals known to the State
of California to cause cancer and birth
defects or other reproductive harm.
CAUTION!
• When the ignition switch is in the
RUN position and if the indicator
light does not switch on or if it
switches on while driving, contact
the Authorized Maserati Dealer as
soon as possible.
• Prolonged driving with the MIL on
could cause damage to the engine
control system. It also could affect
fuel economy and drivability. If the
MIL is flashing, severe catalytic
converter damage and power loss
will soon occur. Immediate service is
required. In addition, the OBDII
system incorporates a diagnostic
connector that can be interfaced
using diagnostic equipment. This
makes it possible to read the error
codes stored in the control unit,
together with a set of specific
parameters for the engine operation
diagnostic cycle, for compliance with
CARB & EPA OBDII regulations.
Left Turn Signal Indicator Light
The indicator lights up when
the left turn signal or the
hazard flashers are turned on.
The indicator light will flash at
the same frequency of the turn signals
and is controlled by the stalk switch
lever.
If the vehicle electronics sense that the
vehicle drives for more than 1 mile
(1.6 km) with either turn signal on, a
continuous sound will alert the driver
to turn the signal off.
If the indicator flashes at a rapid rate,
check for a defective exterior light
bulb.
Tire Pressure Monitoring Light
This warning light is connected
to the Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS).
Under normal conditions, the
warning light should illuminate when
the ignition switch is in RUN and
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
should go off once the engine is
started.
If the warning light remains lit or
illuminates while driving, the pressure
of one or more tires is too low and a
message will be displayed.
The TPMS malfunction indicator is
connected to the low tire pressure
monitoring light.
When the system detects a
malfunction, the monitoring light and
the related message will flash for
approximately one minute and then
remain lit.
This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle startups as long as
the malfunction lasts.
When the malfunction indicator lights
up, the system may not be able to
detect or signal low tire pressure
correctly.
Please refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” in section
5 for further information.
Anti-Lock Brake (ABS) Light
This light, and its related
message, indicate possible
malfunctions of the Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS).
The light will turn on when the
ignition switch is in RUN position and
may stay on for 4 seconds. If the ABS
light remains lit or turns on while
driving, the Anti-Lock portion of the
brake system is not functioning and
requires service. However, the
conventional brake system will
continue to operate normally if the
warning light is switched off. If
the ABS light turns on while driving,
or if it does not switch on when the
ignition switch is in RUN position,
please visit an Authorized Maserati
Dealer as soon as possible to restore
the Anti-Lock brake function.
NOTE:
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF
Indicator Light
The ESC activation/
malfunction indicator light on
the instrument cluster will
display when the ignition
switch is in RUN position.
It should switch off by starting the
engine.
If the light stays on with the engine
running, there is a malfunction in the
ESC system.
If the light still stays on after several
ignition cycles, and the vehicle has
been driven for several kilometers at
more than 30 mph (48 km/h) speed,
visit an Authorized Maserati Dealer as
soon as possible to have the problem
diagnosed and serviced.
Each time the ignition switch is in
RUN:
• The ESC off indicator light and the
ESC activation/malfunction indicator
light illuminates temporarily.
• When the ESC is functioning, the
system will make buzzing or clicking
sounds. This is normal. The sounds
will stop once ESC becomes inactive
and the road conditions that caused
the ESC activation no longer persist.
4
This light indicates that the
Electronic Stability Control is
disabled. The related message
will be displayed.
139
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Warning Indicators on Rev Counter
Following indicator lights and linked
messages are displayed on the Rev
Counter on sector 1 of the display (see
“TFT Display” in this chapter).
This indicator lights up when
the rear fog light is switched
on.
High Beam Indicator
This indicator lights up when
the high beams are switched
on or when are flashed by
using the multifunction lever.
Push the left multifunction lever
forward to switch the headlights to
high beam function, and pull toward
yourself (back to normal position) to
reset the low beams.
4
Malfunction messages will be stored in
“Stored Messages” (see example in
picture).
140
Rear Fog Light Indicator
Brake Indicator Light
This light monitors various
brake functions, including
brake fluid level and parking
brake engagement.
If the brake light illuminates the
parking brake may be engaged, the
brake fluid level mat be low or a
problem with the anti-lock brake
system (ABS) reservoir may have
occurred.
In all the above situations, a related
message will be displayed.
If the light still illuminates when the
parking brake has been disengaged,
and the fluid level is at the full mark
on the master cylinder reservoir, there
could be a brake hydraulic system
malfunction or a problem with the
brake booster detected by the ABS/ESC
system.
If this occurs, the light will remain lit
until the problem has been solved.
If the problem concerns the brake
booster, the ABS pump will run when
engaging the brake and a brake pedal
pulsation may be felt during each stop
of the vehicle.
Inefficiency of one of the dual brake
system cycle is indicated by the brake
warning light, which will turn on when
the brake fluid level in the master
cylinder has dropped below a certain
level.
The light will remain lit until the
problem has been diagnosed and
serviced.
If a brake failure occurs, visit the
Authorized Maserati Dealer as soon as
possible in order to have the brake
system checked and serviced.
In the event of an Electronic Brake
Force Distribution (EBD) failure, both
the brake indicator light and the ABS
light illuminate.
Immediate repair of the ABS system is
required.
Functioning of the brake warning light
can be checked by turning the ignition
switch from OFF to RUN position.
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
The light should illuminate for
approximately 2 seconds.
The light should switch off unless the
parking brake is engaged or a brake
fault is detected. If the light does not
illuminate, have the warning light
checked by an Authorized Maserati
Dealer.
The light will also switch on when the
parking brake is engaged with the
ignition switch in RUN position.
This light only indicates the brake is
engaged but not the clamping force
of the parking brake to the wheels. To
fully engage the parking brake, please
refer to “Parking Brake” in section 5.
RUN. If the light does not illuminate
while starting the engine, stays lit, or
switches on while driving, have the
system checked at an Authorized
Maserati Dealer as soon as possible.
In the latter case, the message will
remain displayed: to hide it, press ◄
on the steering wheel right side.
Right Turn Signal Indicator
This indicator lights up when
the right turn signals or the
hazard flashers are switched
on.
The indicator will flash at the same
frequency of the turn signals and is
controlled by the turn signal lever.
If the vehicle electronics sense that the
vehicle drives for more than 1 mile
(1.6 km) with either turn signal on, a
continuous sound will advise the
driver to turn the signal off.
If the indicator flashes at a fast rate,
check for a defective outside indicator
light bulb.
4
Seat Belt Reminder Light
WARNING!
Driving a vehicle with the red brake
light on could be very dangerous and
is not recommended. Part of the brake
system may have failed, resulting in
increased braking distances and the
risk of an accident. Have the vehicle
checked as soon as possible at an
Authorized Maserati Dealer.
Air Bag Indicator Light
This light will illuminate for a
few seconds for a bulb check
when the ignition switch is in
See “Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) – Air bags” in section 2 for
further information.
WARNING!
If the warning light remains ON or if it
does not illuminate or illuminates
while driving, contact your
Authorized Maserati Dealer as soon as
possible.
When the ignition switch is in
RUN, the seat belt reminder
light will light up for a few
seconds as a bulb check.
During the bulb check, you will hear
an acoustic signal if one or both front
seat belts are unbuckled.
After the bulb check or while driving,
if a seat belt remains unbuckled, the
seat belt reminder light will illuminate
in addition to the acoustic signal and a
message will indicate which belt is
unbuckled.
141
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
TFT Display
4
WARNING!
Maserati urges you to use the seat
belts correctly fastened and adjusted
at all times. Correct use of the seat
belts can help reduce the risk of
serious injury in the event of an
accident. Do not pass seat belts over
sharp edges. They could tear. Do not
pin anything to the seat belts. This
could reduce their initial strength and
cause them to tear in the event of a
crash.
Position within the submenus and
scroll arrows (example: 1 of 5).
There can be maximum 9
displayable submenu positions.
When the number of submenu
points exceeds 9, the points are
replaced by a numerical value
within the scroll arrows (in the
example: 12).
5
Submenu Titles.
6
Menu Instruction.
7
(P, R, N, D, M) shift position
indicator.
8
Sport or Normal driving mode.
9
Gear engaged.
10
Complete Odometer.
11
Engine Temperature Gauge.
12
Fuel Gauge.
13
Distinctive Quadrants for
indicators according to priority
and function (see “Indicators on
Display” in this chapter).
When operating, the TFT Display is
divided into sectors including menus
and sub-menus, running data, warning
lights and messages.
The different sectors of the display
layout are shown in the following
picture.
Refer to “Occupant Restraint Systems”
in section 2 for further information.
142
4
1
Main area.
2
User-selectable information
(data, time, temperature,
compass, etc.).
3
Main menu titles with scroll
arrows.
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
The display background may change
according to the type of message
displayed.
• Blue color: normal conditions.
• Yellow color: low-critical warning.
• Red color: high-critical warning.
Main- and Submenu
Operate the controls on the right side
of the steering wheel to scroll, modify
and program the Main- and Submenu.
Press and release the switch (►) to
enter the information screens or a
submenu. Keep the switch (►) pressed
for 2 seconds to restore the
selected/displayed functions.
The sub-menu title selected will be
displayed in sector 5 (Submenu Title).
Within a submenu, press and release
the ▲ and ▼arrow buttons to scroll
through the menu.
Press the ◄ button to return to the
main menu from an item of interest or
from an information screen.
4
Press and release the multifunction
switch in the ▲ and ▼ arrow
directions to scroll upwards and
downwards the main menu titles.
The main screen area in sector 1
(Menu Area) will be updated and the
selected title will be shown in sector 3
(Main Menu Title).
143
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Main Menu & Submenu Content Overview
Pos.
4
144
Main menu
Submenus
1.
DIGITAL SPEED SPEEDOMETER
From mph
to km/h or vice
versa
2.
VEHICLE INFO
Individual Tire
Pressure Monitor
3.
FUEL ECONOMY
Current, Range,
Average
TRIP A
Distance,
Average, Avg.
speed, Elapsed
Time
5.
TRIP B
Distance,
Average, Avg.
speed, Elapsed
Time
6.
AUDIO
Current media
Source and track
7.
STORED
MESSAGES
Example: Coolant
Low
8.
SCREEN SETUP
Cluster upper left Cluster upper
Restore Defaults
information
right information
9.
VEHICLE
SETTINGS
Electric Parking
Brake Disable
4.
Transmission
Temperature
Set Speed
Warning
Oil Temperature
Oil Pressure
AWD Torque
Distribution (V6
Engine only)
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
1. DIGITAL SPEED — SPEEDOMETER
Press and release the central switch in
the ▲ or ▼ arrow directions until
"Digital Speed" is displayed.
Pressing and releasing the switch (►)
will toggle the unit of measure
between mph or km/h.
Press and release the ◄ button to
return to the main menu.
2. VEHICLE INFO
Press and release the switch in the ▲
or ▼ arrow directions until "Vehicle
Info" is displayed.
Press and release the switch (►) to
access the submenu.
Press and release the switch in the ▲
or ▼ arrow directions to scroll
through the following information
displays and in the (►) arrow direction
to visualize the selected information.
• Individual tire pressure monitor
Indicates the pressure of each
individual tire (see example below).
Please refer to “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” in
section 5 for further information.
• Transmission temperature
Displays the current transmission
temperature.
• Oil Temperature
Displays the current engine oil
temperature.
• Oil Pressure
Displays the current engine oil
pressure (see example).
• AWD Torque Distribution (V6
Engine)
Display a vehicle icon with torque
distribution in front and rear axle
and “AWD” if all wheel drive is
active. Displays “RWD” if all wheel
drive is inactive.
4
V6 Engine
Press and release the ◄ button to
return to the main menu.
145
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
3. FUEL ECONOMY
Press and release the switch in the ▲
or ▼ arrow directions until "Fuel
Economy" is displayed.
4
The screen will display the following:
• Current fuel economy in mpg or
l/100km
Shows the instantaneous fuel
economy.
• Range in miles or km
Shows the range since the last fuel
average reset.
When the fuel economy is reset, the
display will read “Reset” or show
dashes for two seconds.
Then, the history information will be
erased, and the averaging will
continue from the last fuel average
reading before the reset.
146
• Fuel economy average in mpg or
l/100km
Shows the average fuel economy
since the last reset.
Press the central switch (►) for 1
second and release to reset the Fuel
Economy “Average”.
When the fuel economy is reset, the
display will read “Reset” or show
dashes for two seconds.
Then, the history information will be
erased, and the averaging will
continue from the last fuel average
reading before the reset.
Press and release the ◄ button to
return to the main menu.
4. TRIP A – 5. TRIP B
Press and release the switch in the ▲
or ▼ arrow directions until "Trip A" or
“Trip B” is displayed.
The screen will display the following:
• Distance traveled in miles or km
Shows the total covered distance
since the last reset.
• Average consumption in mpg or
l/100km
Shows the average fuel
consumption since the last reset.
• Average speed in mph or km/h
Shows the average speed since the
last reset.
• Elapsed Time
Shows the total time of travel since
the last reset in
“hours:minutes:seconds” Elapsed
Time will increment when the
ignition switch is in the RUN or
START position.
Press the central switch (►) for 1
second and release to reset Trip A or
Trip B.
Press and release the ◄ button to
return to the main menu.
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
6. AUDIO
Press and release the switch in the ▲
or ▼ arrow directions until “Audio” is
displayed.
7. STORED MESSAGES
The display will show the audio status
(source and information) as set on the
MTC. It is possible to display up to 13
alphanumeric characters. Displays
Audio Status are:
Press and release the central switch in
the ▲ or ▼ arrow directions until
“Stored Messages” is displayed.
The system will either display the
number of the stored messages (if any
available) or “No Stored Messages” as
shown in picture.
Press and release the switch in the ▲
or ▼ arrow directions to scroll the
stored messages.
When the number of messages
exceeds 9, the submenu points will be
replaced by a numerical value
indicating the message number. Press
and release the switch (►) to view the
selected message (for example
“Transmission too Hot”). Press and
release the ◄ button to return to the
main menu.
4
• AM: Frequency;
• FM: Frequency, Station provided
info;
• CD: Track info;
• UCI/BTSA with metadata: Artist,
Song, Album.
Press and release the ◄ button to
return to the main menu.
147
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
• OK.
• Cancel.
For the “Upper Right” and “Upper
Left” titles there are following
options:
8. SCREEN SETUP
Press and release the switch in the ▲
or ▼ arrow directions until “Screen
Setup” is displayed.
Press and release the switch (►) to
access the submenu.
If the vehicle exceeds 5 mph (8 km/h),
this feature is locked out and the main
screen shows “Screen Setup
Unavailable While in Motion”.
Scroll the positions on the menu with
the switch in the ▲ or ▼ arrow
directions:
4
• None.
• Compass.
• Outside Temperature.
• Date.
• Time (see picture).
• Restore Defaults.
• Upper Right (see picture).
Operate this function with the vehicle
stopped and transmission in P (Park)
position.
In order to enter a function, press the
switch (►) as shown in the picture.
• Upper Left.
Press and release the central switch
(►) to view the options related to the
menu title selected.
For the “Restore Defaults” title there
are following options:
148
• Time & Date.
• Range to Empty.
• Average fuel consumption MPG (or
L/100km).
• Current fuel consumption MPG (or
L/100km).
• Trip A Distance.
• Trip B Distance.
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Scroll with the switch in the ▲ or ▼
arrow directions to view the selectable
item. A check mark will remain next to
the previously selected item until a
new selection is made.
Press and release the switch (►) to
select an item. “Setting Saved”
notification appears as a popup for 2
seconds, then the display will show
the last modified item.
The images show the default items,
which are also displayed on the upper
part of the MTC.
9. VEHICLE SETTINGS
Press and release the switch in the ▲
or ▼ arrow directions until “Vehicle
Settings” is displayed.
Press and release the switch (►) to
access the submenu.
If the vehicle exceeds 5 mph (8 km/h),
this feature is locked out and the main
screen shows “Vehicle Settings
Unavailable While in Motion”.
4
Press and release the ◄ button to
return to the main menu.
Operate this function with the vehicle
stopped and transmission in P (Park)
position.
In order to enter a function, press the
switch (►) as shown in the picture.
149
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Example: How to modify the Speed
Warning Status
Scroll with the switch in the ▲ or ▼
arrow directions to view the selectable
items.
Press and release the switch (►) to
select “Speed Warning”.
4
Scroll with the switch in the ▲ or ▼
arrow directions to view the selectable
options.
Speed values are in loop, keeping the
switch pressed in the ▲ or ▼ arrow
directions will increase scroll speed.
Press and release the switch (►) to
select the option. A check mark will
remain next to the previously selected
item until a new selection is made.
Scroll with the switch in the ▲ or ▼
arrow directions to view the selectable
items:
• Electric Park Brake.
• Speed Warning.
NOTE:
In order to modify the “Electric Park
Brake” function, please see chapter
“Parking Brake” in section 5.
Press and release the switch (►) once
again to view the related options:
“Off” is the default status.
The “Setting Saved” notification
appears as a popup for 2 seconds, then
the display will show the last modified
item.
150
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Examples of this message type are
"Right Front Turn Signal Light Out"
and "Tire Pressure” low (as shown
in the picture).
When the set speed is exceeded, the
driver is alerted by an acoustic signal,
a telltale indicating the speed limit,
and a pop-up message indicating that
the limit has been exceeded.
The pop-up message and the telltale
will be displayed for 5 seconds before
returning to the previous menu.
Messages on Main Display Area
The main display area also displays
"pop up" messages. These pop up
messages fall into several categories:
• Five-Second Stored Messages
When the appropriate conditions
occur, this type of message appears
on the main display area for five
seconds and then returns to the
previous screen. Most of the
messages of this type are then
stored (as long as the condition that
activated it remains active) and can
be reviewed from the "Stored
Messages" main menu item. As long
as there is a stored message, an "i"
will be displayed in the
compass/outside temp sector.
4
• Unstored Messages
This message type is displayed until
the condition that activated the
message is cleared.
Examples of this message type are
"Turn Signal On" (if a turn signal is
left on) and "Lights On" (if the
driver leaves the vehicle).
151
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
• Unstored Messages with Ignition
Switch in RUN
This message type is displayed until
the ignition switch is in RUN
position. An example of this
message type is "Press Brake and
Push Button to Start" (as shown in
the picture).
• Five-Second-displayed Navigation
Messages
When the navigation menu is
enabled on the MTC, information
pop ups will be displayed for 5
seconds while changing direction or
approaching a turning point.
On highway, the first pop up will be
displayed at 2 miles (3.2 km) from
the turn, on roadway, at 1 mile
(1.6 km).
4
• Five-Second Unstored Messages
When appropriate conditions occur,
this type of message appears on the
main display area for five seconds
then returns to the previous screen.
Examples of this message type are
"Memory System Unavailable
Vehicle Not in Park" and "Automatic
High Beams Enabled".
152
While approaching the turn, further
pop ups will be displayed starting at
430 yd (400 m) from the turning
point and the countdown to 0 miles
(meters).
Warning Lights on Display
NOTE:
• In sector 13 of the display more
telltales are displayed while
dedicated messages are shown on
sector 1 for 5 seconds, unless
otherwise indicated.
• Malfunction messages will be saved
in “Stored Messages”.
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Charging System Warning Light
This telltale shows the status
of the electrical charging
system. If the telltale stays on
or comes on while driving,
turn off some of the vehicle's
non-essential electrical devices or
increase engine speed (if at idle). If
the charging system telltale remains
on, it means that the vehicle is
experiencing a problem with the
charging system. IMMEDIATELY
contact an Authorized Maserati
Dealer to have the vehicle serviced.
If jump starting is required, refer to
“Jump Start Procedures” in section 6.
Automatic Transmission Failure
Indicator
This indicator and related
displayed message, indicate
transmission failure. If the
failure permits, slowly drive to
the nearest Maserati Service Center.
Engine Temperature Warning Light
This warning light notifies
when the engine is
overheated. As temperature
rises and the gage displayed in
sector 11 approaches “H”, this
warning light will illuminate
combined with the related displayed
message, and triggering and acoustic
signal by reaching the set threshold.
If the warning light switches on while
driving, safely pull over and stop the
vehicle. If the A/C system is on, turn it
off. Also, shift the transmission into N
(Neutral) and idle the vehicle. If the
temperature does not return to
normal, immediately turn the engine
off and contact an Authorized
Maserati Dealer.
Check “Engine Overheating” in
section 6 for more information.
Low Oil Pressure Indicator
Under normal conditions, the
warning light illuminates
when the ignition switch is
turned to RUN and goes off as
soon as the engine is started.
If the warning light stays or turns on
while driving, the engine oil pressure
is too low. The warning light is
combined with a displayed message
and an acoustic signal that will last 4
minutes. In this case, turn the engine
off immediately and carry out the
necessary checks.
Do not operate the vehicle until the
problem has been checked and
serviced. This light does not indicate
the oil level. The engine oil level must
be checked with the dipstick located
under the engine hood (see
“Maintenance Procedures” in section
7).
If the problem persists, contact an
Authorized Maserati Dealer.
Engine Oil Temperature Indicator
This light indicates that the
engine oil is overheated. The
indicator is combined with the
related displayed message. In
this case, drive carefully until the
temperature drops back to normal
level and the indicator light turns off.
If the problem persists, contact an
Authorized Maserati Dealer.
4
Low Engine Oil Level Indicator
This indicator and the related
displayed message, indicate a
low engine oil level.
The engine oil level must be
checked with the dipstick fitted under
the engine lid (see “Maintenance
Procedures” in section 7).
Power Steering Failure Warning Light
This warning light, and the
related message, illuminate
when the Electric Power
Steering is not operating and
needs service.
If the problem persists, contact an
Authorized Maserati Dealer.
153
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC)
Indicator
4
154
This light combined to the
related message displayed on
sector 1 for 5 seconds,
indicates a failure of the
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC)
system. If the indicator turns on while
driving, have the system checked by
the Authorized Maserati Dealer.
When detecting a failure, the light
indicator will illuminate while the
engine is running. Cycle the ignition
switch when the vehicle has
completely stopped and the shift lever
is placed in P (Park) position: the light
indicator should turn off.
If the indicator remains lit with the
engine running, you can still drive your
vehicle. However, contact the
Authorized Maserati Dealer as soon as
possible.
If the indicator is flashing while the
engine is running, immediate service is
required. You may experience reduced
performance, an elevated/rough idle
or engine stall and your vehicle may
require towing.
Catalyst Over Temperature Indicator
This warning light, and the
related message, light up if
the engine runs irregularly
with consequent high
temperature in the exhaust system.
WARNING!
• If the warning light is accompanied
by the message “Catalyst Temp
Getting Hot Reduce Speed”: the
temperature of the catalytic
converters is too high. The driver
must slow down immediately until
the warning light turns off.
• If the message “Catalyst Temp Hot
Stop Safely Wait To Cool” appears
after decelerating: the temperature
in the catalytic converters has
reached an abnormal level and the
catalytic converters could be
damaged. Drive slowly to the
nearest workshop.
• If the light turns on permanently 3
times the engine will stop. It will be
possible to restart the vehicle only
after a key-off / key-on cycle. Then
slowly drive to the nearest Maserati
Service Center.
• Maserati is not responsible for
damage deriving from noncompliance with the above
mentioned warnings.
Door Ajar Indicator
This indicator illuminates
when one or more doors are
ajar. The indicator will show
which door is ajar. When one
or more doors are open, a related
message will be displayed if the vehicle
is running at speed 5 mph (8 km/h) or
faster.
Trunk and Engine Lid Ajar Indicators
These light indicators will
illuminate to indicate that the
trunk or engine lid is ajar.
When the trunk or engine
compartment is open, a
related message will be
displayed with the warning
indicator if the vehicle is running at
speed 5 mph (8 km/h) or faster.
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Low Fuel Indicator
When the fuel level reaches
approximately 4.2 Gallons
(16.0 L) this light will turn on,
and remain on until fuel is
added; the related message will also
be displayed.
Refer to “Refueling” in section 5 for
fuel filling.
Windshield and Headlights Washer
Low Fluid Indicator
This indicator will illuminate
for 5 seconds to indicate a low
level of the windshield and
headlamp washer fluid. A
related message will be displayed.
See “Maintenance Procedures” in
section 7 for fluid filling.
Adaptive Light Control System Failure
This indicator, and the related
message, indicate a failure of
the automatic headlight
aiming system.
Please contact an Authorized Maserati
Dealer to check the system.
Suspension Failure Indicator
This indicator light and the
related message turn on
during driving if there is a
failure of the suspension
Please contact an Authorized Maserati
Dealer to check the system.
with hot engine or exhaust
components and cause a fire.
Transmission Temperature Warning
Light
Ice Hazard Warning Light
This warning light and the
related message indicate that
the transmission fluid
temperature is rising.
If this warning light turns on, safely
pull over and stop the vehicle.
Then, shift the transmission into P
(Park) and run the engine at idle or
faster until the temperature drops and
the light switches off. If the problem
persists, contact an Authorized
Maserati Dealer.
CAUTION!
Continuous driving with the
transmission temperature warning
light illuminated will eventually cause
severe transmission damage or failure.
WARNING!
If the transmission temperature
warning light is illuminated and you
continue operating the vehicle, in
some circumstances you could cause
the fluid to boil over, come in contact
When the external
temperature falls below 37°F
(3°C), the temperature value
blinks for a few seconds, the
warning light turns on, a message is
displayed and an acoustic signal is
triggered to warn the driver of the
risk of icy roadbed.
Under such conditions, we recommend
to use the I C E drive mode (see
“Automatic Transmission” in section 5)
drive carefully and slow down as the
grip of the tires may be significantly
reduced.
The warning light flashes for 5
seconds and switches off when the
temperature reaches 43°F (6°C) or
higher.
4
Brake Pads Wear Warning Light
This warning light and the
related message indicate that
the brake pads have reached
their wear limit.
Please contact an Authorized Maserati
Dealer to have them replaced.
system.
155
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Electric Parking Brake Failure Warning
Light
4
156
This warning light and related
message illuminate when
there is an EPB system failure.
The failure could also completely or
partially block the vehicle because the
parking brake could remain on even
after it has been automatically or
manually disengaged though its
controls. In this situation it is possible
to release the parking brake by
following the emergency release
procedure as indicated in chapter
“Emergency Release of the Parking
Brake” in Section 6.
If it is still possible to use the vehicle
(parking brake not engaged) drive to
the nearest Authorized Maserati
Dealer and remember to performing
each operation/command that the
electric parking brake is not
functioning.
Oil Change Required Indicator
The “Oil Change Required”
message flashes on the display
for approximately 5 seconds
after an acoustic signal and it
indicates that the next scheduled oil
change is due.
The engine oil change indicator system
is duty cycle based, which means the
engine oil change interval may
fluctuate according to your personal
driving style. Unless reset, this message
will continue to display each time you
cycle the ignition to the RUN position.
To turn off the message temporarily,
press and release the ◄ button. To
reset the oil change indicator system
please visit a Maserati Service Center.
Indicators in Sector 13 of the Display
Cruise Control, lights on and gear shift
indicators are displayed in sector 13 on
the right side of the total odometer.
Speed Limit Exceeded Warning Light
Electronic Cruise Control ON Indicator
This warning light and related
message illuminate when the
set speed limit is exceeded (in
the example shown: 40 mph
or km/h).
This light indicator and related
message will illuminate when
the electronic cruise control is
ON. For further information,
check “Electronic Cruise Control” in
section 5.
Electronic Cruise Control in Stand-by
Indicator
This light indicator and related
message will illuminate when
the electronic cruise control is
in stand-by. For further
information, check “Electronic Cruise
Control” in section 5.
Electronic Cruise Control SET Indicator
This light indicator and related
message will illuminate when
the electronic cruise control is
SET. For further information,
check “Electronic Cruise Control” in
section 5.
Park/Headlight On Indicator
This indicator will illuminate
when the park lights or
headlights are turned on.
For further information, see
“Lights” in section 3.
Gear Shift Indicator Light
This indicator lights up to
indicate gear shift change in
order to optimize fuel
consumption, see “Drive
Mode” in section 5 for further
information.
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Service AWD System Message (V6
Engine)
Infotainment System
The message on the TFT display will
illuminate when all wheel drive
feature requires service. For further
information, refer to “All-Wheel
Drive” in section 5.
The vehicle is equipped with the
infotainment Maserati Touch Control
(MTC) System, an advanced user
interface which combines innovative
and exclusive technical features
integrating entertainment, user
settings, air conditioning, navigation,
communication and information
features within a single system.
The MTC System features an audio
system which is acoustically optimized
for this specific vehicle.
V6 Engine
This vehicle is provided with a
description of the MTC System
features and listing of warnings and
precautions, which are essential for
safe use of the system. Maserati
advises you to read this addendum
carefully and thoroughly.
4
WARNING!
The navigation system assists the
driver while driving, providing advice
and suggestions, by voice guidance
and graphic information, for the best
route to reach the set destination. The
suggestions provided by the
navigation system do not relieve the
driver from full responsibility for the
maneuvers made through traffic while
driving, or from compliance with road
regulations and other provisions
regarding road traffic. The person
driving the vehicle is always and in
any case responsible for safe driving
on the road.
157
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
MTC Controls
Hard Keys
MTC System has a series of tools,
controls and soft-keys that are
designed to use external multimedia
resources and different audio options,
to change settings and to perform
other functions.
All controls are positioned in the
central part of the dashboard.
• SD Card slot
Insert an SD Card containing any
navigation information, perform
navigation functions and play media
files (music and images).
1
ON/OFF and Volume control.
2
Enter/Browse and Tune/Scroll
knob.
3
Card slot.
4
CD/DVD slot.
5
“Radio” soft-key.
6
“Player” soft-key.
7
“Controls” soft-key.
8
“Climate” soft-key.
9
“Nav” soft-key.
10
“Phone” soft-key.
11
“Settings” soft-key.
4
158
• CD/DVD slot
To be used when in Player mode.
When inserting a disc, make sure the
label is facing up. Press the lateral
button to eject the disc.
• ON/OFF and Volume
Press the central button (1) to turn
the unit on or off. Rotate the
external regulator on the central
button (1) to adjust the volume.
If the ignition is switched off
(ignition switch in OFF) with the
radio in stand-by mode, the radio
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
memorizes the stand-by mode for
recall at the next ignition cycle.
Press the central button to turn the
radio on.
It is possible to eject the CD and to
display the time if the system is off.
The navigation software is always
working when the ignition is
switched on, even if the radio is in
standby mode.
• Enter/Browse and Tune/Scroll
Press the central button to accept a
highlighted selection on the screen.
Rotate the external regulator to
scroll through a list or tune a radio
station.
Touch-Screen Keys
The soft keys located on the lower
part of the MTC display, enable
different function modes as briefly
indicated below. For further
information refer to the dedicated
booklet included in the owner
documentation.
• Radio soft-key (5)
Press the Radio soft-key to enter the
Radio mode. The different tuner
modes: AM, FM and SAT can be
selected by touching the related
soft-keys in the Radio mode.
• Player soft-key (6)
Press the Player soft-key to access
media sources such as: Disc, USB
Device and AUX as long as the
requested media is present.
• Controls soft-key (7)
Press the Controls soft-key to access
the Settings list. Controls such as;
Heated Seats, Heated Steering
Wheel, Ventilated Seats, etc. can be
selected or turned ON/OFF by
touching the related soft-key.
• Climate soft-key (8)
Press the Climate soft-key to access
the air conditioning settings. See
“Air Conditioning Controls” in this
section for further details.
• Nav soft-key (9)
Press the Nav soft-key to access the
Navigation feature.
• Phone soft-key (10)
Press the Phone soft-key to access
the MTC Phone feature.
• Settings soft-key (11)
Press the Settings soft-key to access
the list of settings.
Audio Controls
The vehicle is equipped with audio
controls that allow both driver and
front passenger to operate the audio
system without using the touch-screen
keys on the MTC display. These
controls can be used to adjust audio
volume, change radio station or mode
(AM, FM, CD, etc).
Steering Wheel Audio Controls
The sound system controls are
rocker-type switches with a button in
the center and are located on the rear
side of the steering wheel, right
behind the front switches.
The right-hand control manages
volume and mode of the sound
system.
By pressing the top of the rocker
switch you can increase the volume,
and by pressing the bottom of the
rocker switch you can lower it. Press
the center button to switch radio
mode (AM, FM, CD, etc.). The
left-hand control functions depend on
the current mode set with the
right-hand control, and are the
following ones.
4
159
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Rotate the regulation knob clockwise
to increase volume, counter-clockwise
to lower volume.
Rotate the right knob to scroll through
the menus and change the user’s
settings (see “MTC Settings” in section
4).
Radio Operation
Pressing the top of the switch will Seek
up for the next received station and
pressing the bottom of the switch will
seek down for the next received
station.
The button fitted in the center of the
left-hand control will tune to the next
preset station set on the MTC preset
button.
4
160
CD Player
MTC Side Audio Controls
A light press on the top of the switch
will play the next track on the CD.
Pressing the bottom of the switch once
will go to the beginning of the current
track, or to the beginning of the
previous track if it is within one second
after the current track begins to play.
If you press the switch up or down
twice, it plays the second track; three
times, it will play the third, etc.
The center button on the left side
rocker switch has no function for a
single-disc CD player. However, if the
vehicle is equipped with a
multiple-disc CD player, the center
button will select the next available CD
in the player.
On both sides of the MTC display there
are two rotating devices (knobs) with a
central button.
Press the central button on the left
side to turn the MTC on and off; rotate
the knob to set the audio volume.
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Audio System
The vehicle is equipped with an audio
system that offers superior sound
quality, higher sound pressure levels
and reduced energy consumption.
The new system maximizes the
amplifier and speaker technology
delivering substantially higherperforming components and system
efficiency.
The standard sound system
"Premium" features 10 speakers and
can develop a sound output of 760 W.
The standard system includes:
• 6.5 in (165 mm) CFR Woofer: 2 x 165
mm in the front doors.
• 6.5 in (165 mm) Black Kevlar Woofer:
2 x 165 mm in the rear doors.
• 4 in (100 mm) Yellow Kevlar
Midrange: 1 x center dashboard, 2 x
in the front doors, 2 x L/R surround.
• 1 in (25 mm) MMX Tweeter: 1 x
Center, 2 x on the dashboard L/R, 2 x
in the rear doors.
• 13.7 x 7.9 in (350 x 200 mm)
Racetrack Sub Dual VC: 1 x on the
rear parcel shelf.
• 16-channel 1280 Watts Class-D
amplifier in the trunk.
The system is supplied with a 12
channel high efficiency amplifier and
is operated by a high voltage tracking
power supply and drives a 7.5-channel
playback architecture. This audio
system offers the ability to choose
4
• Four 6.5 in (165 mm) diameter
Woofers, one on each door.
• One 3.15 in (80 mm) diameter
Midrange diameter, on the top of
the dashboard.
• One 1 in (25 mm) diameter Tweeter,
2 on the upper edges of the
dashboard and 2 on rear doors.
• One 7x10 in (180x250 mm)
Subwoofer on the rear panel below
the rear window.
The vehicle can be equipped with an
"High Premium" audio system
including 15 speakers and 1280 W of
sound power, available upon request.
The optional “High Premium” sound
system includes:
161
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
4
162
Logic 7® surround sound for any audio
source. The high-efficiency speaker
design ensures higher Sound Pressure
Level (SPL) and exceptional dynamic
sound quality.
The speakers are tuned for maximum
efficiency and compatible with the
amplifier output stage ensuring best
updated surround sound processing.
Logic 7® multichannel surround sound
technology delivers an immersive,
accurate sound stage throughout the
passenger compartment.
This surround effect is available from
any audio source - AM/FM/CD/Satellite
Radio or AUX input; and is activated
through the MTC System controls. By
selecting “Audio Surround”, you can
activate the Logic 7® multichannel
surround-sound technology in your
vehicle. All information on the current
operational mode are listed in the
specific booklet included in the on
board documentation.
The driver selectable “Video
Surround” mode (DSS) is available only
for video media sources (DVDs, Video
CDs, or other video media supported
by the radio). Some audio will sound
better in “DSS” modes, some other in
“Stereo” mode.
When in “Audio Surround” mode,
balance is set automatically. Fader
control is available in surround mode
but it should be set to the center
position for optimal surround
performance.
MTC Settings
The MTC System uses a combination of
keys able to access and change the
customer programmable features.
Touch-screen keys are displayed on the
lower part of the MTC display
positioned centrally on the dashboard.
There is a Scroll/Enter control knob
located on the right side of the MTC
display.
Turn the control knob to scroll through
menus and change settings (i.e., 30, 60,
90), press the button in the center of
the control knob one or more times to
select or change a setting (i.e., ON,
OFF).
NOTE:
For further details refer to the
Maserati Touch Control guide.
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Customer Programmable
Features — MTC Settings
Press the Settings soft-key to display
the programmable features menu.
In this mode the MTC System allows
you to access following programmable
features (some of them are optional
and may not be available on your
vehicle): Display, Clock & Date, Safety
& Driving Assistance, Lights, Doors &
Locks, Auto-On Comfort & Remote
Start, Engine Off Options, Audio,
Phone/Bluetooth and SIRIUS XM
Setup.
NOTE:
Only one touchscreen area or key may
be selected at a time.
To make a selection, and enter the
desired function, press the
corresponding soft-key on the menu
(the picture shown is “Doors and
Locks”).
To scroll through the functions, move
the cursor up or down, or press the
arrow ▼ or ▲. Once the desired mode
is entered, press and release the
touch-screen area of the setting that
you wish to modify. The new setting
will be highlighted with one or more
boxes to indicate status or possible
variants of the function status. A
check mark in a box indicates the
current status of the function. Press
the checkmark to cancel, or the empty
box to insert the check mark, and
change the status of the function.
Once the procedure is completed (for
example, Display mode) press the ◄
back arrow soft-key to return to the
previous menu or press the upper
right X soft-key, to close the settings
screen. Pressing the ▲ or ▼ soft keys
and the cursor on the right side of the
screen will allow you to scroll up or
down through the available settings.
4
163
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Display
After pressing the Display soft-key the
following mode settings will be
available.
• Display mode
When in this display you can select
one of the auto display settings. To
change mode status, touch and
release the Day, Night or Auto
soft-key.
4
• Display Brightness with Headlights
On
When in this display, you can select
the brightness with the headlights
on. Adjust the brightness with the +
and – setting soft-keys or by
selecting any point on the scale
between the + and – soft-keys.
164
• Display Brightness with Headlights
Off
When in this display, you can select
the brightness with the headlights
off. Adjust the brightness as
previously explained.
• Set language
When in this display, you can select
one of available languages for all
display descriptions, including the
trip functions and the navigation
system.
• Units
When in this display, you can select
between US and Metric units of
measurement in the instrument
cluster, odometer and navigation
system. The speed unit, shown in
digital format on the TFT display of
the instrument cluster, is defined
and modifiable through the controls
located on the right side of the
steering wheel (see “TFT Display” in
chapter “Instrument Cluster” of this
section).
• Voice Response Length
When in this display, you can change
the voice response length settings.
To change the voice response
length, touch the Brief or Detailed
soft-key.
• Touchscreen Beep
When in this display, you can turn
on or shut off the sound activated
by pressure of a touch screen button
(soft-key).
• Control Screen Time-Out
Use this mode to operate the timing
of the control screen display.
• Navigation Turn-by-Turn Displayed
on Cluster
By selecting this feature, the
turn-by-turn directions will appear
on the instrument cluster along a
programmed route until the desired
destination is reached (see picture).
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
• Set Time Minutes
When in this mode, you can set the
minutes manually. To select, touch
the + or – soft-keys as done for the
hours.
Clock & Date
Time is always visible on the
dashboard analog clock and in digital
format on the instrument cluster and
on the MTC display.
With this feature it is possible to view
and set the following modes.
• Sync with GPS or Radio Time
When in this mode, time is
automatically set and synchronized
to the GPS or radio signal.
• Set Time Hours
When in this mode, you can set the
hours manually. To select, touch the
+ or – soft-keys to adjust the hours.
• Time Format
When in this mode, you can select
the time format display. To change
the current setting, touch and
release the 12 Hrs or 24 Hrs button.
• Set Date in Cluster (MM/DD/YY)
When in this mode, you can set the
date manually in the status bar of
the MTC and on the instrument
panel display.
4
Safety & Driving Assistance
Press the “Safety & Driving Assistance”
soft-key to set the following modes.
• Park Assist
The rear park assist system will scan
for objects behind the vehicle when
the transmission shift lever is in R
(Reverse) and the vehicle speed is
less than 11 mph (18 km/h). The
system can be enabled with Sound
only, Sound + Display, or turned Off.
See “ParkSense® Park Assist” in
section 2 for further information.
165
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
• Rain Sensing Auto Wipers
By selecting this feature, the system
will automatically activate the
windshield wipers if it senses
moisture on the windshield.
Lights
Press the Lights soft-key to set the
following modes.
4
• Tilt Side Mirrors In Reverse
By selecting this feature the outside
side-view mirrors will tilt downward
when the ignition is in RUN position
and the transmission shift lever is in
R (Reverse) position. The mirrors will
move back to their previous position
when the transmission is shifted out
of R (Reverse).
• ParkView Backup Camera
This vehicle is equipped with the
ParkView® rear backup camera
which allows you to see an image of
the rear surroundings of your
vehicle whenever the shift lever is
set in R (Reverse). The image will be
displayed on the MTC display along
with a caution note to “check entire
surroundings”. See “ParkSense®
Park Assist” in section 2 for further
information.
166
• Headlights Off Delay
By selecting this feature, the driver
can choose to have the headlights
off or lit for 30, 60, or 90 seconds
when exiting the vehicle. To change
the current headlight off delay
status, touch and release the 0, 30,
60 or 90 soft-key to select the
desired time range.
• Headlights Illumination on Approach
By selecting this feature, the driver
can choose to have the headlights
off or lit for 30, 60, or 90 seconds
when the doors are unlocked with
the key fob RKE transmitter.
• Headlights with Wipers
By selecting this feature, while the
headlight lever is in “AUTO”
position, the headlights will turn on
approximately 10 seconds after the
wipers are activated. The headlights
will also turn off when the wipers
deactivate if they were activated in
the current mode.
• Auto Dim High Beams
By selecting this feature, the high
beam headlights will deactivate
automatically under certain
conditions. See “Lights” in section 3
for further information.
• Daytime Running Lights
When this feature is selected, the
DRL lights will turn on whenever the
engine is running. To make your
selection, touch the Daytime
Running Lights soft-key, until a
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
transmitter button. When 1st
press of key fob unlocks is selected,
you must press the key fob RKE
transmitter button twice to
unlock the passenger's doors. When
unlock all doors by 1st press
selection mode, all doors will unlock
on the first press of the key fob RKE
transmitter button.
check-mark appears next to setting,
showing that setting has been
selected.
• Steering Directed Headlights
By selecting this feature, the
headlights rotate following the
steering wheel direction change.
• Headlights Dip (Traffic Changeover)
By selecting this feature, the
headlights will change their
luminous distribution when a
left-hand-drive vehicle enter a
Country with right-hand-drive
system and vice versa.
• Flash Lamps with Lock
By selecting this feature, the
headlights will flash when the doors
are locked or unlocked with the key
fob RKE transmitter.
Doors & Locks
Press the Doors & Locks soft-key to set
the following modes.
• Auto Door Locks
This feature allows you to lock the
vehicle’s door(s) without having to
press the key fob RKE transmitter
button. See “Passive Entry
System” in section 2.
• Auto Unlock on Exit
By selecting this feature, all doors
will unlock when the vehicle is
stopped, the transmission is in P
(Park) or N (Neutral) position and
the driver's door is open.
• Flash Lamps with Lock
By selecting this feature, the
headlights will flash when the doors
are locked or unlocked with the key
fob RKE transmitter.
• Sound Horn with Lock
By selecting this feature, the horn
will sound when the doors are
locked or unlocked with the key fob
RKE transmitter.
NOTE:
If the vehicle is programmed on 1st
Press of Key Fob Unlocks:
• all doors will unlock no matter which
Passive Entry equipped door handle
is grasped;
• only the driver’s door will unlock
when the driver’s door is grasped;
• with Passive Entry, touching the
handle more than once will only
result in the driver’s door opening.
4
If driver door first is selected, once the
driver door is opened, the interior
door lock/unlock switch can be used to
unlock all doors (or use key fob RKE
transmitter).
• 1st Press of Key Fob Unlocks
By operating the 1st Press of the Key
Fob Unlocks mode you may set up
only the driver's door will unlock on
the first press of the key fob RKE
167
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
• Passive Entry
By selecting this feature, Passive
Entry may be programmed to on or
off. The default status is on. With
Passive Entry deactivated, also the
“Pre-Short Drop” function is
disabled (for further information,
refer to “Bodywork Maintenance
and Care” in section 7).
4
• Personal Settings Linked to Key Fob
By selecting this mode, the key fob
can be programmed with the
driver’s personal position settings.
These settings will be implemented
when pressing the button on the
remote control.
Auto-On Comfort & Remote Start
By pressing the Auto-on Comfort
soft-key the following setting will be
available.
• Auto-on Driver Heated/Ventilated
Seat & Steering Wheel with Vehicle
Start
By selecting this feature the driver’s
heated seat and heated steering
wheel will automatically activate
when the temperature is below 40°F
(4°C). When temperatures are above
80°F (26°C) the driver vented seat
will turn on.
168
Engine Off
This feature allows certain functions
after turning off the engine.
• Easy Exit Seat
This feature provides automatic
driver seat positioning to enhance
driver mobility when entering and
exiting the vehicle.
• Engine off Power Delay (Power
duration after engine shutdown)
By selecting this feature, the power
window switches, radio, MTC
System, DVD video system (for
versions/markets, where provided),
power sunroof, and power outlets
will remain active for up to 10
minutes after the ignition switch is
cycled to OFF. Opening of one front
door will cancel this feature.
The switch-off delay can be canceled
(0 seconds) or reduced to 5 minutes
or 45 seconds.
• Headlights off delay
By selecting this feature the
headlights will stay lit for up to 90
seconds after turning off the
engine.
The switch-off delay can be canceled
(0 seconds) or reduced to 60 or 30
seconds.
Audio
This feature enables to view and set
the available audio modes depending
on the type of audio system supplied
on the car.
The following modes refer to the
“High Premium” audio system.
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
• Balance/Fade
Use this screen to adjust the Balance
and Fade settings.
• Speed Adjusted Volume
This feature increases or decreases
volume combined to vehicle speed.
To change the speed adjusted
volume touch the Off, 1, 2 or 3
soft-key.
• Surround Sound (only for “High
Premium” audio system)
This feature provides simulated
surround sound mode. To make
your selection, press Stereo,
Audience or On Stage.
4
• Equalizer
Use this screen to adjust the Bass,
Mid and Treble settings. Adjust the
settings with the + and – setting
soft-keys or by selecting any point
on the scale between the + and –
soft-keys.
• Music Info Cleanup
This feature helps organizing music
files for optimized music navigation.
Phone/Bluetooth
Press the Phone/Bluetooth soft-key to
select and connect phones and audio
sources.
• Paired Phones
• Paired Audio Sources
By selecting one of these options you
will be notified which phones or
which audio sources are combined to
the Phone/Bluetooth system.
For each option, you can also add a
device and change the PIN code of the
device you wish to connect. For
further information, see the MTC
guide.
169
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
NOTE:
On the Maserati website, at
www.maserati.com, or through the
Authorized Maserati Dealer you may
consult the list of telephones that are
compatible with the MTC, and their
level of compatibility.
4
SIRIUS XM Setup
After pressing the SIRIUS XM Setup
soft-key the following settings will be
available.
• Channel Skip
SIRIUS XM can be programmed to
designate a group of channels that
are the most desirable to listen to or
to exclude undesirable channels
while scanning. To make your
selection, touch the Channel Skip
soft-key, select the channels you
170
would like to skip followed by
pressing the arrow ◄ soft-key.
• Subscription Information
SIRIUS XM Satellite radio requires a
user-paid subscription to access
these stations.
It will be necessary to access the
information on the Subscription
Information Screen in order to
subscribe.
Touch the Subscription Info soft key
to access your receiver ID number.
Write down the SIRIUS XM ID
numbers for your radio. To activate
SIRIUS XM service, either call the
number listed on the screen or visit
SIRIUS XM online at
www.siriusxm.com\subscriptions or
call the number listed.
Slot for SD Memory Card
and CD/DVD
Both slots are located on the center of
the dashboard, under the air
conditioning system control devices.
To insert a memory card into the slot,
lift the tab with the “SD” indication
and push it inside the slot. To extract
it, press lightly on the card.
To insert a CD/DVD push it inside the
lower slot with the label on the upper
side. To extract it, press the button on
the left side of the slot, as indicated.
Songs and video played from a SD card
or a CD/DVD can be controlled using
the touch screen controls on the MTC
(see the MTC guide) or the remote
controls on the steering wheel (see
“Audio Controls” in this section).
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Dashboard Compartments
There are two glove box
compartments on the dashboard to
store small items or documents.
WARNING!
Do not operate the vehicle with a
compartment lid in the open position.
Cellular phones, music players, and
other handheld electronic devices
should be stowed while driving. Use
of these devices while driving can
cause an accident due to distraction,
resulting in death or injury.
CAUTION!
Do not place objects weighing over
22 lb (10 kg) in the glove box
compartment.
Glove Box Driver Side
Glove Box Passenger Side
To open the glove box on the driver
side, pull the handle as indicated.
To open the glove box on the
passenger side, pull the handle as
shown in the picture.
4
The compartment is ca. 10-12 in (25-30
cm) deep and is lit by two courtesy
lights when open (the light
automatically switches off when the
compartment is closed).
The compartment is divided into two
parts: in the lower part you can find
the Owner’s documentation, while in
the upper part you can fit small items.
171
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
The compartment is illuminated by a
courtesy light when open (the light
will automatically switch off when the
compartment is closed); moreover, the
compartment is also air-conditioned
like the rest of the interior.
The air outlet inside the compartment
is located on the lower right side.
Analog Clock
Air Conditioning Controls
To adjust the analog clock located on
the center of the dashboard between
the air outlets, use the MTC System
(see “MTC Settings” in this section).
The vehicle is equipped with an
automatic dual-zone air conditioner/
heater that adjusts the air temperature
in the passenger compartment, in two
separate left and right side zones.
Upon request, the vehicle can be
equipped with an automatic four-zone
air conditioning system: in this case an
additional A/C module, operable both
by the rear and the front passengers
(see “Four-zone Climate Control
(optional)” in this chapter), is installed
in the central console, between the
front seats.
A demister system can "control" a
specific area of the windshield,
through a sensor located behind the
rearview mirror, and activate a special
function to prevent or eliminate mist.
The sensor is enabled upon ignition
and whenever the user presses one of
the automatic function buttons
(AUTO).
4
The time can be visualized also on the
MTC status bar and on the instrument
cluster display (see “MTC Settings” in
this section).
Clock backlight functioning is
combined with the MTC display and
the ignition switch backlight.
CAUTION!
To help ensure proper functioning of
the sensor, do not apply adhesive
parking stickers, etc. in the “sensing”
area between the sensor and the
(Continued)
172
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
indicator illuminates when the A/C is
on. Operating this function will cause
the automatic feature to switch into
manual mode and the AUTO LED/Key
will turn off.
(Continued)
windshield. Therefore, keep the
windshield and the sensor clean to
prevent accumulation of dust or other
impurities.
Dual Zone Climate Controls
This system can be operated by using
either the automatic climate control
panel on the dashboard, below the
MTC display, or the corresponding soft
keys on the MTC display.
When the MTC System is in any mode
other than climate (Radio, Player,
Controls, etc.) the driver and
passenger temperature settings will be
indicated on the upper part of the
display.
Description of Controls
All functions, except the air
distribution, MAX A/C and the SYNC
mode, can be set and modified using
the climate control panel or the MTC
display.
1. Climate control on/off
Press the button
or the OFF key to
switch the climate control on/off. The
LED on the button and the OFF key
will illuminate when the A/C is on.
NOTE:
For vehicle equipped with Remote
Start, the Air Conditioning System will
not function during Remote Start
operation if the climate control is left
in OFF.
3. Driver temperature control
Provides the driver with independent
temperature control. Push the ▼
button for cooler temperature. Push
the ▲ button for warmer
temperature. The driver's temperature
setting will be displayed on the MTC
screen between the arrows.
4
NOTE:
In SYNC mode, this button will also
automatically and simultaneously
adjust the passenger temperature.
4. Passenger temperature control
Provides the passenger with
independent temperature control.
Push the ▼ button for cooler
temperature. Push the ▲ button for
warmer temperature. The passenger's
temperature setting will be displayed
on the MTC screen between the
arrows.
NOTE:
2. A/C
Press to change the current air
conditioning (A/C) setting; the
Pressing the 4 button while in SYNC
mode will automatically exit SYNC.
173
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
5. Recirculation
Press to change the current setting,
the LED indicator on the button/the
relevant soft key illuminates when the
function is on.
4
6. Blower control
Blower control is used to regulate the
amount of air forced through the
climate system. There are seven blower
speeds available. Adjusting the blower
will cause automatic mode to switch to
manual.
Pushing the “+” on the climate control
panel will increase the speed of the
blower, while pushing the “-” will
decrease it. On the MTC screen, touch
the small icon of the blower to
decrease the speed, or the big icon to
increase it. Between the two icons,
bars will appear to show the number
of the corresponding selected speed.
The blower can also be activated/
regulated by touching the bars
between the two blower icons.
7. AUTO
This function automatically controls
the interior temperature by adjusting
the air flow rate and the air
distribution. Press the AUTO will cause
the ATC to switch between manual
and automatic mode. The LED on the
button/the AUTO soft key illuminates
174
when the AUTO function is activated.
See “Automatic Temperature Control
(ATC)” in this chapter for more
information.
8. FAST defrosting/demisting
Press the
button/the
soft key to
switch the airflow setting to the
windshield and the front side windows
to get a quick defrosting/defogging.
The LED on the button/the soft key
illuminates when this feature is
activated. Operating this function will
cause the ATC to switch into manual
mode: so the AUTO LED/soft key will
turn off; the fifth blower speed will be
automatically selected, unless the
blower is not already set to a higher
speed. If this function is turned off the
climate system will return to the
previous setting.
9. REAR defrosting/demisting
Press the
button/the
soft key to
turn on the rear window defroster and
the heated outside mirrors. A LED
indicator will illuminate when the rear
window defroster and the heated
external mirrors are on.
The rear window defroster and the
heated external mirrors automatically
turn off after 10 minutes.
CAUTION!
Failure to observe the following
cautions may cause damage to the rear
windows defroster:
• Use care when washing the inside of
the rear window. Do not use abrasive
window cleaners on the interior
surface of the window. Use a soft
cloth and a mild washing solution,
wiping parallel to the heating
elements. Labels can be peeled off
after soaking with warm water.
• Do not use scrapers, sharp
instruments, or abrasive window
cleaners on the interior surface of
the window.
• Keep all objects inside the vehicle at
a safe distance from the window.
10. Airflow distribution modes
The airflow distribution mode can be
adjusted so air comes from the
dashboard vents, floor vents,
demist/defrost vents.
The mode setting keys are located on
the MTC display only and allow
following setting options:
• “Dashboard” mode
Air flows in from the four adjustable
vents of the dashboard and the two
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
positioned at the rear of the central
console. Each of these vents can be
singly adjusted. The air vanes of the
vents can be moved up and down or
right and left to adjust air flow
direction. A setting wheel, placed
near each vent, allows to regulate
or close the air flow.
• “Bi-Level” mode
Air comes from the dashboard
vents, the central console adjustable
vents and the fixed floor vents. A
small portion of the airflow is
directed through the defrost/demist
vents.
NOTE:
Bi-Level mode is designed to let cooler
air from the dashboard and rear
central console vents and warmer air
from the floor vents.
• “Floor” mode
Air comes from the floor vents. A
small portion of the airflow is
directed through the defrost/demist
vents.
• “Mix” mode
Air comes from the floor and the
defrost/demist vents. This mode is
recommended for cold climates, to
improve comfort and prevent
fogging.
11. “SYNC” mode
Press the SYNC soft-key on the MTC to
switch the Sync feature on/off. The
SYNC indicator illuminates when this
feature is selected. This function is
used to synchronize the passenger
temperature setting with the driver
temperature setting.
Changing the passenger temperature
setting while in SYNC will
automatically exit this feature.
12. MAX A/C
Pressing the MAX A/C soft key on the
MTC, the system automatically
switches to get the maximum cold air
flow.
When the A/C and AUTO are switched
off it is not possible to have air at a
lower temperature than the outside.
Recirculation
When outside air contains smoke,
odors, or high humidity, or if rapid
cooling is desired, you may wish to
recirculate interior air by pressing the
Recirculation control button. The LED
on the button/the recirculation soft
key will illuminate when this function
is selected. Push the button a second
time to turn off the Recirculation
mode and allow the entry of outside
air into the air conditioning system.
4
Dual Zone Climate Control
Functions
Air Conditioning (A/C)
The A/C button allows to manually
activate or deactivate the air
conditioning system. When the air
conditioning system is turned on, cool
dehumidified air will flow through the
vents into the cabin. For improved fuel
economy, press the A/C button to turn
off the air conditioning and manually
adjust the blower and airflow mode
settings.
175
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Automatic Temperature Control
(ATC)
Automatic operation
NOTE:
4
In cold weather, use of Recirculation
mode may lead to window fogging.
and increase
Select the MIX mode
the blower speed to prevent fogging.
MAX A/C
Activating this function, the system
switches to exit AUTO, enter A/C and
Recirculation. The minimum
temperature (LO) in both zones, the
maximum blower speed and the air
distribution
are also selected.
The blower speed can be adjusted and
the air distribution can be modified
without exiting MAX A/C. To exit MAX
A/C press the relevant soft key or exit
A/C or Recirculation. Selecting
,
AUTO, or OFF, will also exit MAX A/C.
176
• Press the AUTO key on the A/C panel
or the soft key button on the MTC
screen.
• Set the desired temperature
adjusting the driver and/or passenger
temperature hard or soft control
buttons. Once the desired
temperature is displayed, the system
will achieve and automatically
maintain that comfort level.
• When the system is set up for your
comfort level, it is not necessary to
change the settings anymore, simply
allow the system to function
automatically.
• To provide you with maximum
comfort in the Automatic mode,
during cold start-ups the blower
speed will remain low until the
engine warms up.
Manual operation
The system allows manual selection of
blower speed, air distribution mode,
A/C status and Recirculation control.
The blower fan speed can be set to any
fixed speed by adjusting the blower
control. In this case the blower will
operate at a fixed speed until
additional speeds are selected. This
allows the front occupants to control
the volume of air circulated in the
vehicle and cancel the AUTO mode.
The user can also select the direction
of the airflow by selecting one of the
available mode settings. A/C operation
and Recirculation control can also be
manually selected.
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Four-Zone Climate Control
(optional)
Air conditioning controls that allow
rear passengers to adjust the
temperature in the left and right rear
part of the passenger compartment
are located at the rear of the center
console underneath the adjustable air
outlets, or on the rear console storage
compartment between the rear seats,
if the vehicle is equipped with
“Comfort Luxury" seats.
2. A/C
Press to change the current air
conditioning (A/C) setting, the A/C
symbol on the button illuminates
when the A/C is on. This will cause the
automatic operation to switch into
manual mode and the AUTO indicator
will turn off.
“Comfort Luxury" Rear Seats
Description of Controls
The following functions can be
operated/adjusted by using the rear
climate control panel.
1. Rear climate control on/off
Press the button
to switch the rear
climate control on/off. The LED on the
button turns on when the rear A/C is
on.
3. Left side temperature control
Provides the rear passengers with
independent temperature control.
Push the ▼ button for cooler
temperature settings or the ▲ button
for warmer temperature. The set
temperature value will be displayed in
the area above the buttons.
4
4. Right side temperature control
Provides the rear seats passengers
with independent temperature
control. Push the ▼ button for cooler
temperature settings or the ▲ button
for warmer temperature. The set
temperature value will be displayed in
the area above the buttons.
5. Blower control
Blower control is used to regulate the
airflow of the rear climate system.
There are seven blower speeds
available. Adjusting the blower will
cause the automatic mode to switch to
manual.
177
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Press the “+” button to increase
blower speed.
Press the “-” button for lower speed.
Airflow distribution modes
The airflow distribution can be
adjusted to let air come from the
central console vents, floor vents,
demist/defrost vents on pillars
between the doors. The set mode is
recognizable through an illuminated
LED on the button.
4
6. “Bi-Level” mode
Air comes from the adjustable vents on
the rear central console and from the
fixed ones directed to the floor. A
portion of the airflow is directed to
the vents on pillars.
NOTE:
The Bi-Level mode is designed to
provide comfort by sending cooler air
out of the central console vents and
warmer air from the floor vents.
7. “Floor” mode
Air comes from the floor vents. A
portion of the airflow is directed to
the vents on pillars.
8. “Panel” mode
Air comes from the adjustable vents on
the central console. Each of these
vents can be singly adjusted. The air
178
vanes of the vents can be moved up
and down or right and left to adjust
air flow direction. A setting wheel,
placed near each vent, allows to
regulate or close the air flow.
9. AUTO
This function automatically controls
the interior temperature by adjusting
the air flow rate and the air
distribution.
• Press the AUTO button: the
automatic rear climate control
switches from manual to automatic
mode and vice-versa. The AUTO
symbol on the button illuminates
when this function is activated.
• Adjust then the temperature you
wish to maintain by regulating the
left and/or right side temperature
control buttons. Once the desired
temperature is set, the system will
achieve and automatically maintain
that comfort level.
• When the system is set up for your
comfort level, it is not necessary to
change the settings anymore: simply
allow the system to function
automatically.
To provide you with maximum comfort
in the Automatic mode, during cold
start-ups the blower speed will remain
low until the engine warms up.
Four-Zone Climate Control by the
Driver
By operating the MTC display controls
the driver can adjust the settings of
the rear climate zones controlled by
rear passengers.
By touching the following MTC screen
keys, the driver is able to:
1. View and change the settings of
the rear climate.
2. Block the settings of the rear
climate.
3. Synchronize the temperature of
the passenger side with the
driver's side.
4. Return to the front climate
control display.
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
• Automatic Temperature Controls
(ATC) will automatically adjust the
climate control settings to reduce or
eliminate window fogging on the
front windshield.
Operating Tips
• Continuous use of the air
recirculation in winter, in rainy
weather or humid climate is not
recommended because it may cause
window fogging.
• Interior fogging on the windshield
can be quickly removed by FAST
defrosting/demisting. The “Mix”
mode can be used to maintain a
clear windshield and provide
sufficient heating. If side window
fogging becomes a problem increase
blower speed.
NOTE:
• Make sure the air intake, located
directly in front of the windshield, is
free of obstructions such as leaves or
other objects. Leaves collected in the
air intake may reduce airflow, and if
they enter the plenum, they could
plug the water drains. In winter
make sure the air intake is clear of
ice, slush, and snow.
• The climate control system filters
outside air containing dust, pollen
and some odors. Strong odors
cannot be totally filtered out. See
“Maintenance Procedures” in section
7 for filter replacement instructions.
• The temperature can be displayed in
U.S. or Metric units by selecting the
US/M customer programmable
feature. See “MTC Settings” in this
section.
• Any time you store your vehicle or
keep it stationary (i.e., during
vacation) for two weeks or more,
run the air conditioning system at
idle for about five minutes in the
fresh air by high blower setting. This
will ensure adequate system
lubrication and minimize the
possibility of compressor damage
when the system is started again.
4
• Recirculation mode without A/C
should not be used for long periods
of time, as fogging may occur.
179
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Phone and Voice Controls
on Steering Wheel
WARNING!
Any voice-controlled system should be
used only in safe driving conditions
following all applicable regulations.
All attention should be kept on
driving. Failure to do so may result in
a collision causing serious injury or
death.
The controls on the right side of the
steering wheel activate/deactivate the
phone mode and the voice control
functions.
4
These functions are only available
when one or more Bluetooth®
compatible mobile phones are paired
with the MTC System connection: to
pair a phone and to learn all available
functions refer to the MTC guide.
NOTE:
On the Maserati website, at
www.maserati.com, or through the
Authorized Maserati Dealer you may
consult the list of telephones that are
compatible with the MTC, and their
level of compatibility.
180
The voice command communication
system is fully integrated with the
vehicle's audio system.
The volume can be adjusted from the
radio volume control knob on the side
of the MTC screen or from the steering
wheel radio controls (see “Audio
Controls” in this section).
The system will automatically mute the
radio when using the phone mode.
When activating the phone mode
using voice commands with
speakerphone, you should speak
normally in a conversational tone from
the driver’s position towards the front
dome light where the voice command
system microphone is located.
System recognition of the user’s voice
can decrease when the speaking too
quickly or too loudly.
Phone Mode
By using the Phone button
it is
possible to: activate the phone mode,
start a call, show recent incoming and
outgoing calls, show contact list, etc.
All these functions can also be reached
by using the touch screen commands
on the MTC screen.
When pressing the button
an
audible sound will indicate system
readiness to accept a command.
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
Voice Commands
By using voice commands, after
pressing the
button, it is possible
to control the AM and FM radio, the
satellite radio and all other media or
devices connected to and controlled
by the “Player” mode (i.e CD player,
SD card, USB/iPod player).
When pressing the
button, an
acoustic signal will indicate the system
is ready to accept a voice command.
NOTE:
For further details refer to the
Maserati Touch Control guide.
4
181
Dashboard Instruments and Controls
182
5 – Driving
Normal Starting of the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Drive Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Brake and Stability Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Using the Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Use of the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electronic Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tires - General Information . . . . . . . . . .
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
206
206
208
211
220
Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Refueling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Driving Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
183
Driving
Normal Starting of the
Engine
WARNING!
• Hold the brake pedal down when
starting the engine.
• It is dangerous to run the engine in
an enclosed area. The engine
consumes oxygen and discharges
carbon dioxide, carbon monoxide
and other toxic gases in the
atmosphere.
5
When doors are opened, the
instrument cluster displays the
Maserati Logo in the center and the
complete odometer plus the “open
doors” indicator
in the lower part
of the cluster.
Before starting the engine, close the
doors, adjust your seat, the inside and
outside mirrors, fasten your seat belt
and instruct all other occupants to
buckle their seat belts.
The shift lever must be in P (Park) or N
(Neutral) position before you can start
the engine. Apply the brakes before
shifting into any driving gear (see
“Automatic Transmission” in this
section).
CAUTION!
• Before starting the engine, switch off
the electrical devices with a high
power consumption (air-conditioning
and heating system, heated rear
window, headlights, etc.).
• Do not start the engine if the fuel
level in the tank is low.
The keyless ignition device allows the
driver to operate the ignition switch
by pushing a button, as long as the key
fob RKE transmitter is within the
passenger compartment (check “Keys”
in section 2 for further information).
By pressing the brake pedal and
pushing the START/STOP button the
engine starts and the shift lever
position, engine temperature, fuel
184
gages, Maserati logo and complete
odometer, will display.
The current display subsequently sets
up with the latest screenshot.
If the engine fails to start, the starter
will disengage automatically after 10
seconds. If you wish to stop the
cranking of the engine prior to
starting it, press the button again.
Driving
NOTE:
NOTE:
Normal starting of either a cold or a
warm engine is obtained without
pumping or pressing the accelerator
pedal.
If the ignition switch is left in the ACC
or RUN (engine not running) position
and the transmission is in P (Park), the
system will automatically time out
after 30 minutes of inactivity and the
ignition will switch to the OFF
position.
If the driver only pushes the
START/STOP button but does not press
the brake pedal, the ignition switch
cycles to the ACC position (see “Keys”
in section 2) and the instrument
cluster displays the screenshot.
At the second press of the
START/STOP button, the ignition
device switches to RUN position (see
“Keys” in section 2) and the
instrument cluster displays the latest
screenshot.
At the third press of the START/STOP
button the ignition switch returns to
OFF position and the display powers
down.
At the fourth press of the START/STOP
button the screen will display the
following message: “Press Brake and
Push Button to Start”.
After starting the engine, the idle
speed is controlled automatically and
will decrease as the engine warms up.
Engine Start Failure
CAUTION!
• Do not attempt to push or tow your
vehicle to get it started. Vehicles
equipped with an automatic
transmission cannot be started this
way. Unburned fuel could enter the
catalytic converter and once the
engine has started, ignite and
damage the converter and vehicle.
• If the vehicle battery is dead, booster
cables may be used to obtain a start
from a booster battery or the
battery in another vehicle. This type
of start can be dangerous if done
improperly. See “Auxiliary Jump
Start Procedure” in section 6 for
further information.
5
Flooded engine clearing
If the engine fails to start after you
have followed the described
procedures, it may be flooded. To clear
any excess fuel, move the shift lever in
P (Park) position. Press and hold the
brake pedal, push the accelerator all
the way to the floor and hold it, then
185
Driving
press and release the START/STOP
button once. The starter will engage
automatically, run for 10 seconds, and
then disengage. Once this occurs,
release the accelerator pedal and the
brake pedal, wait 10 to 15 seconds,
then repeat the “Normal starting of
the engine” procedure.
Starting by cold engine
Start-off slowly, avoiding sudden
acceleration and rev the engine at low
medium speeds. High-performance
driving should be avoided until the
engine temperature reaches 149-158°F
(65-70°C ).
5
Engine Turn Off
• Place the shift lever in P (Park) (see
“Automatic Transmission” in this
section).
• With the engine at idle, press and
release the START/STOP button. The
ignition switch will return to the OFF
position. A burst on the accelerator
pedal before turning off the engine
has no purpose and increases fuel
consumption.
• If the shift lever is not in P (Park), the
START/STOP button must be held for
two seconds and vehicle speed must
be above 5 mph (8 km/h) before the
engine will shut off. The ignition
186
switch will remain in the ACC
position until the shift lever is in P
(Park) and the button is pressed
twice from the OFF position.
• If the shift lever is not in P (Park) and
the START/STOP button is pressed
once, the instrument cluster will
display a “Vehicle Not in Park”
message and the engine will remain
running.
WARNING!
Never leave a vehicle out of the P
(Park) position, as it could roll away.
NOTE:
If the ignition switch is left in the ACC
or RUN (engine not running) position
and the transmission is in P (Park), the
system will automatically time out
after 30 minutes of inactivity and the
ignition will switch to OFF position.
Automatic Transmission
The electronic shift lever replaces the
conventional mechanical lever and has
no mechanical connection to the
transmission. The transmission is
operated by electrical actuators on the
hydraulic system and all commands to
the control system are transmitted by
the CAN network. The lever itself
represents a mere user interface. Gear
positions are simulated by solenoids
inside the lever body, which are
computer controlled and enable or
disable certain positions of the lever.
The solenoids inside the gear lever
prevent the movement of the lever
towards invalid positions.
The electronically-controlled
transmission provides a precise shift
schedule. The transmission electronics
are self-calibrating, therefore the
gearshift behavior could become
perfect as expected after few
hundreds of miles.
CAUTION!
In order to properly use the Automatic
Transmission, it is essential that you
read through the whole chapter, so
that you can understand right from
(Continued)
Driving
(Continued)
the start what the correct and granted
operations are.
Damage to the transmission may occur
if the following precautions are not
observed:
• Shift into P (Park) only after the
vehicle has come to a complete stop.
This is the default position of the
lever and should be used every time
the ignition switch is cycled to OFF.
• Shift into or out of R (Reverse) only
after the vehicle has come to a
complete stop and the engine is at
idle speed.
• Do not shift between P (Park), R
(Reverse), N (Neutral) or D (Drive)
when the engine is above idle speed
• To effect any change from vehicle
stop to R (Reverse), D (Drive), 1st or
2nd gear, it is necessary to keep the
brake pedal fully depressed.
WARNING!
• It is dangerous to move the shift
lever out of P (Park) or N (Neutral) if
the engine speed is higher than idle
speed. If your foot is not firmly
pressing on the brake pedal, the
vehicle could accelerate quickly
forward or in reverse. You could lose
control of the vehicle and hit
someone or something. Only shift
into gear when the engine is idling
normally and when your foot is
firmly pressing on the brake pedal.
• Unintended movement of a vehicle
could injure those in or near the
vehicle. As with all vehicles, you
should never exit a vehicle while the
engine is running. Before exiting a
vehicle, always apply the electronic
parking brake, shift the transmission
into P (Park), and turn the engine
off. The shift lever will consequently
lock in P (Park) position for a few
seconds, then eases, handling the
change to prevent the motion of the
car.
• Never leave children unattended in a
vehicle, or with access to an
unlocked vehicle. Allowing children
in an unattended vehicle is
dangerous for a number of reasons.
A child or others could be seriously
or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the shift lever.
• When leaving the vehicle, always
remove the key fob and lock your
vehicle.
• Do not leave the key fob in or near
the vehicle. A child could operate
power windows, other controls, or
move the vehicle.
This vehicle is equipped with a feature
which requires the shift lever to be
placed in P (Park) before the engine
can be turned off. This prevents the
driver from inadvertently leaving the
vehicle without first placing the
transmission in P (Park). This system
also locks the shift lever in P (Park)
whenever the ignition switch is in the
OFF position.
Automatic Transmission
Controls
5
Automatic transmission is operated by
a selection lever with lock button and
by a series of buttons located on the
central console.
Using the selection lever it is possible
to select following positions, indicated
on the top of the lever: the selected
position will illuminate in amber light.
• P (Park);
• R (Reverse);
• N (Neutral);
• D (Drive) automatic forward speed (8
ranges);
187
Driving
By operating instead the lever, the
new range will be indicated in the
field and in the lower part of the
display.
• +/- to upshift or downshift when
manual mode in D (Drive) status, or
set M (Manual) mode.
Transmission status is visible on the
lever and on the lower part of the
Instrument cluster display.
Buttons on the central console have
following functions:
5
188
to exclude/reactivate the ESC
system.
• M (Manual): to switch from
automatic to manual driving mode.
• I C E: to activate/deactivate the
driving mode in slippery surfaces
conditions.
• SPORT: to activate/deactivate a
sportier driving mode.
•
to switch between the two
suspensions setting modes.
By selecting one of these functions,
the LED beside the button illuminates.
The Electric Parking Brake lever is part
of the shift control panel (see “Parking
Brake” in section 5).
•
By pressing the release button on the
lever, the gear position field is
displayed: if you release the button
without moving the lever, the field
disappears after 2 seconds.
If the vehicle is temporarily in the
manual drive mode, D2 (Drive) status,
or in M1 (Manual) drive mode, the
gear position is indicated beside the
lever status, on the lower part of the
display.
Driving
the vehicle is stopped. Be sure to keep
your foot pressed on the brake pedal
when moving the shift lever between
these gears.
DO NOT race the engine when shifting
from P (Park) or N (Neutral) into
another gear range.
Automatic Transmission Range
P (Park)
In normal conditions, the shift lever is
always unlocked. When in D (Drive)
mode it is possible to upshift or
downshift the changing gears by
automatically temporary setting in M
(Manual) mode.
You must also press the brake pedal to
shift the transmission out of P (Park)
position.
Shifting from D (Drive) to P (Park) or R
(Reverse) should be done only after
the accelerator pedal is released and
Use this position to park the vehicle.
Shifting gears from P (Park) position is
only possible with the brake pedal
pressed. To move the shift lever from P
(Park) position to any other position,
the engine must be switched on. The
engine can be regularly started in P
(Park) range. Never attempt to use P
(Park) while the vehicle is in motion.
When parking on a level surface, you
may place the shift lever in the P
(Park) position first, and then apply
the electronic parking brake by
pulling the handle upwards. The
Instrument cluster will display the
related light indicator
and the
message for 5 seconds.
5
When parking on a hill, apply the
parking brake before placing the shift
lever in P (Park).
For enhanced security, turn the front
wheels toward the curb on a downhill
and away from the curb on an uphill
grade.
189
Driving
R (Reverse)
WARNING!
• Never use the P (Park) position as a
substitute for the electronic parking
brake. Always apply the parking
brake fully when parked to prevent
vehicle movement and possible
injury or damage.
• Make sure the transmission is in P
(Park) before leaving the vehicle.
CAUTION!
5
• DO NOT race the engine when
shifting from P (Park) or N (Neutral)
into another gear range, as this can
damage the drivetrain.
• The following indicators should be
used to ensure that you have
engaged the shift lever into the P
(Park) position:
• when shifting into P (Park), press
the lock button on the shift lever
and push the lever all the way
forward until it stops. When
released, the lever will return to its
standard position;
• with the brake pedal released,
verify that P (Park) position is
illuminated on the shift lever.
190
This range is used to move the vehicle
backward.
We recommend to shift into R
(Reverse) only after the vehicle has
come to a complete stop.
• Vehicle halted: switching between P
(Park), R (Reverse) and D (Drive)
requires pressing the unlock button
on the lever and brake pedal: N
(Neutral) is reached only by pressing
the unlock button on the lever.
• Vehicle moving: the driver can switch
from R (Reverse) to N (Neutral), or
vice versa, by pressing the lock
button on the shift lever.
N (Neutral)
• Vehicle halted and engine started:
switching from N (Neutral) to R
(Reverse), P (Park) and/or D (Drive)
requires brake pedal and unlock
button pressed.
• Vehicle moving: switching from N
(Neutral) to R (Reverse) and/or D
(Drive) requires pressing the unlock
button. Switching to R (Reverse)
starting from N (Neutral) is only
possible if the vehicle is moving
backwards, while switching to D
(Drive) starting from N (Neutral) is
only possible if the vehicle is moving
forwards.
Set the parking brake and shift the
transmission into P (Park) if you must
leave the vehicle.
WARNING!
Do not switch to N (Neutral) and/or
never turn off the ignition to coast
downhill. These are unsafe practices
that limit driver’s response to
changing traffic or road conditions. It
is possible to lose control of the
vehicle and have a collision.
CAUTION!
Towing the vehicle, coasting, or
driving for any other reason with the
transmission in N (Neutral) can result
in severe transmission damage. See
“Towing a Disabled Vehicle” in section
6 for further information.
D (Drive)
This range should be used for most city
and highway driving. It provides the
smoothest upshifts and downshifts and
the best fuel economy. The
transmission automatically shifts up
and down through all gears.
Driving
The D (Drive) position provides
optimum driving characteristics under
all normal operating conditions of the
vehicle.
• Vehicle stationary: switching from D
(Drive) to R (Reverse) and/or to P
(Park) requires brake pedal and
unlock button pressed: reaching N
(Neutral) starting from D (Drive) is
allowed by only pressing the unlock
button on the shift lever.
• To enable special operations while
the car is moving at a low speed,
such as getting out of a marsh or
snow, it is possible to run quickly
from D (Drive) to R (Reverse), and
vice versa, by pressing the reset
button on the gear shift lever.
• Vehicle moving: switching to N
(Neutral) from D (Drive) requires the
unlock button on the shift lever
pressed.
• From D (Drive) selected mode it is
always possible to switch to M
(Manual), by pressing the M
(Manual) button: the Led indicator
beside the button will light up; to
return to D (Drive) position, the
same action should be performed as
the LED will turn off.
• When in D (Drive) mode, moving the
shift lever forward or backwards to
the next step without pressing the
unlock button on the lever will cause
the system to enter a temporary
function and enable the manual
shift mode. This range is indicated
with the symbols “+/-” on the right
and left side of the “D” letter on the
gear range field of the display. The
system will then switch back to
automatic mode according to time
elapsed in “temporary” mode and
driving conditions.
At extremely cold temperatures (-23°F
/ -30°C or below), transmission may be
affected by the low temperature of
the engine and transmission. Normal
operation will resume once the
transmission temperature has risen to
a normal level.
that wheel slip is unlikely to occur.
When specific road and environmental
conditions require increased levels of
road traction, the vehicle
automatically shifts into AWD mode.
Drive mode, RWD, or AWD, is
displayed on the TFT display. Refer to
paragraph “TFT Display” in chapter
“Instrument Cluster” of section 4 for
further information.
WARNING!
There may be a slight delay for AWD
engagement after a wheel slip
condition occurs.
5
All-Wheel Drive (V6 Engine)
This vehicle is equipped with an active
on-demand All-Wheel Drive (AWD)
system provides available optimum
traction for a wide variety of road
surface and driving conditions. The
system minimizes wheel slip by
automatically redirecting torque to
the front and rear wheels as necessary.
To maximize fuel economy, the AWD
vehicle automatically defaults to
Rear-Wheel Drive (RWD) when road
and environmental conditions are such
V6 Engine
191
Driving
Drive Mode
NOTE:
If the “Service AWD System” warning
message appears after engine start up,
or during driving, it means that the
AWD system is not functioning
properly. If the warning message is
often activated, it is recommended to
go to the service.
Keys (buttons) on the side of the shift
lever only have two functions: OFF and
ON. The OFF state (button released) is
the standard function mode. The ON
state is activated by pressing the
button, the dedicated LED will
illuminate. It is necessary to press the
button for at least 3 seconds.
The table shows the different drive
modes according to the state of the
keys.
Button
5
M
V6 Engine
ICE
SPORT
WARNING!
When “Service AWD System” is
activated driver should be aware of
different driving behavior and reduce
speed. The “Service AWD System” also
warns the driver not to drive into
cross country areas requiring AWD and
snow roads.
192
OFF – Button released
The tables below summarizes the
adjustment of transmission and engine
parameters according to set drive
mode/s. is the only mode that does
not depend on the activation or
deactivation of the other modes. The
tables show the configurations with
button NOT pressed and the
button pressed.
ON – Button pressed (LED ON)
Electronic Stability Control ESC
activated
Electronic Stability Control ESC
partially deactivated
Autoshift Mode (Auto)
Manual shift mode (Manual)
Increase Control Efficiency
mode OFF
Increase Control Efficiency
mode ON (*)
Normal drive mode (Normal)
Sportier drive mode (SPORT)
Soft suspensions setting (Soft)
Hard suspensions setting (Hard)
(*) I C E (Increase Control and Efficiency) operates on engine supply in order to
reduce fuel consumption, exhausts, noisiness (efficiency) by dampen vehicle
reactions (control). The current mode is also useful for low grip surfaces.
Driving
Button NOT pressed
M
M
M
ICE
ICE
ICE
SPORT
SPORT
Normal + Manual I C E + Auto + Soft Sport + Auto +
+ Soft suspensions suspensions
Soft suspensions
Sport + Auto +
Hard suspensions
Active
Active-Sport
Button pressed
Setup Normal + Auto +
Soft suspensions
Stability control
Active
M
Active
Active-Sport
Suspensions setup
Normal
Normal
Normal
Normal
Hard
Engine control
Normal
Normal
Comfort
Performance
Performance
Engine boost
Normal boost
Overboost
Low boost
Overboost
Overboost
Exhaust sound
Low up to 3,000
rpm
Low up to 3,000
rpm
Low
Always High
Always High
Gear shifting point
Normal
-
Comfort
Performance
Performance
Kick down
Yes
Yes
Yes - Soft
Yes - Strong
Yes - Strong
Rev limiter
7,000 rpm (V8)
6,200 rpm (V6)
7,000 rpm (V8)
6,200 rpm (V6)
6,700 rpm (V8)
6,000 rpm (V6)
7,200 rpm (V8)
6,500 rpm (V6)
7,200 rpm (V8)
6,500 rpm (V6)
Automatic
downshift
Normal
Anti - Stall
Comfort
Performance
Performance
Transmission speed
Normal
Rapid - Normal
Comfort
Sport
Sport
5
193
Driving
Button pressed
ESC OFF
ESC OFF
ESC OFF
ESC OFF
ESC OFF
M
M
M
M
ICE
Button pressed
Setup Normal + Auto +
Soft suspensions
5
194
ICE
ICE
SPORT
SPORT
Normal + Manual I C E + Auto + Soft Sport + Auto +
+ Soft suspensions suspensions
Soft suspensions
Sport + Auto + Hard
suspensions
Stability control
OFF
OFF
OFF - According
to speed
OFF
OFF
Suspensions setup
Normal
Normal
Normal
Normal
Hard
Engine control
Normal
Normal
Comfort
Performance
Performance
Engine boost
Normal boost
Overboost
Low boost
Overboost
Overboost
Exhaust sound
Low up to 3,000
rpm
Low up to 3,000
rpm
Low
Always High
Always High
Gear shifting point
Normal
-
Comfort
Performance
Performance
Kick down
Yes
Yes
Yes - Soft
Yes - Strong
Yes - Strong
Rev limiter
7,000 rpm (V8)
6,200 rpm (V6)
7,000 rpm (V8)
6,200 rpm (V6)
6,700 rpm (V8)
6,000 rpm (V6)
7,200 rpm (V8)
6,500 rpm (V6)
7,200 rpm (V8)
6,500 rpm (V6)
Automatic
downshift
Normal
Anti - Stall
Comfort
Performance
Performance
Transmission speed
Normal
Rapid - Normal
Comfort
Sport
Sport
Driving
Activation/Deactivation of
Drive Mode
To insert a driving mode, briefly press
the corresponding button. The LED
beside the button will light along with
the indicator light on the display,
combined with a specific message for
5 seconds (see examples) or the
specific symbol of the set mode.
To activate button press the
corresponding button for at least 3
seconds.
gear is displayed on the instrument
cluster beside “M”.
To disable the mode, press the button
again: the LED or symbol on the
cluster will turn off.
5
M (Manual) Drive Mode
In this mode, the transmission
interacts with the driver in order to
allow manual shift and ensure
increased control of the vehicle. The
current mode allows the gear system
to optimize the engine brake action,
remove undesired shifting into a
higher and lower gears and improve
the overall performance of the
vehicle.
This mode allows you to move the
shift lever step by step forward (-) or
backward (+) without pressing the
lock button. The current transmission
Using the shift paddles behind the
steering wheel (if present), the
corresponding icon will display beside
the “M” indication and current shifted
gear.
Pull the right shift paddle (+) towards
the steering wheel and release it to
enter the higher gear; do the same
195
Driving
operation with the left shift paddle (-)
to enter the lower gear.
5
Manual mode can be activated at any
time, with no need to release the
brake pedal.
Even if the release button is pressed
and gear is shifted in R (Reverse), P
(Park) or N (Neutral), the selected
manual mode will be maintained.
In Manual mode, the transmission will
shift up or down (+/-) if manually
196
selected by the driver by using the
shift lever, or shift paddles on the
steering wheel (if present). The
transmission remains in the engaged
gear until the driver shifts into another
higher or lower gear, except in the
following cases.
• Lack of accelerator pedal activity will
cause the transmission to revert to
automatic operation. The
transmission will also upshift
automatically once maximum engine
speed is reached.
• If in SPORT mode, the transmission
will remain in the selected gear even
when maximum engine speed is
reached. The transmission will
upshift only if enabled by the driver.
Manual upshift or downshift will be
maintained as long as SPORT mode is
selected, even by full stroke pedal
press.
• If in M (Manual) or in SPORT mode,
the transmission will automatically
downshift as the vehicle slows to halt
(to prevent engine lugging) and the
current gear will display on the
instrument cluster. Shifting the gear
lever backward (+) or moving the
right shift paddle (+) towards the
steering wheel when stationary, will
cause the vehicle to start in second
gear. If the vehicle speed is too low,
the system will ignore further
upshifts. Avoid using speed control
when the M (Manual) mode is
engaged.
Gear Shift Indicator Light
In order to improve fuel economy, we
recommend that you shift gears when
the system prompts you to do so. This
will help reduce fuel consumption
without significantly affecting vehicle
performance.
The indicator beside the displayed
gear will light up just before reaching
the required speed for gear change.
When the new gear is engaged, the
indicator turns off. If the shift runs late
or is not performed at all, the indicator
remains lit for a few seconds then
turns off. As soon as new conditions
occur requiring further gear change,
the indicator light will illuminate
again.
Driving
Transmission Malfunction and
Overheating Conditions
NOTE:
The gearshift indicator will only work
when the transmission is set in M
(Manual) mode.
I C E Mode excluding ESC
To release the vehicle in low grip
conditions (e.g.: snow, mud, sand, etc),
it is possible to shift the transmission
feature in the specific driving mode as
required for these situations, by
pressing the I C E button and to
exclude completely the yaw and
spinning control system, by pressing
the button for two seconds .
Transmission Emergency Control
Transmission function is monitored
electronically to detect abnormal
conditions. If a condition is detected
that could result in transmission
damage, Transmission Limp Home
Mode is activated. In this situation, the
transmission may operate only in
certain gears, or may not shift at all.
Vehicle performance may be severely
degraded and the engine may stall. In
some situations, the transmission
system may be able to re-engage or
start the engine. The Malfunction
Indicator Light
may illuminate.
A message in the instrument cluster
will inform the driver about the more
serious transmission conditions, and
indicate what actions may be
necessary.
Transmission Oil Over Temperature
If the transmission oil temperature
exceeds the operating limit, the
amber light illuminates on the
instrument cluster.
In this case, slow down until the
temperature returns to normal level
(the light will turn off).
If this is not sufficient, we recommend
you stop the vehicle, shift the lever to
position P (Park) or N (Neutral) and
keep the engine idle until the
temperature warning light
turns
off and the message disappears from
the display. Resume driving without
demanding high engine performance.
5
197
Driving
If the warning light
turns on again,
it is advisable to stop the vehicle, turn
off the engine and wait for the
engine/transmission assembly to fully
cool down.
• Shift the transmission into D (Drive)
and then into the desired gear
range. If the problem is no longer
detected, the transmission will return
to normal operation.
NOTE:
Even if the transmission can be reset,
we recommend that you visit an
Authorized Maserati Dealer at your
earliest possible convenience, which
has diagnostic equipment to
determine if the problem could recur.
5
If the instrument cluster message
indicates that the transmission may
not re-engage after engine shutdown,
perform the following procedure
preferably at a Maserati Service
Center.
In the event of a momentary problem,
the transmission can be reset to regain
all forward gears by performing the
following steps.
• Stop the vehicle.
• Shift the transmission into P (Park), if
possible.
• Turn the engine off.
• Wait approximately 30 seconds.
• Restart the engine.
198
Transmission Manual Release of P
(Park) Position
See chapter “Transmission Manual
Release of P (Park) Position” in section 6.
Parking Brake
The vehicle is equipped with an
electric automatic parking brake, also
called EPB (Electric Parking Brake).
It is automatically engaged when the
engine is turned off and disengaged
with engine running and driver’s door
closed, while pressing the brake pedal
and operating the shift lever.
When the parking brake is applied, the
warning light
lights up on the
Rev Counter display and the related
message is displayed on the instrument
cluster for 5 seconds (see “Instrument
Cluster” in section 4).
During engagement and
disengagement procedures, the
warning light
flashes until the
parking brake has reached its
maximum activation force and is
respectively fully released.
Driving
In the above mentioned conditions,
the automatic engagement function
can be deactivated/activated by using
the command “Vehicle settings” on
the main menu (refer to paragraph
“Deactivating Automatic Operation”
in this chapter).
simply by pulling the lever upward
within 3 minutes after turning off.
Manual Engagement/
Disengagement
The parking brake can also be
manually engaged or disengaged
when the engine is running or the
ignition switch is in the RUN position,
by pressing the brake pedal and
raising the lever located behind the
shift lever.
When the parking brake is applied,
the warning light
lights up on
the Rev Counter and the related
message will be displayed for 5
seconds on the instrument cluster.
If you attempt to engage/disengage
the parking brake without having
pressed the brake pedal, a message
will be displayed, warning you to
proceed.
If the engine was turned off when the
automatic engagement device was
deactivated (see “Deactivating
Automatic Operation” in this chapter)
it is possible to shift the parking brake
CAUTION!
The main function of the EPB is to
allow safe parking of the vehicle,
therefore it must only be applied
when the vehicle is already stationary.
If the EPB is used while the vehicle is
moving and decelerating until a speed
lower of 3 mph (5 km/h) and, in
particular, until complete stop
(typically in a sudden brake), it is
necessary to have the EPB system
checked by the Authorized Maserati
Dealer.
WARNING!
• Always hold the brake pedal pressed
during engagement or
disengagement of the parking
brake.
• The EPB command activation while
running, generates a deceleration of
the vehicle with strong deceleration
(Dynamic Braking). It is therefore
recommended to use this feature
only in case of emergency. The
stability of the car is guaranteed by
the action of the activated ESC
system.
5
199
Driving
Deactivating Automatic
Operation
The automatic engagement function
can be deactivated/reactivated by
selecting the command “Vehicle
settings” on the main menu, the
command is reachable through the
switch on the right-side of the steering
wheel (refer to “Instrument Cluster” in
section 4.)
Press and release the switch toward
the arrow ► to select “Electric Park
Brake”.
5
Scroll with the switch toward the
arrow ▲ or ▼ through the
programmable options.
Press and release the switch toward
the arrow ► to set the selected
option. A check mark will remain next
to the previously selected item until a
new selection is made.
Press and release the switch once
again toward the arrow ► to visualize
the options connected to this function.
• Auto Apply On;
• Auto Apply Off (default setting).
200
“Setting Saved” Selection notification
appears as a popup for 2 seconds then
the display will show again the
modified function.
In order to resume the automatic
operation follow the same procedures
and selecting “Auto Apply Off”
option.
CAUTION!
• Under certain conditions when the
battery voltage is low, the electric
automatic parking brake system may
temporarily be deactivated for safety
reasons. Therefore, typically upon
starting the engine, when the
battery voltage drops, a message
may temporarily be displayed,
indicating that automatic operation
is temporarily disabled.
• In case of ripetitive requests to reset
the EPB through the messages shown
on the TFT display, please contact the
Authorized Maserati Dealer.
Driving
Failure Indication
Parking
In the event of electric parking brake
system failure, the warning light
on the display will light up and
the related message will show for 5
seconds.
Before leaving the vehicle, make sure
that the parking brake is fully applied
and place the shift lever in the P (Park)
position.
WARNING!
In the event of an EPB failure, take
your vehicle to the nearest Authorized
Maserati Dealer as soon as possible.
WARNING!
• Always check that the vehicle is
locked before leaving it.
• Never leave children unattended in
the vehicle.
• Do not park the vehicle on paper,
grass, dry leaves or other flammable
materials. They could catch fire if
they come into contact with hot
parts of the exhaust system.
When parking on hill roads, it is
important to turn the front wheels
toward the curb on a downhill grade
and away from the curb on an uphill
grade.
Apply the parking brake before
placing the shift lever in P (Park),
otherwise the load on the
transmission locking mechanism may
make it difficult to move the shift
lever out of P (Park).
In certain conditions, it is however
advisable to disengage the parking
brake manually and slightly apply the
service brake for starting off. This is
advisable when there are obstacles
very close to the vehicle in the
direction in which you intend to move.
5
• Do not leave the engine running
while the vehicle is unattended.
Emergency Disengagement
In case of brake lock with complete
electrical system failure, it is necessary
to release the brake manually (see the
complete procedure in “Emergency
Release of the Parking Brake” chapter
in section 6).
CAUTION!
When you need to park the vehicle on
a steep slope, both with the engine on
and off, it is recommended not only to
engage the parking brake, but also to
shift the shift lever to P (Park) before
leaving the vehicle.
201
Driving
“Drive Away Inhibit” strategy
In order to avoid a dangerous
condition due to leave the vehicle not
“braked” with running engine and
without driver on board, “Drive Away
Inhibit” strategy alerts the driver with
messages on the instrument cluster
display and sounding chimes, then put
the transmission in P (Park).
The table shows the vehicle condition
and the action that the system runs to
exit the dangerous condition.
5
202
Vehicle condition
Action of the driver
• Engine running and speed lower than
3 km/h (1.8 mph).
• Transmission in any position other P
(Park).
• Driver safety belt unlocked.
• Driver door opened.
• Brake pedal pressed.
The driver releases the brake pedal to
get out of the vehicle.
Warnings
Warnings
• Slow continuous chime.
• “Vehicle not in Park” message on the
display.
• Fast chime.
• “Secure vehicle to prevent
movement" message on the display.
The system put the
transmission in P
(Park) position
Driving
Brake and Stability
Control System
The vehicle is equipped with an
Electronic Stability Control System
(ESC), which helps to maintain
directional control in the event of loss
of traction of the tires. The system is
able to detect potentially dangerous
situations for the stability of the
vehicle and automatically sets the
brakes on all four wheels in a
differentiated manner, in order to
provide a torque stabilizing of the
vehicle. ESC includes following
subsystems:
• EBD (electronic brake force
distribution);
• ABS (anti blocking system);
• TCS (traction control system);
• BAS (brake assist system);
• HSA (hill start assist).
WARNING!
• These systems cannot prevent the
natural laws of physics from affecting
the vehicle, nor can it increase
traction, braking or steering efficiency
beyond that afforded by the condition
of the vehicle brakes and tires.
• These systems cannot prevent
collisions, including those resulting
from excessive speed in turns,
following another vehicle too
closely, or hydroplaning.
tires and the road. Therefore, always
keep a safe distance from the vehicle
in front of yours and reduce your
speed when entering a curve.
• The capabilities of a vehicle
equipped with these systems must
never be exploited in a reckless or
dangerous manner that could
jeopardize the driver’s and the
passenger’s safety or the safety of
others.
NOTE:
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
The Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
provides increased vehicle stability and
brake performance under most
braking conditions. The system
automatically “pumps” the brakes
during severe braking to prevent
wheel lock-up.
The Electronic Brake Force Distribution
(EBD) prevents the rear wheels from
over-braking and provides greater
control of available braking forces
applied to the rear axle.
WARNING!
The ABS helps prevent the wheels
from locking, but it does not increase
the physical grip limits between the
• When the vehicle's speed is higher
than 7 mph (11 km/h), you may also
hear a slight clicking sound as well as
other motor noises. The system is
performing a self-check cycle to
ensure that the ABS is working
properly.
• This self-check occurs each time the
vehicle is started and accelerated
past 7 mph (11 km/h).
ABS is activated during braking under
certain road or stopping conditions.
ABS-inducing conditions can include
ice, snow, gravel, bumps, railroad
tracks, loose debris.
You may also experience the following
when the brake system goes into AntiLock:
5
• The ABS motor running (it may
continue to run for a short time
after the vehicle stops).
• The clicking sound of solenoid
valves.
• Brake pedal pulsations.
203
Driving
• A slight drop or fall away of the
brake pedal at the end of the stop.
These are all normal characteristics of
ABS functioning.
5
WARNING!
• The ABS contains sophisticated
electronic equipment that may be
susceptible to interference caused by
improperly installed or high output
radio transmitting equipment. This
interference can cause possible loss
of anti-lock braking capability.
Installation of such equipment
should be performed by qualified
Maserati personnel.
• Pumping the Anti-Lock Brakes will
diminish their effectiveness and may
lead to a collision. Pumping brakes
makes the stopping distance longer.
Just press firmly on your brake pedal
when you need to slow down or
stop. Do not pump brakes.
Traction Control System (TCS)
The current device is an integral part
of the ESC system. It operates
automatically by reducing the power
transmitted by the engine in case of
slipping, loss of grip on wet floor
204
(aquaplaning), acceleration on slippery
snow-covered or frozen surfaces, etc.
Activating under slip conditions
different control systems:
• if slippage affects both drive wheels,
it reduces the power transmitted by
the engine;
• if slippage only affects one drive
wheel, it brakes the slipping wheel
automatically.
Brake Assist System (BAS)
This system completes the ABS system
by optimizing the vehicle braking
capacity during emergency brake
maneuvers. The system detects an
emergency braking situation by
sensing the rate and amount of brake
application and then applies optimum
pressure to the brakes in order to help
reduce braking distances.
The quick brake coupling is optimal for
BAS performances. In order to fully
exploit the system, apply continuous
brake pedal pressure during the entire
vehicle stop sequence. Do not reduce
brake pedal pressure earlier than
required. Once the brake pedal is
released, the BAS is deactivated.
Electronic Stability Control
(ESC)
This system enhances directional
control and stability of the vehicle
under various driving conditions. The
ESC corrects over steering and under
steering of the vehicle by applying the
brake to the appropriate wheel.
Engine power may also be reduced to
assist in counteracting the conditions
of instability and maintain the right
direction. The system is also able to
reduce the engine power.
Through sensors fitted on the vehicle,
the ESC system detects the driver’s
chosen direction comparing it to the
one maintained while running. In case
of discrepancy between the required
trajectory and the current one, the ESC
system brakes the appropriate wheel
to counteract over or under steering.
Driving
• Oversteer - when the vehicle is
turning more than appropriate for
the steering wheel position.
• Understeer - when the vehicle is
turning less than appropriate for the
steering wheel position.
The ESC system has two available
operating modes:
ESC on
This is the normal ESC operating
mode. At each start-up of the vehicle,
the ESC system is set in this mode and
should be used for most driving
conditions. The ESC should only be
turned off for specific reasons as
pointed out in the following
paragraphs.
ESC off
The “ESC off” mode is aimed for a
more spirited driving experience but
also purposeful for driving in deep
snow, sand, or gravel. The current
mode disables the TCS portion of the
ESC and raises the threshold for ESC
activation, allowing higher wheel spin
than normally granted by the ESC
system. The switch is fitted beside
the gear shift lever: to deactivate the
system see“Drive mode” in
“Automatic Transmission” in this
section.
NOTE:
• When in “ESC off” mode, the TCS
functionality of ESC is deactivated
(except for the limited slip feature
described in the TCS paragraph of
this chapter). All other stability
features of ESC function regularly.
• To improve the vehicle's traction
when driving with snow chains, or
when starting off in deep snow,
sand, or gravel, it may be desirable
to switch to the “ESC off” mode by
pressing the switch and remain in
this operational mode no longer
than needed. Once the situation
requiring “ESC off” mode is
overcome, turn the ESC on again by
pressing the switch. This may also
be performed while in motion.
brake pressure proportionally to the
amount of throttle/torque applied as
the vehicle starts to move in the
chosen direction.
HSA Activation Criteria
The following criteria must be met in
order for HSA to activate:
• vehicle is stationary.
• gear selection matches vehicle uphill
direction (i.e., vehicle facing uphill is
in forward gear; vehicle backing
uphill is in reverse gear).
HSA will work in R (Reverse) and all
forward gears when the activation
criteria have been met.
The system will not activate if the gear
is placed in N (Neutral) or P (Park).
5
Hill Start Assist (HSA)
The HSA system is designed to assist
the driver when starting a vehicle
uphill. HSA will maintain the level of
brake pressure applied for a short
period of time also after releasing the
brake pedal.
If the driver does not apply the
throttle during this short period of
time, the system will release brake
pressure and the vehicle will start
sloping down. The system will release
205
Driving
Using the Brakes
CAUTION!
To obtain a good performance of
brake pads and discs, avoid sudden
braking during the first 190 mi
(300 km).
The pad wear limit is indicated by the
illumination of the warning light
,
on the instrument panel.
In this event, please contact an
Authorized Maserati Dealer.
5
excessive lining wear, and possible
brake damage. In an emergency, full
braking capacity may be impaired.
Brake pads and brake discs
Wear on the brake pads and brake
discs depends to a great extent on the
driving style and the conditions of use
and therefore cannot be expressed in
actual miles driven on the road.
The high-performance brake system is
designed for optimal braking effect at
all speeds and temperatures.
Certain speeds, braking forces and
ambient conditions (e.g. temperature
and humidity) can therefore cause the
brakes to “squeal”.
New brake pads and/or brake
discs
WARNING!
Riding the brakes can lead to brake
failure and possibly an accident.
Driving with your foot resting or
riding on the brake pedal can result in
abnormally high brake temperatures,
206
New brake pads have to be “broken
in”, and therefore only attain optimal
friction to the brake disc when the
vehicle has covered several hundred
miles.
During this first period, the slightly
reduced braking ability must be
compensated for by pressing the brake
pedal harder. This applies whenever
the brake pads and/or brake discs are
replaced.
Use of the Engine
Breaking-In
Today's modern production methods
are designed to provide extremely
precise construction and assembly of
components. However, moving parts
do undergo a settling process, basically
in the first hours of vehicle operation.
Avoid exceeding 5,000 rpm for the first
620 mi trip (1,000 km).
After starting the vehicle, do not
exceed 4,000 rpm until the engine has
warmed up sufficiently (coolant
temperature: 149-158°F / 65-70°C).
Do not drive keeping at a constant
high speed rate for a prolonged time.
While cruising, brief full-throttle
acceleration within the limits of local
traffic laws contributes to a good
break-in of the engine. Wide-open
throttle acceleration in low gear can
be detrimental and should be avoided.
The engine oil installed in the engine
at the factory is a high-quality energy
conserving type lubricant. Oil changes
should be consistent with anticipated
climate conditions under which vehicle
operations will occur. For the
recommended viscosity and quality
grades, see “Maintenance Procedures”
in section 7.
Driving
A new engine may consume some oil
during its first few thousand miles of
operation. This should be considered
as a normal part of the break-in
period and not interpreted as an
indication of an engine malfunction.
While Driving
Never travel with the Rev Counter
indicator approaching the peak rpm,
not even downhill. When the Rev
Counter indicator is approaching the
peak rpm (red colored zone), take
precautions to avoid exceeding that
limit.
CAUTION!
• Under normal conditions, all red
warning lights on the instrument
cluster display should be off. When
they come on, this indicates a
malfunction. Refer to “Instrument
Cluster” in section 4.
• Continuing to drive when a red
warning light is on could cause
serious damage to the vehicle and
affect its performance.
WARNING!
Do not travel downhill with the
engine off, as the power booster will
no longer function due to the vacuum
decrease. This can be realized, and if
done the system can become
ineffective. The power steering will
also lose its efficiency under these
conditions.
Ensure proper operation of different
devices checking their respective
control warning lights.
transmission control systems. When
these systems are operating properly,
your vehicle will provide excellent
performance and fuel economy, as
well as engine emissions well within
current local regulations of various
countries.
If any of these systems require service,
the OBD II system will turn on the
malfunction indicator light (MIL).
It will also store diagnostic codes and
other information to assist your
Maserati Service Center to service
your vehicle. Although the vehicle will
still be drivable and not need towing,
contact an Authorized Maserati
Dealer for service as soon as possible.
5
On Board Diagnostic System
Your vehicle is equipped with a
sophisticated onboard diagnostic
system called OBD II. This system
monitors the performance of the
emissions, engine, and automatic
207
Driving
Electronic Cruise Control
CAUTION!
5
208
• Prolonged driving with the
malfunction indicator light (MIL)
on could cause further damage to
the emissions control system. It could
also affect fuel economy and
drivability. The vehicle must be
serviced before any emissions tests
can be performed.
• If the
malfunction indicator light
(MIL) is flashing while the engine is
running, severe catalytic converter
damage and power loss will soon
occur. Immediate service is required
at the Authorized Maserati Dealer.
• After the problem has been solved,
the Authorized Maserati Dealer
personnel will perform specific tests
on the test bench for a complete
check of the system and, if necessary,
also road tests, even on long
distances.
The electronic speed regulator (Cruise
Control) enables the driver to maintain
the desired vehicle speed without
pressing the accelerator pedal,
reducing driving fatigue on highways,
especially long trips, as the set speed is
automatically maintained.
CAUTION!
The device can only be switched on at
speeds exceeding 19 mph (30 km/h)
and it switches off automatically when
the brake pedal is pressed.
WARNING!
The Cruise Control function must only
be activated when traffic and the
route allow maintaining a constant
speed safely for a sufficiently long
distance.
Controls
The electronic Cruise Control buttons
are located on the left side of the
steering wheel. Control buttons have
following functions:
ON/OFF button:
activation/deactivation;
multifunction control:
• RES (+), pushed up:
resume set speed (higher
speed);
• CANCEL, pushed: cancel
set speed;
• SET (–), pushed down:
setting speed (lower
speed).
Driving
NOTE:
In order to ensure proper operation,
the electronic Cruise Control system
has been designed to shut down if
multiple Cruise Control functions are
operated at the same time. If this
occurs, the electronic Cruise Control
system can be reactivated by pushing
the electronic Cruise Control ON/OFF
button and resetting the desired
vehicle set speed.
Activation
Push the ON/OFF button. The amber
light
in sector 13 of the instrument
cluster will illuminate and the related
message pops up for 5 seconds.
the display returns to the previous
setting.
Temporary Deactivation
A soft tap on the brake pedal, pushing
the CANCEL switch, or normal brake
pressure while slowing the vehicle will
temporarily deactivate the Electronic
Speed Control without erasing the set
speed memory, which will appear
above the white light
(in the
example: 45 mph).
The system must be turned off when
not in use.
Pressing the ON/OFF button or turning
the ignition switch OFF erases the set
speed memory.
WARNING!
Leaving the Electronic Speed Control
system on when not in use is
dangerous. You could accidentally set
the system or cause it to go faster
than you want. Always leave the
system OFF when you are not using it.
5
The related message will pop up for 5
seconds on the instrument cluster and
the display will return to the previous
setting, however, the white light
will turn on as the Cruise Control is
still activated.
To turn the system off, push the
ON/OFF button a second time. The
amber light
will turn off and a new
message pops up for 5 seconds, then
209
Driving
5
Setting Desired Speed
Resume Speed
Turn the electronic Cruise Control ON.
When the vehicle has reached the
desired speed (in the example:
51 mph), push the switch downward
and release.
The green light
will illuminate and
the related message will pop up for 5
seconds on the instrument cluster.
To resume a previously set speed, push
the RES (+) switch upward and release.
Resume can be used at any speed
above 19 mph (30 km/h).
If the driver presses the accelerator
pedal while the Cruise Control is
active, such as to overtake another
vehicle, and exceeds the speed limit,
the system will temporarily deactivate
the speed regulator. A message pops
up for 5 seconds on the instrument
cluster to alert the driver.
Release the accelerator and the vehicle
will operate at the selected speed.
NOTE:
The vehicle should be traveling at a
steady speed and on level ground
before pushing the switch downward.
When the accelerator pedal is
released, the vehicle will return to the
set speed.
210
Changing Speed Setting
When the electronic Cruise Control is
set, you can increase speed by pushing
the switch upward. Keeping the switch
pressed, the set speed will continue to
increase until the switch is released,
then the new set speed will be
maintained and memorized.
To decrease speed while the electronic
Cruise Control is activated, push the
switch downward. Keeping the switch
pushed in the downward position, the
set speed will continue to decrease
until the switch is released. Release the
switch when the desired speed is
reached, and the new set speed will be
maintained.
Pushing the switch upward or
downward once will enable to increase
or decrease the set speed of 1.24 mph
(2.0 km/h).
Each subsequent tap of the switch will
increase or decrease the speed of
1.24 mph (2.0 km/h).
Driving
Using Electronic Cruise Control on
Hillsides
The transmission may be downshifted
on hills to maintain the vehicle set
speed. The electronic Cruise Control
system maintains set speed up and
down hills. A slight speed change on
moderate hills is normal. On steep
slopes, a greater speed loss or gain
may occur so we recommend to drive
without Electronic Cruise Control.
WARNING!
Electronic Cruise Control can be
dangerous where the system cannot
maintain a constant speed. Your
vehicle could go too fast for the
conditions, and you could lose control
and have an accident. Do not use
electronic Cruise Control in heavy
traffic or on winding, icy,
snow-covered or slippery roads.
Tires - General
Information
Tire Safety Information
Tire Markings
Tire Sizing Chart
EXAMPLE: P245/40 ZR20 (99Y) XL or
245/40 ZR20 (Y99) XL
Size Designation:
P = Passenger car tire size based on
U.S. design standards
“...blank...” = Passenger car tire
based on European design standards
245 = Section width in millimeters
(mm)
40 = Aspect ratio in percent (%) —
Ratio of section height to section
width of tire
1. U.S. DOT Safety Standards Code
(TIN)
ZR = Construction Code
• Z: means a tire usable at speeds
greater than 150 mph (240 km/h)
• R: means radial construction
5
20 = Rim diameter in inches (in)
2. Size Designation
3. Service Description
4. Maximum Pressure and Maximum
Load
5. Treadwear, Traction and
Temperature Grades (see
“Department of Transportation
Uniform Tire Quality Grades” in
this section).
211
Driving
Service Description:
99 = Load Index — A numerical code
associated with the maximum load a
tire can carry
Y = Speed Symbol — A symbol
indicating the range of speeds at
which a tire can carry a load
corresponding to its load index
under certain operating conditions.
The maximum speed corresponding
to the speed symbol should only be
achieved under specified operating
conditions (i.e., tire pressure, vehicle
loading, road conditions, and posted
speed limits).
5
Load Identification:
“...blank...” = Absence of any text on
the sidewall of the tire indicates a
Standard Load (SL) tire
XL = Extra Load (or reinforced) tire
LL = Light Load tire
Tire Identification Number (TIN)
The TIN may be found on one or both
sides of the tire, however the date
code may only be on one side. Tires
with white sidewalls will have the full
TIN, including the date code, located
on the white sidewall side of the tire.
212
Look for the TIN on the outboard side
of black sidewall tires as mounted on
the vehicle. If the TIN is not found on
the outboard side, then you will find it
on the inboard side of the tire.
Tire and Loading Information Label
The proper cold tire inflation pressure
is listed on the driver's side rear door
pillar.
EXAMPLE: DOT MA L9 ABCD 0313
DOT = Department of Transportation
— This symbol certifies that the tire is
in compliance with the U.S.
Department of Transportation tire
safety standards and is approved for
highway use.
MA = Code representing the tire
manufacturing location (two digits).
L9 = Code representing the tire size
(two digits).
ABCD = Code used by the tire
manufacturer (one to four digits).
03 = Number representing the week
in which the tire was manufactured
(two digits). In this case, 03 means
the 3rd week.
13 = Number representing the year
in which the tire was manufactured
(two digits). In this case, 13 means
the year 2013.
This label tells you important
information about the:
• Number of people that can be
carried in the vehicle.
• Total weight the vehicle can carry.
• Tire size designed for the vehicle.
• Cold tire inflation pressures for the
front, rear, and spare tires.
Loading
The vehicle maximum load on the tire
must not exceed the load carrying
capacity of the tire on your vehicle.
You will not exceed the tire's load
carrying capacity if you adhere to the
loading conditions, tire size, and cold
tire inflation pressures specified on the
Driving
“Tire and Loading Information Label”
and in the “Features and
Specifications” section.
NOTE:
Under a maximum loaded vehicle
condition, gross axle weight ratings
(GAWRs) for the front and rear axles
must not be exceeded.
To determine the maximum loading
conditions of your vehicle, locate the
statement “The combined weight of
occupants and cargo should never
exceed XXX lbs/XXX kg” on the tire
and loading information label. The
combined weight of occupants and
cargo/luggage should never exceed
the weight referenced here.
Steps For Determining Correct Load
Limit
• Locate the statement “The combined
weight of occupants and cargo
should never exceed
XXX lbs/XXX kg” on the vehicle's
label.
• Determine the combined weight of
the driver and passengers that will
be riding in the vehicle.
• Subtract the combined weight of the
driver and passengers from
XXX lbs/XXX kg.
• The resulting figure equals the
available amount of cargo and
luggage load capacity. For example,
if “XXX amount equals 1,400 lbs/635
kg and there will be five
150 lbs/68 kg passengers in your
vehicle, the amount of available
cargo and luggage load capacity is
650 lbs/295 kg (since 5 x 150/68 =
750/340, and 1,400/635– 750/340 =
650 lbs/295 kg).
• Determine the combined weight of
luggage and cargo being loaded on
the vehicle. That weight may not
safely exceed the available cargo
and luggage load capacity calculated
in previous Step.
• If your vehicle will be towing a
trailer, load from your trailer will be
transferred to your vehicle. Consult
this manual to determine how this
reduces the available cargo and
luggage load capacity of your
vehicle.
NOTE:
• The following table shows examples
on how to calculate total load,
cargo/luggage, and towing
capacities of your vehicle with
varying seating configurations and
number and size of occupants. This
table is for illustration purposes only
and may not be accurate for the
seating and load carry capacity of
your vehicle.
• For the following example, the
combined weight of occupants and
cargo should never exceed
865 lbs/392 kg.
5
213
Driving
Occupants
TOTAL
FRONT
REAR
Combined weight
of Occupants and
Cargo from Tire
Label
MINUS
=
AVAILABLE Cargo/
Luggage and Trailer
Tongue weight
minus
1: 200 lbs/91 kg
2: 130 lbs/59 kg
3: 160 lbs/72 kg
4: 100 lbs/45 kg
5: 80 lbs/37 kg
TOTAL WEIGHT:
670 lbs (304 kg)
=
195 lbs/88 kg
minus
1: 210 lbs/95 kg
2: 180 lbs/82 kg
3: 150 lbs/68 kg
TOTAL WEIGHT:
540 lbs/245 kg
=
325 lbs/147 kg
minus
1: 200 lbs/91 kg
2: 200 lbs/91 kg
TOTAL WEIGHT:
400 lbs/182 kg
=
465 lbs/211 kg
EXAMPLE 1
865 lbs/392 kg
5
2
3
EXAMPLE 2
865 lbs/392 kg
5
3
2
1
EXAMPLE 3
865 lbs/392 kg
2
214
2
0
Combined Occupant's
weight (1, 2, 3, etc.)
Driving
Tires
Driving over rough or damaged road
surfaces, as well as debris, curbs and
other obstacles can cause serious
damage to wheels, tires, and
suspension parts.
This is more likely to occur with
low-profile tires, which provide less
cushioning between the wheel and
the road.
Be careful to avoid road hazards and
reduce your speed, especially if your
vehicle is equipped with low profile
tires.
WARNING!
Overloading of your tires is
dangerous. Overloading can cause tire
failure, affect vehicle handling, and
increase the stopping distance. Use
tires of the recommended load
capacity for your vehicle. Never
overload them.
Department of Transportation
Uniform Tire Quality Grades
The following tire grading categories
were established by the National
Highway Traffic Safety Administration.
The specific grade rating assigned by
the tire's manufacturer in each
category is shown on the sidewall of
the tires on your vehicle.
All passenger car tires must conform
to Federal safety requirements in
addition to these grades.
Treadwear
The Treadwear grade is a comparative
rating, based on the wear rate of the
tire when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified government
test course. For example, a tire graded
150 would wear one and one-half
times as well on the government
course as a tire graded 100. The
relative performance of tires depends
upon the actual conditions of their
use, however, and may depart
significantly from the norm due to
variations in driving habits, service
practices, and differences in road
characteristics and climate.
Traction Grades
The Traction grades, from highest to
lowest, are AAA, A, B, and C. These
grades represent the tire's ability to
stop on wet pavement, as measured
under controlled conditions on
specified government test surfaces of
asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C
may have poor traction performance.
WARNING!
The traction grade assigned to this
tire is based on straight-ahead
braking traction tests, and does not
include acceleration, cornering,
hydroplaning, or peak traction
characteristics.
5
Temperature Grades
The temperature grades are A (the
highest), B, and C, representing the
tire's resistance to the generation of
heat and its ability to dissipate heat,
when tested under controlled
conditons on a specified indoor
laboratory test wheel. Sustained high
temperature can cause the material of
the tire to degenerate and reduce tire
life, and excessive temperature can
lead to sudden tire failure.
215
Driving
5
The grade C corresponds to a level of
performance, which all passenger car
tires must meet under the Federal
Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No.
109. Grades B and A represent higher
levels of performance on the
laboratory test wheel, than the
minimum required by law.
Radial tires fitted on the vehicle may
look properly inflated even when they
actually are under inflated. Do not
make a visual judgment when
determining proper inflation.
Three primary driving aspects are
affected by improper tire pressure:
WARNING!
The temperature grade for this tire is
established for a tire that is properly
inflated and not overloaded. Excessive
speed, under-inflation, or excessive
loading, either separately or in
combination, can cause heat buildup
and possible tire failure.
WARNING!
• Improperly inflated tires are
dangerous and can cause collisions.
Tire Pressure
Proper tire inflation pressure is
essential for safety and best
performance of your vehicle. The tire
pressure monitoring system “TPMS”
setup on the vehicle (see “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System” in this section)
may alert the driver about insufficient
tire pressure even though the driver is
responsible for checking regularly the
tire pressure.
216
Safety
• Under-inflation increases tire flexing
and can result in tire overheating
and failure.
• Over-inflation reduces a tire's ability
to cushion shock. Objects on the
road and chuckholes can cause
damage that results in tire failure.
• Over-inflated or under-inflated tires
can affect vehicle handling and can
fail suddenly, resulting in loss of
vehicle control.
• Unequal tire pressures can cause
steering problems. You could lose
control of your vehicle.
• Unequal tire pressures from one side
of the vehicle to the other can cause
the vehicle to drift to the right or
left.
• Always drive with each tire inflated
to the recommended cold tire
inflation pressure.
Economy
Improper inflation pressures may cause
uneven wear patterns to develop
across the tire tread. These abnormal
wear patterns will reduce tread life
resulting in a need for earlier tire
replacement. Under-inflation also
increases tire rolling resistance
resulting in higher fuel consumption.
Ride comfort and vehicle stability
Proper tire inflation contributes to a
comfortable ride. Over-inflation
produces a jarring and uncomfortable
ride.
Tire Pressure Checkup
The proper cold tire inflation pressure
is indicated on the driver's side rear
door pillar.
Inflation pressure specified on the
label always refers to “cold tire
inflation pressure”. Cold tire inflation
pressure is defined as the tire pressure
after the vehicle has not been driven
for at least three hours, or driven less
than 1 mi (1.6 km) after a three hour
period.
Driving
Check tire pressures more often in
case of significant outside
temperature changes, as tire pressure
varies according to temperature
changes.
The pressure should be checked and if
necessary adjusted; tire wear and
overall conditions should also be
checked monthly. Tire pressures
change by approximately 1 PSI (0.07
bar) per 12°F (7°C) of air temperature
change. Keep this in mind when
checking tire pressure inside a garage,
especially in winter.
Example: If garage temperature = 68°F
(20°C) and the outside temperature =
32°F (0°C) then the cold tire inflation
pressure should be increased by 3 PSI
(0.21 bar) for every 12°F (7°C) for this
outside temperature condition.
Tire pressure may increase from 2 to 6
PSI (0.13 to 0.4 bar) during operation.
DO NOT reduce this normal pressure
build up or your tire pressure will be
too low. After inspecting or adjusting
the tire pressure, always reinstall the
valve stem cap. This will prevent
moisture and dirt from entering the
valve stem, which could damage the
valve stem and the TPMS sensor
connected to it.
Tread Wear Indicators
Tread wear indicators are in the
original equipment tires to help you in
determining when your tires should
be replaced.
These indicators are molded into the
bottom of the tread grooves. They will
appear as bands when the tread depth
becomes 0.06 in (1.6 mm).
When the tread is worn to one of the
tread wear indicators, the tire should
be replaced.
WARNING!
The wet performance (aquaplaning
resistance) will decrease
proportionally to the thickness of the
tread.
Tires Durability
The service life of a tire depends on
various factors including, but not
limited to:
• driving style;
• tire pressure;
• distance driven.
WARNING!
Tires and the spare tire (if equipped)
should be replaced after six years,
regardless of the remaining tread.
Failure to follow this warning can
result in sudden tire failure. You could
lose control and have a collision
resulting in serious injury or death.
Replacement Tires
In order to maintain high performance
and safety level under all driving
conditions, Maserati strongly
recommends to use tires equivalent to
the originals in size, quality and
performance when replacement is
needed.
See the “Tire and Loading
Information” label on the driver’s side
rear door pillar for the size
designation of your tire or see
“Technical Data” in section 8.
The Load Index and Speed Symbol for
your tire will be found on the original
equipment tire sidewall.
5
217
Driving
NOTE:
Maserati recommendes Maserati
Genuine Tires marked with “MGT”
logo specifically designed for its
models.
5
It is recommended to replace the two
front tires or two rear tires as a pair.
Replacing just one tire can seriously
affect your vehicle’s handling.
If you ever replace a wheel assembly,
make sure that the wheel’s
specifications (valve, TPMS sensor and
tire) match those of the original
wheels. Failure to use equivalent
replacement tires may adversely affect
the safety, handling, and ride of your
vehicle.
The Authorized Maserati Dealer is
available to provide suggestions as to
the types of tires most suited to the
use foreseen by the Customer.
WARNING!
• Do not use a tire, wheel size or
rating other than that specified for
your vehicle. Some combinations of
unapproved tires and wheels may
change suspension dimensions and
performance characteristics,
resulting in altered steering,
handling, and braking operations of
218
the vehicle. This can cause
unpredictable handling and stress to
steering and suspension
components. You could lose control
and have a collision resulting in
serious injury or death. Use only the
tire and wheel sizes with load
ratings appointed for your vehicle.
• Never use a tire with a smaller load
index or capacity, other than what
was originally equipped on your
vehicle. Using a tire with a smaller
load index could result in tire
overloading and failure. You could
lose control and have a collision.
• Always check the maximum speed
rating on the tire sidewall on any
tire on the vehicle.
• Never exceed the maximum speed
rating of the tires. Risk of accident
and serious pesonal injury due to
excessive speed.
• Failure to equip your vehicle with
tires having adequate speed
capability can result in sudden tire
failure and loss of vehicle control.
CAUTION!
Replacing original tires with tires of a
different size may result in false
speedometer and odometer readings.
Winter Tires
These tires are specially designed for
driving on snow and ice and are fitted
to replace the ones supplied with the
vehicle. Winter or All season tires can
be identified by the M+S (Mud &
Snow) or 3PMSF (3 Peaks Mountain
Snow Flake) designation on the tire
sidewall.
Before mounting snow tires, contact
the Authorized Maserati Dealer to
receive the technical information
necessary to advise you on wheel and
tire compatibility.
Use snow tires only in sets of four.
As to the type of tires to use, inflation
pressures and winter tires
specifications, carefully follow the
indications as reported in the
“Technical Data” and “Tire Inflation
Pressure” chapters in section 8.
The features of these tires are
markedly reduced in winter when
tread depth is less than 0.16 in (4 mm).
In this case, they should be replaced.
Driving
The specific features of winter tires
lead to lower performance under
normal weather conditions or on long
highway trips, compared to the
standard tires. Therefore, their use
should be limited to the performance
for which they have been
type-approved.
NOTE:
For the correct use and replacement of
winter tires, refer to the instructions
for normal tires.
WARNING!
The standard tires profile and rubber
mixture are optimized for wet and dry
driving conditions. Standard tires may
not prove favorable for snow
conditions: install snow tires before
driving in such conditions to avoid
risk of loss of control and damage to
the vehicle as well as serious personal
injury.
NOTE:
Snow tires should have the same load
capacity as original equipment tires
and should be mounted on all four
wheels.
Snow Chains
The use of snow chains is specified by
local regulations of each country.
Use snow chains of reduced
dimensions, with a maximum
projection of 0.23 in (6 mm) beyond
the tire tread.
The chains may be fitted only on 19”
driving wheel tires.
Check the chain tension after driving
for a distance of about 55 yd (50 m)
with the chains fitted.
With the chains fitted, it is advisable
to deactivate the ESC system (see
chapter “Automatic Transmission” in
this section).
CAUTION!
• Broken chains can cause serious
damage. Stop the vehicle
immediately if noise occurs that
could indicate chain breakage.
Remove the damaged parts of the
chain before further use.
• Do not exceed 30 mph (50 km/h).
• Drive cautiously and avoid severe
turns and large bumps, especially
with a loaded vehicle.
• Avoid holes in the road, do not drive
over steps or sidewalks and do not
drive on long stretches without
snow. This will prevent damage to
the vehicle and the roadbed.
NOTE:
Maserati provides on request spider
version snow chains especially
developed for this vehicle. This chains
are easy to be fitted and can be
removed quickly without damaging
the wheel rims. The Authorized
Maserati Dealer can provide you with
all information about the “Maserati
Spider Version Snow Chains”, available
in the Genuine Accessories range.
5
Compact Spare Tire
The limited-use spare tire, or
compact-spare tire, is for temporary
emergency use only.
This tire is identified by a label
indicating the driving speed
limitations to comply with when using
the spare tire.
Keep it inflated to the cold tire
inflation pressure listed on your Tire
and Loading Information label located
on the driver’s side rear door pillar or
in the table “Tire Inflation Pressure” in
section 8.
219
Driving
Mounting the spare tire affects vehicle
handling. Replace (or repair) as soon as
possible the original equipment tire
and reinstall it on the vehicle. Do not
install more than one compact spare
tire and wheel on the vehicle at a
time.
Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS)
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) will warn the driver of a low
tire pressure according to the vehicle
recommended cold pressure indicated
on the label on the driver's side rear
door pillar.
WARNING!
With these compact spare tires, do not
drive more than 50 mph (80 km/h).
Temporary use spares have limited
tread life.
5
The tire pressure will vary with
temperature by about 1 PSI (0.07 bar)
for every 12°F (7°C). This means that
when the outside temperature
decreases, the tire pressure will
decrease. Tire pressure should always
be set based on cold inflation tire
pressure. This is defined as the tire
pressure after the vehicle has not been
driven for at least three hours, or
driven less than 1 mi (1.6 km) after a
three hour period. The cold tire
inflation pressure must not exceed the
220
maximum inflation pressure molded
into the tire sidewall. Check “Tires –
General Information” in section 5 for
information on how to properly inflate
the tires.
The tire pressure will also increase as
the vehicle is driven - this is normal
and there is no adjustment required
when this occurs.
The TPMS will warn the driver of a low
tire pressure if the tire pressure falls
below the low-pressure warning limit
for any reason, including low
temperature effects and natural
pressure loss of the tire.
The TPMS will continue to warn the
driver of low tire pressure as long as
the condition persists and will not turn
off until the tire pressure is equal or
above the recommended cold inflation
pressure. Once the low tire pressure
warning light
illuminates, you must
increase the tire pressure to the
recommended cold inflation pressure
in order for the TPMS light
to turn
off. The system will automatically
update and the TPMS light
will turn
off once the system acquires the
correct tire pressure.
The vehicle may need to be driven for
up to 20 minutes above 15 mph
(24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to
Driving
acquire and process the updated
setting.
For example: Your vehicle (stationary
for more than three hours) may have a
recommended cold inflation pressure
of 30 PSI (2.1 bar). If the ambient
temperature is 68°F (20°C) and the
measured tire pressure is 27 PSI (1.8
bar), a temperature drop to 12°F (7°C)
will decrease the tire pressure to
approximately 23 PSI (1.6 bar). This
tire pressure is sufficiently low to turn
ON the TPMS Light
. Driving the
vehicle may cause the tire pressure to
rise to approximately 27 PSI (1.8 bar),
but the TPMS light
will stay lit. In
this situation, the TPMS light
will
turn OFF only after the tires are
inflated to the vehicle’s recommended
cold inflation pressure value.
WARNING!
The TPMS warns the driver that the
tire pressure has decreased. This
warning does not exempt the driver
from periodically checking the tires
and from complying with the
prescribed tire pressure levels.
CAUTION!
• The TPMS has been optimized for
the original equipment tires and
wheels. TPMS pressures and warning
have been established for the tire
size equipped on your vehicle.
Undesirable system operation or
sensor damage may occur when
using replacement equipment that is
not of the same size, type, and/or
style. Aftermarket wheels can cause
sensor damage. Do not use
aftermarket tire sealants or balance
beads if your vehicle is equipped
with a TPMS, as damage to the
sensors may result.
• The system can temporarily
experience radio-electric
interference emitted by devices
using similar frequencies.
• After inspecting or adjusting the tire
pressure, always reinstall the valve
stem cap. This will prevent moisture
and dirt from entering the valve
stem and damage the TPMS internal
sensor.
5
NOTE:
• Driving on a significantly
underinflated tire causes the tire to
overheat and may lead to tire
failure. Under-inflation also reduces
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and
may affect the vehicle’s handling and
stopping ability.
• The TPMS is not a substitute for
proper tire maintenance, and it is
the driver’s responsibility to maintain
correct tire pressure using an
accurate tire pressure gage, even if
under-inflation has not reached the
(Continued)
221
Driving
5
(Continued)
level to trigger illumination of the
TPMS light
.
• Seasonal temperature changes will
affect tire pressure, and the TPMS
will monitor the actual tire pressure
in the tire.
will automatically update, the graphic
display in the instrument panel will
stop flashing, and the TPMS light
will turn off. The vehicle may need
to be driven for up to 20 minutes
above 15 mph (24 km/h) in order for
the TPMS to acquire and process the
updated information.
Premium System
“Service Tire Pressure System”
Warning
The TPMS system uses wireless
technology with wheel rim mounted
electronic sensors to monitor tire
pressure levels. Sensors mounted to
each wheel as part of the valve stem
transmit tire pressure readings to the
receiver module.
The TPMS consists of the following
components:
The instrument cluster will also display
a screenshot reporting the pressure
values of each tire with flashing low
pressure value.
• receiver module;
• four TPMS sensors;
• various TPMS messages, which
display on the instrument cluster;
• warning light
.
Tire Pressure Low Warning
will illuminate in
The TPMS light
the instrument cluster and an acoustic
signal will notify that tire pressure is
low in one or more of the four tires.
222
Should this occur, you should stop as
soon as possible and inflate the tire/s
with the low pressure (the one/s
flashing in the instrument panel
graphic) to the recommended cold
pressure inflation value indicated on
the label. Once the system receives the
updated tire pressure value, the system
If a system fault is detected, the TPMS
light
will flash for 75 seconds and
then remain lit followed by a beeping
sound. Therewith, the instrument
cluster will display a "Service Tire
Pressure System" message for a
minimum of five seconds and then
display dashes (- -) in place of the
pressure value to indicate which sensor
is ineffective.
If the ignition switch is cycled, the
sequence will repeat, in case the
system fault still persists. If the system
fault no longer exists, the TPMS light
will no longer flash, and the
"Service Tire Pressure System" message
will no longer display, and a pressure
value will display in place of the
dashes.
Driving
sound. In addition, the graphic in
the instrument cluster will still
display a flashing pressure value
corresponding to the compact tire
position.
A system fault can occur due to any of
the following:
• Signal interference due to electronic
devices or driving next to facilities
emitting the same radio frequencies
as the TPMS sensors.
• Installing aftermarket window
tinting that contains materials that
may block radio wave signals.
• Accumulation of snow or ice around
the wheels or wheel housings.
• Using tire chains on the vehicle.
• Using wheels/tires not equipped
with TPMS sensors.
The instrument cluster will also display
a "Service Tire Pressure System"
message for a minimum of five
seconds when a system fault related to
an incorrect sensor location fault is
detected. In this case, the "Service Tire
Pressure System" message is then
followed with a graphic display with
pressure values still shown. This
indicates that the pressure values are
still being received from the TPMS
sensors but they may not be located in
the correct vehicle position. The
system still needs to be serviced as
long as the "Service Tire Pressure
System" message is displayed.
Vehicles with Compact Spare Tire
• The compact spare tire does not
have a TPMS sensor. Therefore, the
TPMS will not monitor the pressure
of the compact spare tire.
• If you replace a pneumatic having
pressure below the low-pressure
warning limit, with the compact
spare tire, on the next ignition
switch cycle, the TPMS light
will
illuminate followed by a beeping
• After driving the vehicle for up to 20
minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h),
the TPMS light
will flash for 75
seconds and then remain lit. The
instrument cluster will then display a
"Service Tire Pressure System"
message for a minimum of five
seconds and then displays dashes (--)
in place of the pressure value.
• Each subsequent ignition switch
cycle, will be followed by a beeping
sound, the TPMS light
will flash
for 75 seconds and then remain lit.
The instrument cluster will then
display a "Service Tire Pressure
System" message for a minimum of
five seconds and subsequently
5
223
Driving
displays dashes (--) in place of the
pressure value.
5
• Once you repair, replace or reinstall a
tire with the compact spare tire, the
TPMS will update automatically. The
TPMS light
will turn OFF and the
graphic in the instrument cluster will
display a new pressure value instead
of dashes (--), as long as no tire
pressure is below the low-pressure
warning limit in any of the four tires.
The vehicle may need to be driven
for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph
(24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to
acquire and process the updated
information.
assemblies. After replacing all four
wheel and tire assemblies (road tires)
with tires not equipped with Tire
Pressure Monitoring System sensors,
drive the vehicle for 20 minutes above
15 mph (24 km/h). The TPMS will
chime, the TPMS light
will flash on
and off for 75 seconds and then
remain on and the instrument cluster
will display the “Service Tire Pressure
System” message and then display
dashes (--) in place of the pressure
values. Beginning with the next
ignition switch cycle, the TPMS will no
longer chime or display the “Service
Tire Pressure System” message in the
instrument cluster but dashes (--) will
remain in place of the pressure values.
TPMS Deactivation
The TPMS can be deactivated if
replacing all four tire rims with wheel
and tire assemblies free of TPMS
sensors, such as winter wheel and tire
224
To reactivate the TPMS, replace all four
wheel and tire assemblies (road tires)
with tires equipped with TPMS sensors.
Then, drive the vehicle for up to 20
minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h). The
TPMS will chime, the TPMS light
will flash for 75 seconds and then
turn off. The instrument cluster will
then display the “Service Tire Pressure
System” message. The instrument
cluster will also display pressure values
in place of the dashes (--). On the next
ignition switch cycle the “Service Tire
Pressure System” message will no
longer be displayed as long as no
system fault exists.
Driving
General Information
This device complies with Part 15 of
the FCC rules and RSS 210 of Industry
Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
• This device may not cause harmful
interference.
• This device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause
undesired operation.
The TPMS sensors are regulated under
one of the following licenses:
United States
MRXC4W4MA4
Canada
2546–C4W4MA4
Fuel Requirements
The engines are designed to meet all
environmental regulations and
provide excellent fuel economy and
performance when using unleaded
premium gasoline with an AKI octane
rating of 91 or above. AKI (Anti Knock
Index) is an average on the Research
Octane Number, RON, and the Motor
Octane Number, MON (RON + MON/2
gives you the AKI).
Light spark knock at low engine
speeds is not harmful to your engine.
However, continued heavy spark
knock at high speeds can cause
damage, and immediate service is
required.
Poor quality gasoline can cause
problems such as hard starting,
stalling, and hesitation. If you
experience these symptoms, try
another brand of gasoline before
considering service for the vehicle at
an Authorized Maserati Dealer.
Over 40 auto manufacturers
worldwide have issued and endorsed
consistent gasoline specifications (the
World Wide Fuel Charter, WWFC)
which define fuel properties necessary
to deliver enhanced emissions,
performance, and durability for your
vehicle.
Maserati recommends the use of
gasoline that meets the WWFC
specifications if they are available.
Besides using unleaded gasoline with
the proper octane rating, gasoline
that contain detergents, anti-corrosion
and stability additives are
recommended. Using gasoline that
have these additives may help improve
fuel economy, reduce emissions, and
maintain vehicle performance.
CAUTION!
The anti-pollution devices of the
vehicle require unleaded fuel to be
used at all times. Under no
circumstance, not even in an
emergency, should leaded fuel be
supplied to the fuel tank, not even a
minimum quantity. This would
irreparably damage the catalytic
converters. An inefficient catalytic
converter results in noxious exhaust
emissions which damage the
environment.
5
Reformulated Gasoline
Many areas of the country require the
use of cleaner burning gasoline,
referred to as “Reformulated
Gasoline”. Reformulated gasoline
225
Driving
contains oxygenates and are
specifically blended to reduce vehicle
emissions and improve air quality.
Maserati supports the use of
reformulated gasoline. Properly
blended reformulated gasoline will
provide excellent performance and
durability of engine and fuel system
components.
Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends
Some fuel suppliers blend unleaded
gasoline with oxygenates such as
Ethanol. Fuels blended with
oxygenates may be used in your
vehicle.
5
CAUTION!
DO NOT use gasoline containing
Methanol or gasoline containing more
than 10% Ethanol. Use of these blends
may result in starting and driveability
problems, damage critical fuel system
components, cause emissions to exceed
the applicable standard, and/or cause
the
Malfunction Indicator Light to
illuminate (see “Instrument Cluster” in
section 4). Pump labels should clearly
communicate if a fuel contains greater
than 10% Ethanol.
Problems that result from using
gasoline containing Methanol or
gasoline containing more than 10%
Ethanol are not the responsibility of
Maserati and may not be covered
under warranty.
MMT in Gasoline
MMT (Methylcyclopentadienyl
Manganese Tricarbonyl) is a
manganese containing metallic
additive that is blended into some
gasoline to increase octane.
Gasoline blended with MMT provides
no performance advantage beyond
gasoline of the same octane number
without MMT.
Maserati recommends gasoline
without MMT to be used in your
vehicle. The MMT content of gasoline
may not be indicated on the gasoline
pump; therefore, you should ask the
gasoline station operator whether or
not the gasoline contains MMT.
It is even more important to look for
gasoline without MMT in Canada,
because MMT can be used at levels
higher than those allowed in the
United States. MMT is prohibited in
Federal and California reformulated
gasoline.
Materials Added to Fuel
All gasoline sold in the United States is
required to contain effective
detergent additives. Use of additional
detergents or other additives is not
needed under normal conditions and
they would result in additional cost.
Therefore, you should not have to add
anything to the fuel.
Fuel System Warnings
WARNING!
Follow these guidelines to maintain
your vehicle's performance:
• The use of leaded gasoline is
prohibited by Federal law. Using
leaded gasoline can impair engine
performance and damage the
emissions control system.
• An out-of-tune engine or certain fuel
or ignition malfunctions can cause
the catalytic converter to overheat. If
you notice a pungent burning odor
or some light smoke, your engine
may be out of tune or
malfunctioning and may require
immediate service. Contact an
Authorized Maserati Dealer for
assistance.
(Continued)
226
Driving
(Continued)
• The use of fuel additives, which are
now being sold as octane enhancers,
is not recommended. Most of these
products contain high
concentrations of methanol. Fuel
system damage or vehicle
performance problems resulting
from the use of such fuels or
additives is not the responsibility of
Maserati.
NOTE:
International tampering with the
emissions control system can result in
civil penalties being assessed against
you.
Carbon Monoxide Warnings
WARNING!
Carbon monoxide (CO) in exhaust
gases is deadly. Follow the
precautions below to prevent carbon
monoxide poisoning:
the engine running for an extended
period. If the vehicle is stopped in
an open area with the engine
running for more than a short
period, adjust the ventilation system
to force fresh, outside air into the
vehicle.
• Guard against carbon monoxide
with proper maintenance. Have the
exhaust system inspected every time
the vehicle is raised. Have any
abnormal conditions repaired
promptly. Until repaired, drive with
all side windows fully open.
Refueling
To access the fuel filler neck, the filler
door must be unlocked. From outside
the vehicle, this can only be done by
pressing the unlock or the lock
button on the key fob RKE
transmitter, in the same way as if
opening or closing the doors. If any of
the door lock controls is pressed from
inside the vehicle, the filler door will
still remain open to allow refueling.
Once the fuel filler door is unlocked,
proceed as follows:
• Press the indicated area on the filler
door, which is located on the rear
left side of the vehicle: the filler
door will open completely. There is
no fuel filler cap. A flapper door
inside the filler seals the system.
• Insert the fuel nozzle fully into the
filler – the nozzle opens and holds
the flapper door while refueling.
5
• Do not inhale exhaust gases. They
contain carbon monoxide, a
colorless and odorless gas, which
can kill. Never run the engine in a
closed area, such as a garage, and
never sit in a parked vehicle with
227
Driving
NOTE:
Only the correct size nozzle opens the
latches allowing the flapper door on
the fuel filler to open.
• To avoid the risk of inhaling noxious
fumes, do not breathe close to the
fuel filler door, when opened.
• Never have any smoking materials lit
in or near the vehicle when the fuel
filler door is open or the tank is
being filled.
• Never add fuel when the engine is
running. This violates most anti-fire
regulations and may cause the
malfunction indicator light
to
turn on (see “Instrument Cluster” in
section 4).
5
WARNING!
• To avoid the risk of fire, do not
approach the filler with open flames
or cigarettes!
228
Fill the vehicle with fuel. Fuel tank
capacity is indicated in the “Refillings”
table in section 8.
When the fuel nozzle “clicks” or shuts
off, the fuel tank is basically full: it is
possible to further refuel by enabling
the fuel nozzle additional fuel supply
until twofold clicks. After the two
additional clicks, the amount of fuel
allowed by the system is very low, we
recommend therefore not to persist
further.
Wait approximately 10 seconds before
removing the fuel nozzle in order to
ensure completed supply of residual
fuel and restrict the risk of fouling the
fuel filler door area.
Remove the fuel nozzle and close the
fuel filler door.
CAUTION!
To avoid fuel spillage and overfilling,
do not “top off” the fuel tank after
filling.
Emergency refueling funnel
A funnel is provided (in the trunk in
the tool box container) for emergency
refueling with a gas can.
Driving
WARNING!
A fire may result if gasoline is pumped
into a portable container that is inside
of a vehicle. You could be burned.
Always place gas containers on the
ground and outside the vehicle while
filling.
• Pull the release cable moderately to
avoid its possible break. It's not
possible to feel or hear the
unlocking of the fuel filler door
actuator.
• Open the trunk (see “To enter the
Trunk” in section 2).
• Lift the access cover on the left side
of the trunk compartment.
Before the Trip
Check the following at regular
intervals and always before long trips:
• tire pressure and condition;
• levels of fluids and lubricants;
• conditions of the windshield wiper
blades;
• clean the glass on the external light
and all other glass surfaces;
• proper operation of the warning
lights and of the external lights.
Emergency Fuel Filler Door
Release
If you are unable to unlock the fuel
filler door using the key fob RKE
transmitter, then use the fuel filler
door emergency release fitted in the
trunk.
Driving Conditions
• Then open normally the fuel filler
door.
CAUTION!
It is however advisable to perform
these checks at least every 600 mi
(1,000 km) and always following the
maintenance schedule reported in
section 7.
5
Before you drive:
• adjust seat position, steering wheel,
adjustable pedals (if equipped with)
and rear-view mirrors in order to
have the best driving position;
• ensure that nothing (mat covers,
etc.) is obstructing the pedals
movement;
229
Driving
• carefully arrange and secure any
objects in the trunk, to prevent them
to move forward in case of sudden
stops;
• avoid drinking alcohol.
5
230
WARNING!
Beyond being prohibited by law, it is
extremely dangerous to ride inside the
trunk or on the front lid. In the event
of an accident, passengers sitting
there are more exposed to the risk of
serious injury. Passengers must only
travel seated in the vehicle seats, with
the seat belts fastened. Always check
that the driver and all passengers
have the seat belts correctly fastened.
Safe Driving
Although the vehicle is equipped with
active and passive safety devices, the
driver's conduct is always a decisive
factor for road safety.
Some simple rules for traveling safely
in different conditions are listed
below. Some of them will probably
already sound familiar but, in any case,
it would be useful to read them
carefully.
the eyes. If they are too high, they
may bother other drivers.
• Use the high beams only outside of
densely-populated areas and when
you are sure that they will not
disturb other drivers.
• When another vehicle is
approaching, switch from high
beams (if on) to low beams.
• Keep lights and headlights clean.
• Beware of animals crossing the road.
Driving at Night
Driving in the Rain
The main guidelines to follow when
driving at night are set out below.
Rain and wet roads are dangerous. On
a wet road all maneuvers are more
difficult since wheel grip on the
asphalt is significantly reduced. This
means that braking distances increase
considerably and road grip decreases.
Some advice for driving in the rain are
listed below.
• Drive carefully. Night conditions
demands more focus and attention.
• Reduce your speed, especially on
roads with no streetlights.
• Stop at early signs of drowsiness.
Continuing to drive would be a risk
for yourself and for others. Have a
rest before continuing your trip.
• Keep the vehicle at a greater
distance from vehicles in front of you
than you would during the day: it is
difficult to assess the speed of other
vehicles when you only see the lights.
• Check that the headlights are
correctly adjusted: if they are too
low, they reduce visibility and strain
• Reduce your speed and keep a
greater safety distance from the
vehicles in front of you. High speed
may result in a loss of vehicle control.
• When driving on wet or slushy roads,
it is possible for a wedge of water to
build up between the tire and road
surface. This is known as
aquaplaning and may cause partial
or complete loss of vehicle control
and stopping ability. To reduce this
Driving
possibility: slow down if the road has
standing water or puddles.
• Heavy rain substantially reduces
visibility. In these circumstances, even
during the day, turn on the low
beams, to be more visible to other
drivers.
• Set the air conditioning and heating
system controls on the demisting
function, in order to avoid any
visibility problem.
• Periodically check the conditions of
the windshield wiper blades.
• In low grip conditions use I C E
driving mode (see chapter
“Automatic Transmission” in this
section).
difficult and braking distances are
extended.
• Keep a safe distance from the
vehicle in front of you.
• Avoid sudden changes in speed as
much as possible.
• Whenever possible, avoid
overtaking.
• If you are forced to stop the vehicle
(breakdowns, impossibility of
proceeding due to poor visibility,
etc.), first of all, try to stop off of the
travel lane. Then turn on the hazard
warning flashers and, if possible, the
low beams.
• Sound the horn rhythmically if you
hear another vehicle approaching.
Driving in Fog
If the fog is dense, avoid traveling if
possible.
When driving in mist, blanket fog or
when there is the possibility of banks
of fog, please consider some advices
listed below.
CAUTION!
Be aware that rear fog lights can
bother the drivers following your
vehicle: when visibility is back to
normal, turn off these lights.
• Keep a moderate speed.
• Even in daytime, turn on the low
beams, the rear fog lights. Do not
use the high beams.
• Remember that fog creates
dampness on the asphalt and thus
any type of maneuver is more
Driving in the Mountains
Mountain roads usually have many
narrow turns and curves, tunnels and
steep uphill or downhill slopes: please
consider some advices listed below.
• Drive at a moderate speed, avoid
“cutting” corners.
• When driving inside a tunnel in
daylight turn on the low beams in
advance; avoid high beams and be
aware of the rapid brightness
change. Avoid abrupt maneuvers
that could be dangerous for the
following vehicle.
• Never coast downhill with the
engine off or in neutral.
• Remember that passing other
vehicles when driving uphill is slower
and thus requires more free distance
on the road. If you are being
overtaken on a hill, slow down and
allow the other vehicle to pass.
Driving on Snow or Ice
Please consider some general advice
for driving in these conditions, listed
below.
5
• Maintain a very moderate speed.
• Fit snow chains or snow tires if the
road is covered with snow: see the
paragraphs “Tires – General
Information” in this section.
• We recommend you to activate the
I C E mode (see chapter “Automatic
Transmission” in this section).
• During the winter season, even
apparently dry roads can have icy
sections. Be careful when crossing
bridges, viaducts and roads that
231
Driving
have little exposure to the sun and
are bordered by trees and rocks.
They may be icy.
• Keep an ample safe distance from
the vehicles in front of you.
• Avoid sharp braking, sharp changes
in direction and rapid acceleration.
Rapid acceleration on snow covered
or icy surfaces may cause the driving
wheels to pull erratically to the right
or left. This phenomenon occurs
when there is a difference in the
surface traction under the rear
(driving) wheels.
5
WARNING!
Rapid acceleration on slippery surfaces
is dangerous. Unequal traction can
cause sudden pulling of the rear
driving wheels. You could lose control
of the vehicle and possibly have a
collision. Accelerate slowly and
carefully whenever there is likely to be
poor traction (ice, snow, wet mud,
loose sand, etc.).
Driving through Flooded
Sections
Driving through more than a
centimeter of deep shallow standing
water section will require extra
caution to ensure passenger safety and
prevent damage to your vehicle.
WARNING!
Do not drive on or across a road or
path where water is flowing and/or
rising (as in storm run-off). Flowing
water can wear away the road or path
surface and cause your vehicle to sink
into deeper water. Furthermore,
flowing and/or rising water can carry
your vehicle away swiftly. Failure to
follow this warning may result in
injuries that are serious or fatal to
you, your passengers, and others
around you.
Although your vehicle is capable of
driving through shallow standing
water, consider the following Caution
and Warning before doing so.
CAUTION!
• Always check the depth of the
standing water before driving
232
through it. Never drive through
standing water that is deeper than
the bottom of the tire rims mounted
on the vehicle.
• Determine the condition of the road
or the path that is under water and if
there are any obstacles in the way
before driving through the standing
water.
• Do not exceed 5 mph (8 km/h) when
driving through standing water. This
will minimize wave effects.
• Driving through standing water may
cause damage to your vehicle
drivetrain components. After driving
through standing water, do not drive
if you are not sure about drivetrain
condition. Such damage is not
covered by the New Vehicle
Warranty.
• Getting water inside your vehicle
engine can cause it to lock up and
stall out, and cause serious internal
damage to the engine. Such damage
is not covered by the New Vehicle
Warranty.
• After driving through standing water
always have the fluids (engine oil,
transmission oil, etc) checked for
contaminations at an Authorized
Maserati Dealer.
Driving
WARNING!
• Driving through standing water
limits your vehicle traction
capabilities. Do not exceed 5 mph
(8 km/h) when driving through
standing water.
• Driving through standing water
limits your vehicle braking
capabilities, which increases
stopping distances. Therefore, after
driving through standing water,
drive slowly and lightly press on the
brake pedal several times to
progressively dry the brakes discs
and pads.
5
• Getting water inside your vehicle
engine can cause it to lock up and
stall out.
• Failure to follow these warnings
may result in injuries that are
serious or fatal to you, your
passengers, and others around you.
233
Driving
234
6 – In an Emergency
Tool Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
In the Event of an Accident . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Engine Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
In case of a Punctured Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Emergency Release of the Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . 243
Transmission Manual Release of P (Park) Position
Freeing the Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Auxiliary Jump-Start Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Towing a Disabled Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
245
245
246
249
235
In an Emergency
Tool Kit
Hazard Warning Flashers
The tool kit and other first aid
equipment are relocated in the trunk
and are available by lifting the ground
coverage.
The hazard warning flasher switch is
located in the center of the dashboard
under the MTC display.
Press the switch to turn on the hazard
warning flashers to warn oncoming
traffic of an emergency. When these
lights illuminate, the turn signals, the
related warning lights on the
instrument cluster and the button start
flashing.
Press the switch a second time to turn
off the hazard warning flashers.
This is an emergency warning system
and it should not be used when the
vehicle is in motion. Use it when your
vehicle is disabled and it is creating a
safety hazard for other motorists.
When you must leave the vehicle to
seek assistance, the hazard warning
flashers will continue to operate even
though the ignition is placed in the
OFF position.
Beside the tool kit the vehicle is also
equipped with the following tools:
The tool kit includes following tools:
6
• 8/10 mm open end wrenches;
• 13/17 mm open end wrenches;
• double slot + cross-head screwdriver;
• tow hook;
• pincer for wheel stud caps extraction
(where provided);
• tool for electric parking brake
actuator release.
• compact spare wheel. The compact
spare wheel is fully provided with
electric compressor box, jack and
tools for fitting the compact spare
wheel, located inside the compact
spare wheel itself;
• funnel for emergency supply.
CAUTION!
• When the hazard warning flashers
are activated, the turn signals control
is disabled.
236
In an Emergency
(Continued)
• With extended use the hazard
warning flashers may wear down
your battery.
In the Event of an
Accident
It is important always to keep calm.
• If not directly involved, stop at a safe
distance of at least ten meters away
from the accident area.
• If on a highway, stop without
obstructing the emergency lane and
be especially careful if you need to
exit the vehicle.
• Turn off the engine and switch on
the hazard lights.
• At night, illuminate the accident
area with the headlights.
• Always act with caution to avoid the
risk of being crashed into by other
drivers.
• Indicate that an accident has
occurred by placing the emergency
triangle (if foreseen) in a well visible
position and at the prescribed
distance.
• Call the emergency services,
providing as much information as
possible. On the highway, use the
special call boxes.
• Remove the ignition key (if present)
from the vehicles involved.
• If fuel or other chemical products
can be smelled, do not smoke and
ask people around you to put their
cigarettes out.
• To extinguish fires, even small ones,
use a fire extinguisher, blankets,
sand or earth. Never use water.
• In multiple accidents occurred on
highways, particularly where
visibility is poor, there is a high risk
of being involved in other collisions.
Leave the vehicle immediately and
move away from the area.
In case of Injured Persons
• Never leave the injured person
alone.
• Do not crowd around injured
persons.
• Reassure the injured person that
help is on the way and stay close to
them to assist them to avoid possible
panic attacks.
• Release or cut the seat belts
restraining the injured persons.
• Do not give the injured persons
anything to drink.
• Never move an injured person.
• Remove the injured person from the
vehicle only in an emergency
situation, e.g. if there is a risk of fire,
sinking in water or falling down into
a pit.
6
237
In an Emergency
• When removing an injured person,
do not pull his/her limbs, never bend
his/her head and, as far as possible,
keep his/her body in a horizontal
position.
Emergency Kit (for
versions/markets where
provided)
The Emergency Kit provides first aid in
case of a car breakdown or any other
situation. The kit comes in a case on
the left side of the trunk.
The kit includes the following
elements:
6
• emergency triangle;
• reflective emergency vest;
• luminescent pipes providing chemical
lights;
• dynamo torch;
• First Aid Kit;
• gloves;
• ice scraper;
• box with spare lamps and fuses.
NOTE:
• The items inside the kit could change
according to different countries'
regulations.
• Upon request, a potassium-based fire
suppressor same size and weight as a
standard electric torch can be
included. It ensures an higher
effectiveness compared with
conventional 10–kilo (22 lb) fire
extinguishers and preventing
damage to hides and rugs.
Engine Overheating
First Aid Kit
There are steps that you can take to
slow down an impending overheat
condition:
For versions/markets, where provided,
a first aid kit is available in the trunk.
This kit contains following:
• sterile gauze to cover and clean the
wounds;
• bandages of various sizes;
• treated adhesive bandages of various
sizes;
• an adhesive bandage strip;
• a pair of rounded-end scissors;
• gloves;
• rescue blanket.
To reduce potentially overheating of
the engine in city traffic, while
stationary, place the transmission in N
(Neutral), but do not increase the
engine idle speed.
NOTE:
• If your air conditioner (A/C) is on,
turn it off. The A/C system adds heat
to the engine cooling system and
turning the A/C off can help remove
this heat.
• You can also turn the temperature
control to maximum heat, the mode
control to floor and the blower
control to high. This allows the
heater core to act as a supplement to
the radiator and aids in removing
heat from the engine cooling system.
CAUTION!
Driving with a hot cooling system
could damage your vehicle. If the
temperature gage reads “H” (refer to
“Instrument Cluster” in section 4), pull
(Continued)
238
In an Emergency
(Continued)
over and stop the vehicle. Idle the
vehicle with the air conditioner turned
off until the temperature gage drops
back into the normal range. If the
temperature gage remains on the
“H,” turn the engine off immediately
and contact the Authorized Maserati
Dealer.
WARNING!
You or others can be badly burned by
hot engine coolant (antifreeze) or
steam from your radiator. If you see
or hear steam coming from under the
engine lid, do not open it until the
radiator has had time to cool.
Never try to open a coolant pressure
cap (refer to “Maintenance
Procedures” in section 7) when the
radiator is overheated.
In case of a Punctured Tire
The vehicle is equipped with a
compact spare wheel.
Using the Compact Spare
Wheel
The compact spare wheel is stored in
the trunk and is supplied deflated in
order to limit the amount of space
occupied. An electric compressor is
also provided for inflating. In the
event of a tire puncture, proceed as
follows.
• Stop the vehicle in a place that does
not constitute a danger to traffic
and where the wheel can be
changed safely. The vehicle must be
level and on firm ground.
• Select the P (Park) mode and then
engage manually the electric
parking brake and move the ignition
switch to OFF position.
• If necessary, turn the hazard warning
flashers on and place the warning
triangle at the required distance.
WARNING!
• The jack should be used on level
firm ground wherever possible.
• It is recommended that the wheels
of the vehicle be chocked, and that
no person should remain in a vehicle
that is being jacked.
• If the vehicle has been stopped on a
slope or an uneven surface, place
chocks or other suitable items in
front of or behind the wheels to
stop the vehicle from moving.
• Never start or run the engine with
the vehicle on a jack.
• No person should place any portion
of their body under a vehicle that is
supported by a jack.
• Lift the ground coverage of the
trunk.
• Remove the tool kit.
6
• Take the tools for changing the
wheel from the container.
239
In an Emergency
• a telescopic wrench with rubber
coated handle for unscrewing/
tightening the wheel bolts;
• an adapter to be fitted to the
wrench for the wheel nuts;
• a jack.
• Unscrew and pull out the locking
wheel knob.
6
• Take the container and the compact
spare wheel out of the trunk.
Container inserted in the compact
spare wheel contains:
• an electric compressor, complete
with pressure gage and fitting for
inflating the compact spare wheel;
240
• Lift the compressor cover and
remove the hose with the pressure
gage and the cable with a plug for
the power outlet.
• Unscrew the valve cap of the
compact spare wheel and screw the
fitting of the inflation hose onto the
valve.
• Insert the plug in one of the
available power outlets fitted in the
trunk or cabin.
• Turn the compressor on by pressing
the switch.
• Stop the compressor pressing switch
again, when the pressure indicated
by the gage reaches the
recommended level (see “Tire
Inflation Pressure” in section 8) and
screw the cap on the compact spare
wheel valve.
CAUTION!
• In order to obtain a more accurate
reading, the compressor should be
switched off when checking the tire
pressure of the compact spare wheel
on the pressure gage.
• Do not run the compressor for more
than 20 minutes: there is a risk it
could overheat. Also, prolonged
power absorption may discharge the
battery, subsequently preventing the
engine from starting.
• The compressor has been designed
exclusively to inflate compact spare
wheels; do not use it to inflate air
mattresses, dinghies etc.
In an Emergency
• Fit the adapter on the wrench.
Extend the wrench as shown, then
loosen by approximately one turn,
the five bolts on the wheel to be
changed.
• Place the jack near the wheel to be
changed as illustrated.
• Make sure that the head of the jack
is correctly inserted in one of the
slots beneath the sole bar.
• Completely unscrew the five bolts
and remove the wheel. In case a
“Wheel Security Stud Bolt” is
installed, it can only be removed by
using the specific fitting wrench
provided with “Wheel Security Stud
Bolt Kit”, available in the Genuine
Accessories range.
• Fit the compact spare wheel with the
valve stem facing outward, securing
it with the five bolts previously
removed.
• Turn the lever of the jack to lower
the vehicle and remove the jack.
• Fully tighten the bolts, alternately
tightening diametrically opposite.
6
WARNING!
The lifted vehicle may fall and
damage the vehicle's body if the jack
is not positioned correctly.
• Turn the jack lever until the wheel is
raised a few centimeters off the
ground.
241
In an Emergency
will be compromised. Avoid
accelerating to full speed, heavy
braking and fast cornering.
• Fully tighten the bolts, alternately
tightening diametrically opposite.
• The compact spare wheel must be
inflated to the recommended tire
pressure (see “Tire Inflation
Pressure” in section 8).
• For safety reasons, it is absolutely
forbidden to drive with more than
one compact spare wheel fitted on
the vehicle.
WARNING!
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle
off the jack, do not tighten the wheel
bolts fully until the vehicle has been
lowered. Failure to follow this
warning may result in personal injury.
6
WARNING!
• The spare wheel is narrower than
standard wheels and must only be
used to travel the distance required
to reach a service station, where the
punctured tire can be repaired or
replaced.
• Do not exceed a maximum speed of
50 mph (80 km/h) when using the
compact spare wheel; when this
limit is exceeded, the stability, road
holding and braking of the vehicle
242
• Snow chains cannot be fitted on the
compact spare wheel.
• The spare wheel can travel a
maximum of 1,800 mi (3,000 km).
To Refit the Standard Wheel with
Repaired or Replaced Tire
• Following the procedure and the
caution described above, raise the
vehicle and remove the compact
spare wheel reusing the supplied
wrench with adapter, suitably
extended.
• Fit the standard wheel with the
repaired or replaced tire.
• Tighten the original bolts on the
wheel.
• Lower the vehicle and remove the
jack.
WARNING!
Observe the tightening torque for the
bolts securing the wheels (72.3 ±
7 lb/ft / 98 ± 10 Nm). This is equivalent
to a load of approximately 44 lb
(20 kg) being placed on the handle of
the wrench supplied when extended
for use.
Once finished:
• completely deflate the compact
spare wheel by pressing on the valve
with the overhang of the valve cap;
• place the compact spare wheel and
tool container in the trunk;
• fix everything in place with the
locking knob;
In an Emergency
Emergency Release of the
Parking Brake
In the event the electric parking brake
locks due to a total system failure (see
“Parking Brake” in section 5), you
need to release the parking brake by
following one of the two following
procedures in order to operate the
vehicle.
• place the compressor, the jack, the
wrench and the adapter in the
container inside the compact spare
wheel;
Manual Release
• Lift the flap of the floor covering as
indicated.
To manually release the parking brake,
it is necessary to use the special tool
provided with the toolkit placed in the
trunk (see “Tool Kit” in this section).
6
• reposition the tool kit;
• lower the ground coverage at the
bottom of the trunk.
• Remove the underneath
sound-absorbing layer, leveraging
the two side grips.
To release the brake manually, open
the trunk lid (see “To enter the Trunk”
in section 2) and proceed as follows:
• Lift the front edge of the boot
carpet releasing the two buttons
indicated and fold it back.
243
In an Emergency
Release after Battery
Disconnection
The following maneuver does not
allow the full release of the parking
brake but still allows for the vehicle to
move, as e.g. to load it on rescue
vehicles.
• Remove the rubber inspection cover
by pulling its tab in order to locate
the actuator that controls the lock
and unlock system of the parking
brake.
• Insert the hex tip of the flexible part
of the special tool, inside the
disclosed section.
• Turn the handle of the special tool
clockwise until release.
6
• Remove the protective cap by
unscrew it counterclockwise using
the hexagonal socket end of the
special tool.
244
• Remove the special tool from its seat
and seal with the cap.
• Reassemble all parts removed for this
operation.
• Within 3 minutes after power off
(ignition device OFF), reconnect the
battery.
• Turn the ignition switch in RUN
position.
• Press the brake pedal by
simultaneously raising the EPB
control for 5 seconds: the brake
cables will loosen enabling the
vehicle to be moved.
WARNING!
After each emergency release, the
warning light and related
break-down message will light up and
display on the instrument cluster. The
electric parking brake system remains
inefficient and must be repaired by
the Authorized Maserati Dealer to
resume operation.
In an Emergency
Transmission Manual
Release of P (Park)
Position
The manual disengagement of the
shift from P (Park) has the purpose to
allow pushing or towing the vehicle if
not normally possible using the shift
lever (such as inability to start the
engine).
The current device is exclusively
intended for emergency situations.
WARNING!
Always secure your vehicle by fully
applying the parking brake, before
activating the manual park release.
Activating the manual park release
will allow your vehicle to roll away if
it is not secured by the parking brake.
Activating the manual park release on
an unsecured vehicle could lead to
serious injury or death for those in or
around the vehicle.
The lace that allows the emergency
manual park release is located on the
left part of the driver’s foot well.
• Lift the mat on the driver side to
access the lace.
Freeing the Stuck Vehicle
• Slip the lace from its seat.
• With the tip of a screwdriver press
the clip shown in the picture box
and lift the lace up to release the
transmission from the P (Park)
position. The new position will allow
vehicle towing.
• Release the parking brake only when
the vehicle is securely connected to a
tow vehicle.
If your vehicle is stuck in mud, sand, or
snow, it can probably be moved by a
simple rocking motion.
Steer the wheel right and left to clear
the area around the front wheels.
Shift then between D (Drive) or M
(Manual) and R (Reverse) (see chapter
“Automatic Transmission” in section
5). Shifting to M (Manual), try to free
the car starting in second gear. At low
speed motion of the vehicle, you can
switch quickly from D (Drive) to R
(Reverse), and vice versa, just by
pressing the release button on the
shift lever.
For more effectiveness press lightly on
the accelerator pedal in order to avoid
driving wheel slippage.
If unable to release the vehicle in one
of the previously described ways,
enter the low grip driving mode, by
pressing the I C E, and completely
exclude the yaw and slip control
system, by pressing the button for 2
seconds. Moving the shift lever
between D (Drive) and R (Reverse) to
start.
6
Notes for AWD vehicle models
On these vehicles slippage produced
by low grip conditions, automatically
activates the AWD mode. Using the
245
In an Emergency
drive mode M (Manual), the insertion
of AWD will happen immediately
when engaging a forward gear.
CAUTION!
Racing the engine or spinning the
drive wheels may lead to transmission
overheating and failure. Allow the
engine to idle with the shift lever in N
(Neutral) for at least one minute after
every five rocking-motion cycles. This
will minimize overheating and reduce
the risk of transmission failure during
prolonged efforts to free a stuck
vehicle.
6
WARNING!
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous.
Forces generated by excessive drive
wheel speeds may cause damage, or
even failure, of the drivetrain and
tires. A tire could explode and injure
someone. Do not spin your vehicle's
wheels continuously without stopping
when you are stuck and do not let
anyone near a spinning wheel, no
matter what the speed.
Auxiliary Jump-Start
Procedure
If your vehicle has a discharged battery
it can be jump-started using a set of
jumper cables and a battery of another
vehicle or by using a portable battery
booster. It is necessary to have proper
jumper cables in order to connect the
booster battery to the remote posts of
the discharged battery. Booster cables
have usually positive and negative
terminal clamps and are identified by a
different from the sheath color (red =
positive, black = negative). Maserati
provides on request jumper cables
created for its models and content in a
pratical case.
NOTE:
The Authorized Maserati Dealer can
provide you with information about
the “Maserati Jumper Cables Kit”,
available in the Genuine Accessories
range.
Jump-starting can be dangerous if
done improperly so please follow the
procedures in this section carefully.
NOTE:
When using a portable battery booster
pack, follow the battery
manufacturer’s operating instructions
and precautions.
CAUTION!
• To jump start a vehicle do not use a
portable battery booster pack or any
other booster source with a system
voltage greater than 12 Volts or
damage to the battery, starter motor,
alternator or electrical system of the
vehicle with the dead battery may
occur.
• Do not use a battery charger for
emergency starting under any
circumstances. You could damage the
electronic systems, particularly the
control units managing the ignition
and fuel supply functions.
WARNING!
• Do not attempt jump-starting if the
discharged battery is frozen. It could
rupture or explode during jump start
and cause personal injury.
(Continued)
246
In an Emergency
(Continued)
• Do not carry out this procedure if
you have not done it before:
incorrect maneuvers can originate
high electrical discharges and even
cause the battery to explode.
• To avoid the risk of explosion or fire,
do not approach the battery with
open flames or cigarettes that could
generate sparks.
NOTE:
If you need to disconnect the battery
from the vehicle electrical system, see
“Maintenance – Free Battery” in
section 7).
Battery Remote Posts Position
Jump-Start Procedure
For easier operation, remote battery
posts for jumpstarting are located in
the engine compartment while the
battery is stored in the trunk.
Open the engine lid (see “Open and
Close the Engine Lid” in section 2) the
positive remote post (+) and the
negative remote post (-) are easily
recognizable by the icons labeled on
the integrated power module.
WARNING!
• Stay clear of the radiator cooling fan
whenever the engine lid is raised. It
can start anytime the ignition switch
is on. You can be injured by the
moving fan blades.
• Remove any metal jewelry such as
watch bands or bracelets that might
make an inadvertent electrical
contact. You could be seriously
injured.
• Do not allow the vehicles involved
in the jumpstarting operation to
touch each other as this could
establish a ground connection and
cause personal injury.
6
• Turn off the heater, radio, and all
unnecessary electrical accessories.
• Set the parking brake, shift the
automatic transmission into P (Park)
and turn the ignition to OFF.
• If using another vehicle to jumpstart
the battery, park the vehicle within
the jumper cables reach and set the
parking brake and make sure the
ignition is OFF.
247
In an Emergency
• Disconnect the terminal clamp of the
positive jumper cable from the
remote positive (+) post of the
discharged vehicle.
• Connect one terminal clamp of the
positive jumper cable to the positive
(+) remote post of the discharged
vehicle after lifting the protection
cap of the cable indicated on the
external side of the integrated
power module.
6
248
• Connect the opposite terminal clamp
of the positive (+) jumper cable to
the positive (+) post of the booster
battery.
• Connect one terminal clamp of the
negative jumper cable to the
negative (-) post of the booster
battery.
• Connect the opposite terminal clamp
of the negative (-) jumper cable to
the remote negative (-) post of the
vehicle with the discharged battery
as rendered.
NOTE:
• Start the engine in the vehicle that
has the booster battery, let the
engine idle a few minutes, and then
start the engine in the vehicle with
the discharged battery. If using a
portable battery booster, wait a few
seconds after connecting the cables,
before starting the booster vehicle.
Once the engine is started, remove the
jumper cables in the reverse sequence.
• Disconnect one terminal clamp of the
negative (-) jumper cable from the
remote negative (-) post of the
vehicle with the discharged battery.
• Disconnect the opposite terminal
clamp of the negative jumper cable
from the negative (-) post of the
booster battery.
• Disconnect one terminal clamp of the
positive (+) jumper cable from the
positive (+) post of the booster
battery.
If frequent jump-starting is required to
start your vehicle you should have the
battery and charging system inspected
at an Authorized Maserati Dealer
center.
In an Emergency
Towing a Disabled Vehicle
Proper towing or lifting equipment is
required to prevent damage to your
vehicle. Use only towing bars and
other equipment designed for the
purpose, following equipment
manufacturer’s instructions.
Safety chains are mandatory.
Securely attach a towing bar or other
towing device to main structural
members of the vehicle, not to
bumpers or associated brackets.
Make sure you comply with local
towing regulations.
• If the vehicle's battery is discharged,
refer to the following paragraph on
how to shift the automatic
transmission out of the P (Park)
position and release the parking
brake.
• If the vehicle battery is still charged,
turn off the engine and disengage
the parking brake manually (if
automatically engaged) by using the
command behind the shift lever (see
“Parking Brake” chapter in section
5). Shift then manually the
transmission out of P (Park) as
described in “Transmission Manual
Release of P (Park) Position” chapter
of this section. If you need to use the
accessories (wipers, defrosters, etc.)
while being towed, the ignition
must be in RUN position, do not use
the ACC position.
CAUTION!
Your vehicle is equipped with tow
eyes, which are mounted in the front
and the rear. Tow eyes are for
emergency use only, for example to
rescue a vehicle stranded off road. Do
not use tow eyes for tow truck
hookup as you could damage your
vehicle.
Manual Release of
Transmission and Parking
Brake
In order to push or tow the vehicle if
unable to shift the transmission out of
P (Park) (such as a discharged battery),
a manual park release is available. In
this case it is necessary to manually
release the shift lever and the parking
brake by applying the emergency
procedure (see “Parking Brake” in
section 5).
Follow the steps as indicated in
“Transmission Manual Release of P
(Park) Position” in this section to
manually disengage the transmission.
Vehicle Towing Conditions
Maserati does not recommend that
you tow this vehicle on a tow dolly as
vehicle damage may occur. Instead, it
is recommended to tow your vehicle
with all four wheels off the ground
using a flatbed.
If flatbed equipment is not available,
and the transmission is still operable, a
RWD vehicle may be flat towed (with
all four wheels on the ground) under
the following conditions.
• The shift lever must be in N
(Neutral).
• The distance to be traveled must not
exceed 30 mi (50 km).
• The towing speed must not exceed
30 mph (50 km/h).
6
CAUTION!
AWD vehicle can be towed with both
axles on the ground without
limitations, single axle towing is
forbidden as can seriously damage
torque driver of AWD system.
If the transmission is not operable, or
the RWD vehicle must be towed faster
than 30 mph (50 km/h) or farther than
30 mi (50 km) (for example on a
highway), tow with the rear driving
249
In an Emergency
wheels off the ground and on a
platform of a rescue vehicle, or with
the rear wheels raised using a wheel
lift.
CAUTION!
If you have to tow the RWD vehicle
with 2 wheels raised, ensure that the
ignition switch is in the OFF position. If
this is not observed, when the ESC is
active, the ECU will store a
malfunction and the relative warning
light will illuminate on the
instrument cluster display. This
requires the intervention of the
Authorized Maserati Dealer to reset
the system.
6
250
Use tow hook of the tool kit
The tow hook is contained in the tool
kit (see “Tool Kit” in this section) and
must be screwed in its seat accessible
behind the front grille, right-hand
side.
Carefully clean the threaded seat
before tightening the hook.
Screw the tow hook into its seat for
approximately 11 turns.
NOTE:
Maximum work angle of towing cable:
15°.
7 – Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Scheduled Service Plan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Maintenance Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Maintenance-Free Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267
Fuse Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
A/C System Maintenance . . . . . . .
Wheels Maintenance . . . . . . . . . .
Bodywork Maintenance and Care
Interior Maintenance and Care . .
Vehicle Stored for Long Periods . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
278
279
281
283
284
Battery Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
251
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance
Service
Correct maintenance is clearly the best
way to ensure vehicle performance
and safety features, ensure respect for
the environment and low operating
costs.
NOTE:
Also remember that the strict
observance of the maintenance
procedures is essential for keeping
your vehicle operating properly. Not
adhering to the Maintenance Schedule
can impact your vehicle’s warranty.
7
Maserati has therefore provided for a
series of checks and maintenance
operations involving the 1st service
when the vehicle mileage reaches
12,500 mi (20,000 km) or after 1 year
of the vehicle's life, and subsequently
every 12,500 mi (20,000 km) or every
year.
After the 6th Maintenance
Service
After the 6th service, maintenance
must be restarted with the operations
scheduled for the 1st, 2nd and 3rd
service.
252
CAUTION!
The Scheduled Maintenance services
are prescribed by the Maserati. Failure
to have the services carried out may
affect your warranty.
The Scheduled Maintenance service is
provided by the Authorized Maserati
Dealer. If further replacements or repairs
are found to be necessary when a service
is performed in addition to the scheduled
operations, these can be carried out only
with the specific consent of the Customer.
CAUTION!
You are advised to notify the
Authorized Maserati Dealer of any
minor operating problem, without
waiting for the next scheduled service.
The oil change indicator system will
remind you of the deadline for the
maintenance program.
The indicator light
on the
Instrument cluster flashes for
approximately 10 seconds displaying
the “Oil Change Due” message backed
by a beeping sound, indicating that an
oil change is necessary.
The oil change indicator message will
illuminate at approximately 11,900 mi
(19,200 km) after the last oil change
was performed.
Have your vehicle serviced as soon as
possible, within 500 mi (800 km).
NOTE:
• The oil change indicator message will
not monitor the time (only mileage)
elapsed from the last oil change.
Change your vehicles oil if it has
been 1 year since your last oil
change, even if the oil change
indicator message will NOT display
on the instrument cluster.
• Change your engine oil more often if
you drive your vehicle off-road for an
extended period of time or short
trips without reaching operation
temperature.
• Under no circumstances should oil
change intervals exceed 12,500 mi
(20,000 km) or at least after 1 year.
The Authorized Maserati Dealer will
reset the oil change indicator message
after completing the scheduled oil
change.
CAUTION!
Failure to perform the required
maintenance items may result in
damage to the vehicle.
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Service Plan
The Scheduled Maintenance services
listed in this manual must be done at
the times or mileages specified to
protect your vehicle warranty and
ensure the best vehicle performance
and reliability.
at your selling dealer. The technicians
at your dealership know your vehicle
best, and have access to factoryapproved information, genuine
Maserati parts, and specially designed
electronic and mechanical tools that
can help prevent future costly repairs.
More frequent maintenance may be
needed for vehicles in severe
operating conditions, such as dusty
areas and very short trip driving.
Inspection and service should also be
done anytime a malfunction is
suspected.
Maserati recommends that these
maintenance intervals be performed
Service coupons
Main operations
Belt for alternator, water pump, air conditioning compressor
and hydraulic steering pump
Engine oil and filter
1°
2°
3°
4°
5°
6°
Interval running coupons: every 12,500 mi (20,000 km)
or 1 year
I
R
I
Replace at least every 50,000 mi (80,000 km) or 4 years
and every time the part is removed
R
R
R
R
R
R
Replace at least every year
Cooling system connections and lines (check for leaks)
I
Air filter
R
Spark plugs
R
R
Hydraulic steering fluid level (bleed if necessary)
I
I
I
Engine coolant level
I
I
I
Intercooler check for leaks
I
I
I
I
I
7
I
Brake fluid level
I
R
I
Brake system: lines, calipers, connections - Efficiency of the
dashboard warning lights - Handbrake operation
I
I
I
Wear condition of the braking parts (discs, pads)
I
I
I
253
Maintenance and Care
Service coupons
Main operations
1°
2°
3°
R
Controls and adjustment systems in general, hinges, doors,
front and rear lid
I
Headlight aiming
I
R
254
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Vehicle road test
7
6°
I
Condition of the leather interiors
I = Inspect and carry out any other necessary operation
R = Replace
5°
Interval running coupons: every 12,500 mi (20,000 km)
or 1 year
Pollen filter
Check with Maserati Diagnosis
4°
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Maintenance and Care
Periodic Maintenance
Every 600 mi (1,000 km) or before
long journeys
Check:
• engine coolant;
• brake fluid;
• windshield washer fluid level;
• tire inflation pressure and condition;
• operation of lighting system
(headlights, direction indicators,
hazard warning flashers, etc.);
• operation of windshield
washer/wiper system and wear of
windshield wiper blades.
Every 1,900 mi (3,000 km)
Check and top off, if required, the
engine oil level.
Heavy-Duty Vehicle Use
If the car is mainly used under one of
the following conditions:
• off-roads;
• short, repeated journeys (less than
4–5 mi / 7-8 km) at sub-zero outside
temperatures;
• engine often idling or driving long
distances at low speeds or long
periods of idleness.
You should perform the following
inspections more frequently than
recommended on the “Scheduled
Service Plan”:
On Board Diagnostic System —
OBD II
• check front disc brake pad
conditions and wear;
• check cleanliness of hood and trunk
locks, cleanliness and lubrication of
linkage;
• visually inspect conditions of:
engine, transmission, pipes and
hoses (exhaust - fuel system - brakes)
and rubber elements (boots - sleeves
- bushes - etc.);
• check battery charge;
• visually inspect condition of the
accessory drive belts;
• check and, if necessary, change
engine oil and replace oil filter;
• check and, if necessary, replace
pollen filter of the A/C system;
• check and, if necessary, replace air
cleaner filter.
This vehicle is equipped with a
sophisticated onboard diagnostic
system called OBD II. This system
monitors the performance of the
emissions, engine, and automatic
transmission control systems. When
these systems are operating properly,
your vehicle will provide excellent
performance and fuel economy, as
well as engine emissions suited to
current government regulations.
If any of these systems require service,
the OBD II system will turn on the
“Malfunction Indicator Light”
on
the instrument cluster display (refer to
“Instrument Cluster” in section 4). The
system stores as well diagnostic codes
and other information to assist your
service technician by performing
repairs.
Although the vehicle will be drivable
and will not need towing, contact an
Authorized Maserati Dealer for service
as soon as possible.
CAUTION!
All maintenance operations for the
vehicle must be carried out by an
Authorized Maserati Dealer. Do not
carry any operation on your own and
contact an Authorized Maserati
Dealer.
7
255
Maintenance and Care
CAUTION!
on
• Prolonged driving with the
could cause further damage to the
emissions control system. It could
also affect fuel economy and
driveability. The vehicle must be
serviced before any emissions tests
can be performed.
• If the
is flashing while the
engine is running, severe catalytic
converter damage and power loss
will soon occur. Immediate service at
an Authorized Maserati Dealer is
required.
Emissions Inspection and
Maintenance Programs
7
256
In some localities, it may be a legal
requirement to pass an inspection of
your vehicle's emissions control system.
Failure to pass could prevent vehicle
registration. For states that require an
Inspection and Maintenance (I/M), this
check verifies the
“Malfunction
Indicator Light (MIL)” is functioning
and is not on when the engine is
running, and that the OBD II system is
ready for testing.
Normally, the OBD II system will be
ready. The OBD II system may not be
ready if your vehicle was recently
serviced, recently had a dead battery
or a battery replacement. If the OBD II
system should be determined not
ready for the I/M test, your vehicle may
fail the test.
To check if your vehicle's OBD II system
is ready, you must do the following:
1. Press the ignition device to the
RUN position, but do not crank or
start the engine.
2. As soon as you press the ignition
device to turn the engine On, you
will see the MIL remain
illuminated for 15 seconds, this is a
normal bulb check.
3. Approximately 15 seconds later,
one of two things will happen:
• The MIL will remain illuminated
and a message error will appear
on your instrument cluster. This
means that your vehicle's OBD II
system is not ready and you
should not proceed to the I/M
station.
• The MIL will turn Off. This
means that your vehicle's OBD II
system is ready and you can
proceed to the I/M station.
If your OBD II system is not ready, you
should see an Authorized Maserati
Dealer or repair facility. If your vehicle
was recently serviced or had a battery
failure or replacement, you may need
to do nothing more than drive your
vehicle as you normally would in order
for your OBD II system to update. A
recheck with the above test routine
may then indicate that the system is
now ready.
Regardless of whether your vehicle's
OBD II system is ready or not, if the
MIL is illuminated during normal
vehicle operation you should have
your vehicle serviced before going to
the I/M station. The I/M station can fail
your vehicle because the MIL is on with
the engine running.
Spare Parts
Use of genuine parts for normal/
scheduled maintenance and repairs is
highly recommended to ensure
excellent performance.
Damage or failures caused by
non-genuine spare parts used for
maintenance and repairs will not be
covered by the manufacturer's
warranty.
Maintenance and Care
Dealer Service
The Authorized Maserati Dealer has
the qualified service personnel, special
tools, and equipment to perform all
service operations in an expert
manner. Service Manuals are available
which include detailed service
information for your vehicle. Refer to
these Service Manuals before
attempting any procedure yourself.
Intentional tampering with emissions
control systems may void your
warranty and could result in civil
penalties being assessed against you.
Maintenance Procedures
The following pages contain the
“required” maintenance standards
determined by Maserati engineers.
Besides those maintenance items
specified in the “Scheduled Service
Plan”, there are other components
which may require service or
replacement in the future.
To perform most of the services, it is
necessary to open the engine lid (see
“Open and Close the Engine Lid” in
section 2).
chemicals can damage your engine,
transmission, power steering or air
conditioning. Such damages are not
covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty. If a flush is needed
because of component malfunction,
use only the specified fluid for the
flushing procedure.
CAUTION!
WARNING!
You can be badly injured working on
or around a motor vehicle. Take your
vehicle to an Authorized Maserati
Dealer.
• Failure to properly maintain your
vehicle or perform repairs and
service when necessary could result
in more costly repairs, damage to
other components or negatively
impact vehicle performance.
Immediately have potential
malfunctions examined by the
Authorized Maserati Dealer or a
qualified repair center.
• Your vehicle has been equipped with
improved fluids that protect the
performance and durability of your
vehicle and also allow extended
maintenance intervals. Do not use
chemical flushes for washing as the
7
257
Maintenance and Care
The images below show the position
of all components involved in the
maintenance service.
V8 Engine
1
Inspection cover to access the
engine oil level dipstick.
2
Engine oil filler neck.
3
Power steering fluid reservoir.
4
Engine coolant reservoir.
5
Coolant reservoir for
transmission and hydraulic
steering system.
6
Washer fluid reservoir.
7
Brake fluid reservoir access
cover.
8
A/C pollen filter access cover.
9
Integrated power module
(fuses).
10
Air cleaner filters.
7
V8 Engine
258
Maintenance and Care
V6 Engine
1
Engine oil level dipstick.
2
Engine oil filler neck.
3
Power steering fluid reservoir.
4
Engine coolant reservoir.
5
Coolant reservoir for
transmission and hydraulic
steering system.
6
Washer fluid reservoir.
7
Brake fluid reservoir access
cover.
8
A/C pollen filter access cover.
9
Integrated power module
(fuses).
10
Air cleaner filters.
7
V6 Engine
259
Maintenance and Care
Level Checks
ENVIRONMENTAL!
• The engine oils and fluids used
contain substances that are
dangerous for the environment. For
replacement you are advised to
contact the Authorized Maserati
Dealer, where all the necessary
equipment is available to dispose of
the used oil and fluids in compliance
with the regulations in force and in
an environment-friendly manner.
• All equipment used for fluids
replacement (gloves, cloths,
containers, etc) must be disposed in
compliance with the regulations in
force.
Engine Coolant Level Check
7
260
Your vehicle has been equipped with
an improved engine coolant
(antifreeze) that offers high protection
against corrosion, freezing and allows
extended maintenance intervals. To
prevent reducing extended
maintenance periods, it is important to
use original engine coolant
(antifreeze) when adding coolant
throughout the life of your vehicle.
When adding engine coolant
(antifreeze) use pure water only such
as distilled or deionized water when
mixing the water/engine coolant
(antifreeze) solution. The use of
impure water will reduce the amount
of corrosion protection in the engine
cooling system.
• Mix a minimum solution of 50%
engine coolant (antifreeze) and
distilled water. Use higher
concentrations (do not exceed 70%)
if temperatures below −35°F (−37°C)
are forecast.
Please note that it is the owner's
responsibility to maintain the proper
level of protection against freezing
according to the temperatures
occurring in the circulation area of the
vehicle.
The coolant bottle provides a quick
visual method to determine that the
coolant level is adequate. As long as
the engine operating temperature is
satisfactory, the coolant bottle only
needs to be checked once a month.
With the engine off and cold, the level
of the coolant in the bottle should be
between the ranges indicated on the
bottle and inside the filler neck.
• When additional engine coolant
(antifreeze) is needed to maintain
the proper level, it should be added
to the coolant bottle after removing
the cap. Do not overfill.
• Once the desired level is reached,
firmly close cap of the bottle.
• If frequent engine coolant
(antifreeze) additions are required,
or if the level in the coolant recovery
bottle does not drop when the
Maintenance and Care
The brake pads wear could cause the
fluid level to fall. However, low fluid
level may be caused by a leak and a
requires accurate checkup of the
braking system.
engine cools, the cooling system
should be pressure tested for leaks
by an Authorized Maserati Dealer.
• Keep the front of the radiator and
the condenser clean.
WARNING!
• Never add engine coolant
(antifreeze) when the engine is
overheated. Do not loosen or
remove the cap of the engine
coolant bottle to cool an overheated
engine. Heat causes pressure to
build up in the cooling system. To
prevent scalding or injury, do not
remove the pressure cap while the
system is hot or under pressure.
• When adding coolant do not use a
pressure cap other than the one
specified for your vehicle. Personal
injury or engine damage may result.
Brake Fluid Level Check
Check the fluid level immediately if
the brake system warning light
and the related message turn
on indicating a low level of brake
fluid.
• Remove the brake fluid reservoir
access cover.
• Clean the top of the master cylinder
area before removing the cap.
• Add fluid to bring the level up to the
“MAX” mark on the side of the
master cylinder reservoir. Use only
manufacturer's recommended brake
fluid (see “Refillings” in section 8).
• Add enough fluid to bring it to the
“MAX” level marked on the brake
fluid reservoir.
• Once the correct level is reached,
firmly close the cap.
CAUTION!
The symbol
on the reservoir cap
identifies the synthetic type of brake
fluid, distinguishing it from the
mineral type. Using mineral fluids
damages the special rubber linings of
the brake system irreparably.
WARNING!
• To avoid contamination from foreign
materials or moisture, use only new
brake fluid or fluid that has been in
a tightly closed container. Keep the
master cylinder reservoir cap
secured at all times. Brake fluid in an
open container absorbs moisture
from the air resulting in a lower
boiling point. This may cause it to
boil unexpectedly during hard or
prolonged braking, resulting in
sudden brake failure. This could
result in an accident.
7
(Continued)
261
Maintenance and Care
To prevent freeze-up of your
windshield washer system in cold
weather, select a solution or mixture
that meets or exceeds the temperature
range of your climate. This rating
information can be found on most
washer fluid containers.
(Continued)
• Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir
can result in spilling brake fluid on
hot engine parts, causing the brake
fluid to catch fire. Brake fluid can
also damage painted and vinyl
surfaces, make sure it does not spill
over these surfaces.
NOTE:
• Do not allow petroleum based fluid
to contaminate the brake fluid.
Brake seal components could be
damaged, causing partial or
complete brake failure. This could
result in an accident.
The Authorized Maserati Dealer can
provide you with information about
the Maserati recommended
Windshield Washer Fluid with
antifreeze, available in the Genuine
Accessories range.
Adding Washer/Headlight Washer
Fluid
7
During scheduled services or when the
message “Low Washer Fluid” appears
together with the related telltale
add more fluid as soon as possible:
the fluid reservoir will hold nearly 4
Quarts/Litres of washer/headlight
washer fluid.
• Remove the reservoir cap in the
engine compartment and lift the
filler neck.
262
• Fill the reservoir with windshield
washer solvent (refer to “Refillings”
in section 8) and operate the system
for a few seconds to flush out the
residual water.
• When refilling the washer fluid
reservoir, apply some washer fluid to
a cloth or towel and wipe the wiper
blades clean. This will help blade
performance.
WARNING!
• Commercially available windshield
washer solvents are flammable. They
could ignite and burn you. Care must
be exercised when filling or when
working around the washer
solution.
• Do not drive with the windshield
washer fluid reservoir empty: the
action of the washer is essential for
improving visibility when driving.
Maintenance and Care
Engine Oil Level Check
To assure proper lubrication of your
vehicle's engine, the engine oil must
be maintained at the correct level.
If the
warning light illuminates
and the related message of low oil
level displays, or during scheduled
services (see “Scheduled Maintenance
Service” in this section) it is necessary
to check the engine oil level.
The best time to check the engine oil
level is about five minutes after a fully
warmed up engine is shut off or
before starting the engine after it has
sat overnight. In both cases the vehicle
should be parked on level ground to
improve the accuracy of the oil level
readings.
• Remove the dipstick and clean it
with a dry and clean cloth.
• If a refilling is necessary, unscrew the
filler neck cap.
V8 Engine
• Remove the inspection cover on the
right engine bank (V8 Engine).
V8 Engine
V6 Engine
7
• Re-insert the dipstick completely and
remove: the oil level should maintain
between the MIN e MAX reference
ranges (SAFE range).
V8 Engine
263
Maintenance and Care
pressure. This could damage your
engine.
• Do not add any supplemental
materials to the engine oil, other
than leak detection dyes. Engine oil
is an engineered product, and its
performance may be impaired by
supplemental additives.
V6 Engine
7
• Adding 1.5 Quarts / 1.4 Litres (V8
Engine), 1.1 Quarts / 1 Litre (V6
Engine) of oil when the level is at the
bottom of the SAFE range will result
in the level being at the top of the
SAFE range.
• Return the cap and dipstick to their
position and wait for a few minutes
to allow the oil to reach the oil pan.
• Check the level again.
• Refit the inspection cover (V8
Engine).
CAUTION!
• Do not top up with oil with different
characteristics than the engine in the
car (refer to “Refillings” in section 8).
• Overfilling or underfilling the sump
will cause aeration or loss of oil
264
Engine oil filter replacement
The engine oil filter should be
replaced with a new filter at every oil
change.
Contact the Authorized Maserati
Dealer to perform this service.
Automatic Transmission Oil Check
• Retighten the cap then unscrew it
again and check the level: it should
match the “MAX” notch marked on
the dipstick. In hot oil conditions, the
level may even exceed the “MAX”
notch.
Contact the Authorized Maserati
Dealer for the oil level check.
Power Steering Fluid Level Check
With the vehicle on a level ground and
the engine cold, check the fluid level
of the power steering reservoir.
• To carry out the check, unscrew the
cap, clean the dipstick with a dry and
clean cloth.
• If necessary, top up with fluid
making sure that it has the same
characteristics as the one already
used in the system (refer to
“Refillings” in section 8).
Maintenance and Care
Engine Air Filters Replacement
CAUTION!
• Make sure that the power steering
fluid does not come in touch with
the engine hot parts as it is
flammable.
• When the engine is running, do not
keep the steering wheel completely
turned for longer than 8 seconds,
unless absolutely necessary. This will
cause a noise and also the
overheating of the hydraulic
steering fluid and could damage the
hydraulic steering system.
Coolant, Transmission and Hydraulic
Steering System Fluid Level Check
Contact the Authorized Maserati
Dealer for this operation.
Contact the Authorized Maserati
Dealer to have the air filters replaced.
• Unsnap both ends and lift the filter
access cover.
A/C Air Filter Replacement
This filter performs mechanic/
electrostatic air filtering, provided
that windows and doors are perfectly
closed.
The filter is located under the engine
lid in the external A/C system air inlet,
on the passenger side of the vehicle,
next to the windshield wipers.
To replace the filter during the
scheduled maintenance services or
after the vehicle has been heavily used
on dusty roads, proceed as follows:
• Remove the access door in the cowl
screen by pressing the retaining clips
indicated.
• Remove the used filter slipping it off
from within the air intake.
• Install the new filter with arrows
pointing in the direction of airflow,
which is toward the rear of the
vehicle (text and arrows on the filter
will indicate this).
7
265
Maintenance and Care
• Close the filter access cover and
reinstall the access door.
use the “Service” position for any
intervention on the wipers blades.
Windshield Wiper Maintenance
CAUTION!
Failure to replace the filter may
considerably reduce the air
conditioning and heating system
efficiency.
Windshield Wiper Maintenance
and Blades Replacement
When the wiper arms are in “Park”
position it is not possible to check or
replace the blades as they remain
under the engine hood. To service the
blades it is necessary to move the
wiper arms in “Service” position (see
chapter “Windshield Wipers and
Washers” in section 3). In this way it is
possible to turn and lift the arms for
the desired intervention.
7
WARNING!
It is dangerous to operate or service
the wiper blades with the wipers in an
active position (different than “OFF”)
and with the ignition switch in the
RUN position. The rain sensors may
suddenly activate the wipers. Always
266
Life expectancy of wiper blades varies
depending on the geographical area’s
weather conditions where the car is
used and frequency of use. Poor
performance of blades may be present
with chattering, marks, water lines or
wet spots. If any of these conditions
are present, clean the wiper blades or
replace if necessary.
Clean the rubber edges of the wiper
blades and the windshield periodically
with a sponge or soft cloth and a mild
nonabrasive cleaner. This will remove
accumulations of salt or road film.
Operation of the wipers on dry glass
for long periods may cause
deterioration of the wiper blades.
Always use washer fluid when using
the wipers to remove salt or dirt from
a dry windshield.
Avoid using the wiper blades to
remove frost or ice from the
windshield. Keep the blade rubber out
of contact with petroleum products
such as engine oil, gasoline, etc.
Spray nozzles
If the jet does not work, first check
that there is fluid in the pan (see
paragraph “Level checks” in this
section) then check that the nozzles
are not clogged.
Blades Replacement
• Move the wiper arms into “Service”
position, (see chapter “Windshield
Wipers and Washers” in section 3)
and lift them.
• Press the indicated button, slip off
the blade support from the arm and
replace it.
• Return the blade to its original
position on the windshield.
• Turn the multifunction lever to one
of the automatic settings (see
chapter “Windshield Wipers and
Washers” in section 3) and move the
ignition switch to the RUN position:
the wiper arms will return to the
resting position.
Maintenance and Care
Maintenance-Free Battery
NOTE:
Due to the difficulty of this operation,
we recommend that you contact the
Authorized Maserati Dealer for
replacement of the blades.
Body Lubrication
Locks and all body pivot points,
including such items as seat tracks,
door hinge pivot points and rollers,
liftgate, tailgate, sliding doors and
hood hinges, should be lubricated
periodically with a lithium based
grease, to assure quite, easy operation
and to protect against rust and wear.
Prior to the application of any
lubricant, the parts concerned should
be wiped clean to remove dust and
grit; after lubricating excess oil and
grease should be removed. Particular
attention should also be given to
hood latching components to ensure
proper function. When performing
other underhood services, the hood
latch, release mechanism and safety
catch should be cleaned and
lubricated. The external lock cylinders
of the front doors should be
lubricated twice a year, preferably in
the Fall and Spring. Apply a small
amount of high quality lubricant
directly into the lock cylinder.
WARNING!
CALIFORNIA proposition 65.
Engine exhaust, some of its
constituents, and certain vehicle
components contain or emit chemicals
known to the state of California to
cause cancer, and birth defects or
other reproductive harm. In addition,
certain fluids contained in vehicles
and certain products of component
wear contain or emit chemicals
known to the State of California to
cause cancer, and birth defects or
other reproductive harm.
This vehicle is equipped with a sealed
type maintenance-free battery. You
will never have to add water, nor is
periodic maintenance required.
WARNING!
• Battery fluid is a corrosive acid
solution and can burn or damage the
eyes. Do not allow battery fluid to
contact your eyes, skin, or clothing. Do
not lean with the face over a battery.
If acid splashes in eyes or on skin,
flush the area immediately with large
amounts of water.
• Battery gas is flammable and
explosive. Keep flame or sparks
away from the battery. Do not use a
booster battery or any other booster
source with an output greater than
12 Volts. Do not allow cable clamps
to touch each other.
7
• Battery posts, terminals, and related
accessories contain lead and lead
compounds. Wash hands after
handling the battery.
• The battery in this vehicle has a vent
hose that should not be
disconnected and should only be
(Continued)
267
Maintenance and Care
positive (+) and negative (-) and are
identified on the battery case.
(Continued)
replaced with a component of the
same type (vented).
NOTE:
Remote battery terminals for start are
located in the engine compartment for
jump starting to be used with an
auxiliary battery or a battery from
another vehicle (see “Auxiliary
Jump-Start Procedure” chapter in
section 6).
CAUTION!
To Disconnect the Battery
The battery is fitted on the inner right
side of the trunk.
To access the battery it is necessary to
lift the ground coverage of the trunk
and remove the access cover as
indicated.
7
268
• Before disconnecting the battery,
open the trunk lid and lower the
windows a few centimeters.
• Never disconnect the battery from
the electrical system when the
engine is running.
• To temporarily disconnect the vehicle
electrical system from the battery,
simply remove the cable end with
quick coupling from the negative
post (-) of the battery.
• If the battery needs to be removed
from its compartment, you must first
detach the terminal clamp to the
negative post (–) and then the other
terminal clamp to the positive post
(+), after removing the protection
cover. Battery posts are marked
NOTE:
After the battery is disconnected with
electric parking brake engaged, you
can manually move the vehicle by
performing the procedure “Release
after Battery Disconnection” in
chapter “Emergency Release of the
Parking Brake” of section 6.
Maintenance and Care
To Reconnect the Battery
NOTE:
When the battery cables have been
disconnected and the trunk has been
locked, it is necessary to pull the
emergency release lever in order to
re-open it. To access the trunk and
operate the emergency release fold the
rear seatback (see “Cargo Area” chapter
in section 3).
CAUTION!
• It is essential when replacing the
cables on the battery that the
positive cable is precisely attached to
the positive post (+) and the
negative cable is attached to the
negative post (–).
• Cable clamps should be tight on the
terminal posts and free of corrosion.
After the battery has been
disconnected and re-connected and
before starting the engine it is
necessary to proceed as follows:
• Unlock the trunk lid with the key fob
RKE transmitter and then lock it
manually.
• Initialize the climate control system
by activating the compressor (see
chapter "Air Conditioning Controls"
in section 4).
• Turn on the MTC and set the date
and time following the MTC
instructions manual.
• Lift, release and lift again the lever
located behind the shift lever to
inizialize the electric parking brake.
In this way the
warning light
on the instrument panel will turn
off.
Useful Advice to Extend
Battery Life
When parking the vehicle, make sure
that the doors, front, rear lids and
flaps are properly closed. All interior
lights should be off. When the engine
is turned off, do not keep the
connected devices switched on for a
long time (such as radio, hazard
warning flashers, blower, etc.).
CAUTION!
If the battery charge remains below
50% for a long period of time, it will
be damaged due to sulfation; its
performance and starting power will
be reduced and it will be more subject
to freezing (this can happen even at
14°F / -10°C).
We recommend you to have the
battery charge condition checked,
preferably at the beginning of the
cold season, to prevent the electrolyte
from freezing.
This check should be carried out more
frequently if the vehicle is used mainly
for short trips or if it is equipped with
power absorbing devices that remain
permanently on even when the
ignition switch is off. This applies
above all if these devices have been
retrofitted ("Aftermarket" services).
If the vehicle is not used for long
periods of time, please see “Vehicle
Stored for Long Periods” in this
section.
7
• Unlock and lock the doors using the
Key fob RKE Transmitter.
269
Maintenance and Care
Battery Recharge
The vehicle is equipped with a IBS
(Intelligent Battery Sensor) sensor able
to measure charging and discharging
currents and to calculate the state of
charge and state of health of the
battery. This sensor is located in
correspondence of the negative post
(-) of the battery.
For a successful charge/recharge
operation, the charging current must
flow through the IBS sensor as shown
in the picture.
7
CAUTION!
• When charging the battery with an
external charger, to allow IBS to
measure charging current, the
negative terminal clamp of the
charger must NOT be connected
270
directly to the negative post of the
battery, because in this case charging
current does not flow through IBS.
• The negative terminal clamp of the
charger MUST be connected just
after IBS: in this way charging
current flows through IBS, and it can
correctly measure it.
• Do not use a “fast charger” to
provide starting voltage.
Recharge the battery slowly and at a
low amperage with a suitable charger
or use a charge maintainer device (for
further information refer to
“Maintaining Battery Charge” in
chapter “Battery Statement”).
It is possible to recharge the battery
without disconnecting the cables of
the vehicle electrical system from it.
• To access the battery lift the ground
coverage of the trunk compartment
and remove the access cover as
previously shown.
• Remove the protection cover and
connect the terminal clamp of the
charger positive cable (typically in
red) to the positive post (+) of the
battery.
• Connect the terminal clamp of the
charger negative cable (typically in
black) to the nut located by the
negative post (-) on the battery,
indicated in the picture.
• Turn the charger on and follow the
instructions on its user manual to
completely recharge the battery.
• When the battery is recharged, turn
off the battery charger before
disconnecting it from the battery.
• Disconnect first the terminal clamp
of the charger black cable from the
battery and then the terminal clamp
of the red cable.
• Reassemble the protection cover on
the battery positive post and the
access cover on the battery room.
Maintenance and Care
Fuse Replacement
Used Fuses Characteristics
When an electrical device is not
functioning, check that the
corresponding fuse is in proper
working order (intact).
A
Fuse intact
B
Fuse blown
Replace the faulty fuse with a new
one featuring the same rating, by
using appropriate forceps added in
the integrated power module and
inside the cover of the rear power
distribution center.
Type
The color identifies the value of the
fuses in amperes which is also
reported on the them.
The vehicle is endowed mainly with
mini-and maxi-fuses. In addition to
these fuses there are some special
fuses (“Circuit Breaker” or
“non-Cycling Breakers” identified with
CB in the description) on which it is
not possible to visually detect the
status of “fuse blown”. These fuses
contained in the rear power
distribution center remain tripped as
long as there’s power to the circuit.
They protect the motors that move
the seats: in case of failure of a seat,
extract the corresponding fuse and
then reinsert it. If the malfunction
persists, contact the Authorized
Maserati Dealer.
The table shows the match between
color and amperage of mini and maxi
fuses.
7
Color / Ampere
Mini Fuse
Beige - 5
Brown - 7.5
Red - 10
Blue - 15
Yellow - 20
Maxi Fuse
Yellow - 20
Green - 30
Orange - 40
Red - 50
Blue - 60
White - 25
Green - 30
271
Maintenance and Care
CAUTION!
• Never replace a blown fuse with
anything other than a new and
suitable fuse (same rating).
• After replacing a fuse, if the fault
recurs, contact the Authorized
Maserati Dealer.
7
272
Position of Fuses
Integrated Power Module
The fuses are located in two parts of
the vehicle, namely:
• To access the module it is necessary
to lift the engine lid (see “Trunk
Compartment Operation” in section
2).
• To access the fuses remove the
module cover unhooking the lateral
locks as shown in the picture.
• inside the integrated power module,
on the right hand side of the engine
compartment;
• inside the rear power distribution
center, behind the battery, on the
right hand side of the trunk.
Maintenance and Care
The table points out the position as
featured in the figure, the type and
function of the fuses included in the
integrated power module.
CAUTION!
Ref.
Type
Function
22
Maxi – 20A
RH low beam
relay input
28
Mini – 7.5A
IPC Instrument
Panel Control
33
Mini – 10A
HDLP Headlights
• After replacement, refit the
protective cover of the module.
• If you need to wash the engine
compartment, do not direct the jet
of water for too long directly on the
module.
Ref.
Type
Function
10
Mini – 15A
Electric Steering
Lock
11
Mini – 20A
Horn relay input
12
Mini – 10A
AC compressor
relay input
14
Mini – 7.5A Alarm siren
19
Headlamp
Maxi – 30A washer relay
input
20
Maxi – 30A
Wiper motor
relay output
21
Maxi – 20A
LH low beam
relay input
7
273
Maintenance and Care
Rear Power Distribution Center
• To access the center it is necessary to
lift the ground coverage of the trunk
and remove the access cover (refer
“Maintenance-Free Battery” in this
section).
• To access the fuses unhooking the
cover lock shown in picture.
• Lift the lid on the side of the latch and
push it toward the right side to release
the latches as indicated on the unit.
7
274
The table points out the position as
featured in the figure, the type and
function of the fuses on the rear area
distribution control unit.
Ref.
Type
Function
6
Maxi – 20A Sunroof
7
Maxi – 30A
Driver door
module
Ref.
Type
Function
8
Maxi – 30A
11
High Premium
Maxi – 40A stereo amplifier
unit
15
Maxi – 40A
Passenger door
module
HVAC front
blower relay coil
Maintenance and Care
Ref.
Type
Function
17
Maxi – 30A
Rear LH door
module
18
Maxi – 30A
Rear RH door
module
27
CB – 20A
LH rear seat
movement
31
CB – 25A
LH front seat
movement
33
CB – 20A
RH rear seat
movement
35
Mini – 20A
Rear doors
sunshade
37
Mini – 20A
Radio
38
CB – 25A
45
Mini – 10A
Internal mirror,
sunroof
46
Mini – 5A
Rear camera
61
Mini – 25A
Front console
power outlet and
cigar lighter
68
Mini – 20A
Rear sunshade
module
Ref.
Type
69
Mini – 25A
Rear console
power outlet and
cigar lighter
Mini – 10A
HVAC module,
AFLM headlights
module, Parking
Aid Module PAM
70
Function
Bulb Replacement
The signal failure of an external light
(turn signal, low beam and high beam,
number plate light, reverse light and
brake light) is communicated to the
instrument cluster that displays on the
TFT screen in a graphical form and
with a text message which light is
faulty (see example in the figure).
RH front seat
movement
7
275
Maintenance and Care
Front Headlights
The light bulbs of the headlight
clusters are arranged as follows:
1
Bi-Xenon low-beam/high-beam
bulb.
2
Position/parking and DRL LED
lights. Except for Canadian
vehicles (always enabled) the
DRL lights can be deactivated
through the Multi Media System
(see “MTC Settings” in section 4).
3
Turn signal LED.
4
Side-marker light bulb.
5
Side reflex-reflector.
7
CAUTION!
Due to the complexity of the
operation, for the replacement of the
276
headlight clusters light bulbs, we
recommend that you contact an
Authorized Maserati Dealer. If you are
personally carrying out this operation,
make sure that the corresponding fuse
is intact before replacing the bulb. Use
only genuine new light bulbs with the
same characteristics as the old one.
Tail-Light Clusters Light Bulbs
The taillight bulbs are arranged as
follows:
1
Position/parking light guide LED.
2
Stop light LED.
3
Side-marker LED.
4
Turn signal LED.
5
Reverse LED.
6
Reflectors.
7
Rear fog LED.
Light Clusters Bulbs
Replacement
WARNING!
The headlamps are a type of high
voltage discharge tube. High voltage
can remain in the circuit even with the
headlamp switch and the ignition
switch off. Because of this, you should
not attempt to replace a headlamp
bulb yourself, but take the vehicle to
an Authorized Maserati Dealer for
service.
All lamps of the rear and some of front
the headlights and those integrated in
the exterior mirrors are LED powered
and cannot be replaced individually.
Contact the Authorized Maserati
Dealer to locate the correct parts and
replace them.
Maintenance and Care
License Plate Lights
To replace the license plate light bulb
(C 5W):
• use a screwdriver positioned at the
indicated point to lever out the light
fixing frame;
Interior Lights
• rotate the bulb holder and take it
out;
CAUTION!
Before replacing a bulb, ensure that
the matching fuse is intact. For
replacement, use only original new
light bulbs having the same rating as
the old one.
Lamps inside the glove box
compartments of the dashboard are
LED powered and cannot be replaced
by the owner. Contact the Authorized
Maserati Dealer to replace them.
• replace the pressure-fitted bulb;
Courtesy Lights (below Door)
• replace the pressure-fitted bulb;
• refit the bulb holder inserting first
the electrical connector side and
then pressing on the other side to
hook up the clip.
To replace the bulb (W5W):
• use a screwdriver positioned at the
indicated point to lever out the light
fixing frame;
• refit the bulb holder inserting first
the electrical connector side and
then pressing on the other side to
hook up the clip.
7
277
Maintenance and Care
Trunk Light
To replace the bulbs (W5W) inside the
trunk, proceed as follows after trunk
lid opening.
• Remove the light fixing frame by
levering it out gently at the indicated
point with a screwdriver.
• Raise the lens cover.
7
• Replace the pressure-fitted bulb.
278
• Refit the lens cover, inserting first the
electrical connector side and then
pressing on the other side.
A/C System Maintenance
For best performances, the air
conditioning system should be checked
and serviced by the Authorized
Maserati Dealer at the beginning of
the warm season.
This service should include cleaning of
the condenser fins and a performance
test. Drive belt tension should also be
checked at this time.
During the winter, the air conditioning
system should be operated at least
once a month for about 10 minutes.
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your air
conditioning system as the chemicals
can damage your air conditioning
components. Such damage is not
covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Maintenance and Care
Wheels Maintenance
WARNING!
• Use only refrigerants and
compressor lubricants approved by
the manufacturer for your air
conditioning system. Some
unapproved refrigerants are
flammable and can explode, causing
injuries. Other unapproved
refrigerants or lubricants can cause
the system to fail, requiring costly
repairs.
• The air conditioning system contains
refrigerant under high pressure. To
avoid risk of personal injury or
damage to the system, adding
refrigerant or any repair requiring
lines to be disconnected should be
done by an experienced technician.
internal damage, which may even lead
to the tire destruction.
Tires Maintenance
CAUTION!
To obtain the best performances and
the longest mileage from the tires,
take the following precautions during
the first 310 mi (500 km):
• do not drive at the vehicle’s
maximum speed;
• drive at low speed on curves;
• avoid sudden steering;
• avoid sudden braking;
• avoid sudden acceleration;
• do not drive at high speeds for too
long.
The tires inflation pressure must
correspond to the prescribed values
(see the chapter “Tire Inflation
Pressure” in section 8) and should be
checked only when the tires have
cooled down. In fact, the pressure
increases as the tire temperature
progressively increases.
Never reduce the pressure if tires are
hot (see “Tires – General information”
chapter in section 5).
Insufficient tire inflating pressure can
cause tire overheating and possible
CAUTION!
After inspecting or adjusting the tire
pressure, always reinstall the valve
stem cap. This will prevent moisture
and dirt from entering the valve stem,
which could damage it.
Impacts with curbs, holes, and
obstacles in the road, and prolonged
trips on rough roads can cause tire
damage which may not be visible to
the naked eye.
Check your tires regularly for any signs
of damage (e.g. scratches, cuts, cracks,
bulges, etc.). If sharp objects penetrate
the tires, they can cause structural
damage which is only visible when the
tire is removed.
In any case, any possible damage must
be inspected by an experienced tire
fitter, as it may seriously reduce the
tire life.
Remember that tires deteriorate with
time, even if used little or not at all.
Cracks in the tire tread and sides,
alongside possible bulging, are a sign
of deterioration.
7
279
Maintenance and Care
WARNING!
Driving over rough or damaged road
surfaces, as well as debris, curbs and
other obstacles can cause serious
damage to wheels, tires, and
suspension parts. This is more likely to
occur with low-profile tires, which
provide less cushioning between the
wheel and the road. Be careful to
avoid road hazards and reduce your
speed, especially if your vehicle is
equipped with low-profile tires.
WARNING!
• Check the inflating pressure of the
tires when cold, at least every two
weeks and before long trips.
7
• Have the old tires inspected by an
experienced tire fitter, to make sure
they can still be used safely. If the
same tire has been on your vehicle
for 4 or 5 years, have it inspected
anyway by an experienced tire fitter.
• Never fit tires of uncertain origin.
• “Directional” tires have an arrow on
their side showing the rolling
direction. To keep the best
performance when replacing a tire,
280
make sure that the rolling direction
corresponds to the one shown by
the arrow.
• During the tire life, the rolling
direction used for the first fitting
shall always be observed, also in
case of “nondirectional” tires.
• Check the depth of the tire tread at
regular intervals. The minimum
allowed value is 0.06 in (1.6 mm) at
that point the wear indicators on the
tire will be visible (see “Tires –
general information” in section 5).
The thinner is the tread, the greater
is the risk of skidding.
• Drive carefully on wet roads to
decrease the risk of aquaplaning.
Winter Tires
These tires are specially designed for
driving on snow and ice and are fitted
to replace the ones supplied with the
vehicle.
The winter features of these tires are
significantly reduced when tread
depth is less than 0.16 in (4 mm). In
this case, they should be replaced.
The specific features of the winter tires
lead to lower performance under
normal environmental conditions or
on long highway trips, compared to
the standard tires.
Therefore, their use should be limited
to the situations and performance for
which they have been type-approved.
The Authorized Maserati Dealer can
provide all necessary information
about fitting winter tires on the
vehicle.
Wheel Trims Maintenance
All wheel trims should be cleaned
regularly with a mild soap and water.
To remove heavy soil and/or excessive
brake dust, use a nonabrasive,
non-acidic cleaner.
Do not use scouring pads, steel wool, a
bristle brush, or metal polishes.
Do not use oven cleaner that may
involve and damage the brake calipers.
Avoid automatic car washes that use
acidic solutions or harsh brushes that
may damage the wheel trim protective
finish.
Maintenance and Care
Bodywork Maintenance
and Care
Protection from Atmospheric
Agents
The main causes of corrosion are:
• atmospheric pollution;
• salinity and humidity in the
atmosphere (marine areas or a damp
climate);
• seasonal environmental conditions;
• salt scattered on the roadbed to
melt ice and snow.
The abrasive action of wind-carried
atmospheric dust and sand, mud and
stones should not be underestimated.
On this vehicle, Maserati has adopted
the best technological solutions to
protect the bodywork from corrosion.
The main measures are:
• paint products and systems that give
the vehicle particular resistance to
corrosion and abrasion;
• use of galvanized (or pre-treated)
metal sheets which are highly
resistant to corrosion in the most
exposed parts;
• spraying of the underbody, engine
compartment, insides of wheel
housings, and other structures with
wax products having high protective
power;
• spraying of plastic materials, with a
protective function, in the most
exposed points: underneath the
doors, inside part of the mud guards,
edges, etc.;
• use of ventilated box sections,
coated with protective wax products,
to avoid condensation and trapped
water which could encourage the
formation of internal rust.
Useful Advice to Keep the
Bodywork in Good Condition
Paint
The paintwork does not only have an
aesthetic function but also protects
the underlying metal sheets. In the
event of abrasions or deep scratches,
we recommend to have the necessary
touch-ups made immediately, to avoid
any rust formation. Touch-ups do not
feature particular difficulties, even on
metallic finishes.
For all paint touch-ups, use only
original products indicated on the
plate applied on the trunk lid.
Normal paint maintenance consists in
washing, the frequency of which
depends on the conditions of use and
of the environment. For example, if
driving the vehicle in areas where
there is high atmospheric pollution or
the roads are spread with anti-freeze
salt, it is advisable to wash the vehicle
more frequently.
ENVIRONMENTAL!
Detergents pollute water. Therefore
the vehicle should be washed in areas
equipped for the collection and
purification of the fluids used for
washing.
7
281
Maintenance and Care
NOTE:
The use of alcohol-based products for
cleaning the metal plates in the engine
compartment and/or the trunk may
deteriorate the painted surface. It is
recommended to use water-based
products and neutral surfactants.
Car Wash
For correct washing:
7
282
• wet the bodywork with a low
pressure water jet;
• pass a sponge with a light detergent
solution over the bodywork,
frequently rinsing the sponge;
• rinse well with water and dry with an
air jet or chamois leather.
When drying, take particular care with
the parts that are less visible, such as
the door and lid bays, headlight edges,
in which water can be trapped more
easily.
You are recommended not to take the
vehicle immediately into an enclosed
environment, but leave it in the open
air so as to allow the water to
evaporate.
Do not wash the vehicle after it has
been left in the sun or when the
engine lid is hot: the paint gloss could
be affected.
External plastic parts must be cleaned
with the same procedure followed for
the normal washing of the vehicle.
Avoid, as far as possible, parking the
vehicle under trees; the resinous
substances that very often drop from
the trees give the paint a dull
appearance and increase the possibility
of originating corrosive processes.
It is important that the drain holes in
the lower sides of the doors, rocker
panels, and trunk bottom be kept clear
and open.
CAUTION!
• Bird droppings must be washed off
immediately and thoroughly, since
their acidity is particularly corrosive.
• To provide better protection for the
paint, polish the vehicle at intervals
with a suitable product leaving a
protective film on the paint.
• If the vehicle is washed using
high-pressure water jets or cleaners,
it is important that the nozzle of the
jet be kept at a distance of at least
16 in (40 cm) from the bodywork to
avoid damaging it.
NOTE:
If you wish to keep the RKE
Transmitter with you or anywhere
outside the vehicle while the car is
being washed, it is advisable to disable
the Passive Entry from the MTC system,
for further information refer to
chapter “MTC settings” in section 4.
Pre-Short Drop Function
When in a car washing, if the driver
keeps the RKE Transmitter in his/her
pocket, or in any place outside the
vehicle within 5 ft (1.5 m) distance, the
front windows will perform a pre-short
drop.
This is a shorter drop compared to the
normal Short Drop performed by the
Passive Entry function when you grab
the door handle to enter the vehicle.
This prevents water to enter the
vehicle between the upper edge of the
glass window and the door trim.
NOTE:
When deactivating the Passive Entry,
also the Pre-Short Drop function will
be disabled.
Maintenance and Care
Glass Surfaces
All glass surfaces should be cleaned on
a regular basis with any commercial
household-type glass cleaner.
Never use an abrasive type cleaner.
Use caution when cleaning the inside
rear window equipped with electric
defrosters. Do not use scrapers or
other sharp instrument that may
scratch the elements.
When cleaning the rear view mirror,
spray cleaner on the towel or rag that
you are using. Do not spray cleaner
directly on the mirror.
Labels can be peeled off after soaking
with warm water.
Keep all objects a safe distance from
the window.
Cleaning Headlights
Your vehicle has plastic headlights that
are lighter and less susceptible to
stone breakage than glass headlights.
Plastic is not as scratch resistant as
glass and therefore different lens
cleaning procedures must be followed.
To minimize the possibility of
scratching the lenses and reducing
light output, avoid wiping with a dry
cloth. To remove road dirt, wash with
a mild soap solution followed by
rinsing.
Do not use abrasive cleaning
components, solvents, steel wool or
other aggressive material to clean the
lenses.
Engine Compartment
At the end of each winter season,
carefully wash the engine
compartment, remembering to avoid
directing the jet of water for too long
on the electric parts.
To perform this operation, you must
contact the Authorized Maserati
Dealer.
Interior Maintenance and
Care
Interior trim should be cleaned
starting with a damp cloth. Do not use
harsh cleaners.
The leather upholstery can be best
preserved by regular cleaning with a
damp soft cloth. Small particles of dirt
can act as an abrasive and damage the
leather upholstery and should be
removed promptly with a damp cloth.
Stubborn soils stains can be removed
easily with a soft cloth and
appropriate products. Avoid soaking
the leather upholstery with any liquid.
Please do not use polishes, oils,
cleaning fluids, solvents, detergents,
or ammonia-based cleaners to clean
your leather upholstery.
Application of a leather conditioner is
not required to maintain the original
condition.
Check at regular intervals that there is
no water trapped under the mats (due
to drips off shoes, umbrellas etc.)
which may cause the metal parts to
oxidize.
7
283
Maintenance and Care
CAUTION!
Do not use alcohol, gasoline or
solvents to clean the instrument
panel's transparent dome, the MTC
display and the leather upholstery.
Leather Upholstery Treatment
Have the leather upholstery only
treated, as provided in the Scheduled
Service Plan, by the Authorized
Maserati Dealer which has the
required specific products.
Parts in Premium Quality Wood
Remove any dirt with a buckskin
leather or damp cloth.
NOTE:
7
284
The Authorized Maserati Dealer can
provide you with any information
about the Maserati approved “Car
Care” products, available in the
Genuine Accessories range.
Vehicle Stored for Long
Periods
If the vehicle is going to be stored for
over a month, follow the below
precautions:
• Wash and dry the vehicle thoroughly.
• Store the vehicle in a covered, dry
and, if possible, ventilated area.
• Select P (Park) and turn off the
engine.
• Disconnect the battery (refer to
“Maintenance-Free Battery” in this
section) or connect a battery charger
(refer to paragraph “Maintaining
Battery Charge” in this section).
• Check the battery charge status.
During garaging, this check must be
carried out every three weeks.
Recharge the battery if the no-load
voltage is less than 12.5 V.
• Check that the parking brake is NOT
engaged.
• Do not empty the engine cooling
system.
• Clean and protect the painted parts
applying protective wax.
• Clean and protect polished metal
parts with special products available
on the market.
• Talc the windshield wiper blades and
raise them from the windshield.
• Cover the vehicle with a long cloth in
breathable fabric (available from the
Authorized Maserati Dealer). Do not
use thick plastic sheets, which do not
allow the humidity on the vehicle
surface to evaporate.
• Inflate the tires up to a pressure
which must be 14.5 PSI (1 bar) higher
than the normally prescribed one,
and check it at regular intervals.
NOTE:
The Authorized Maserati Dealer can
provide you with any information
about the available “Indoor and
Outdoor Car Covers”, available in the
Genuine Accessories range.
WARNING!
The tire pressure must be brought
back to the prescribed value before
reusing the vehicle (see “Tire Inflation
Pressure” in section 8).
Maintenance and Care
Battery Statement
Battery State of Charge
To avoid problems with ignition
and/or the electrical system in general
when you are driving, the battery
charge status is constantly maintained
and guaranteed by the vehicle's
recharge circuit; the main component
of which is the alternator. This circuit
is only able to supply voltage to the
battery when the vehicle is traveling.
The warning light
on the
instrument cluster, will indicate any
malfunctions in the recharge circuit or
an insufficient battery charge status
(shown in figure).
The amount of voltage that is supplied
to the battery to maintain the charge
status also depends on the amount of
charge absorbed by the systems used
in the vehicle, for example: the air
conditioning system, the lights,
windshield wipers, the audio system
etc. In addition to this, even the traffic
conditions you are driving in can
influence the amount of charge
produced: if, for example, you are
traveling on the highway, the
alternator supplies more voltage to
the battery, whilst in heavy traffic,
where the vehicle is continually
stopping and starting, the alternator
provides less charge. This also applies
for the amount of electrical charge
stored in the battery to power other
electrical devices whilst the vehicle is
traveling.
The vehicle is fitted with advanced
electronic systems, such as, for
example, the alarm system and various
electronic control modules, which
consume power even when the
ignition switch is in the OFF position
and the vehicle is not being used.
Therefore, it is fundamental that the
battery is properly charged to ensure
that the engine starts properly and
that all the electrical/electronic
systems in the vehicle work efficiently.
Maintaining Battery Charge
When the vehicle is not going to be
used for one week or more, or if you
travel approximately 10 miles / 16 km
per day and/or 4,000 miles / 6,000 km
per year, Maserati recommends
connecting the battery to a battery
charger, to save you the trouble of
having to recharge the battery. The
battery charger will keep the battery
charged properly and at the correct
voltage levels required by the systems
and devices in the car.
Before using the battery charger,
carefully follow the instructions
provided. To connect the device to the
battery, see “Battery Recharge” in
“Maintenance-Free Battery” of this
section.
If you do not use a battery charger to
prevent the battery from going dead
when you are not going to use the
vehicle for long periods of time, you
need to check and recharge the
battery at least once every three
weeks (or if you travel approximately
10 miles / 16 km per day and/or 4,000
miles / 6,000 km per year). Please note
that allowing the battery to go dead
repeatedly can cause premature wear
on the internal cells and greatly
reduce their life, leading to problems
7
285
Maintenance and Care
with the ignition system and other
electrical/electronic systems.
The Authorized Maserati Dealer is
available to advise you on how to
recharge you battery correctly and
give you useful information on battery
care and maintenance.
NOTE:
The Authorized Maserati Dealer can
provide you with any information
about the Maserati approved “Battery
Charger and Conditioner”, available in
the Genuine Accessories range.
WARNING!
The process of charging or recharging
the battery produces hydrogen, a
dangerous gas that can explode and
cause serious injuries. When charging
or recharging the battery, follow the
recommended precautions at all times:
7
• always charge or recharge the
battery in a well-ventilated
environment;
• never charge or recharge a battery
that has frozen: it can explode due
to hydrogen trapped inside the ice
crystals;
286
• ensure that any sparks or open
flames are kept well away from the
battery while it is charging;
• before using a charger to charge or
maintain the battery charge status,
carefully follow the instructions
provided to ensure the charger is
connected to the battery safely and
correctly.
Restarting the Vehicle
Before restarting the vehicle after a
long period of inactivity, we
recommend that you carry out the
following operations.
• Check the tires for pressure and for
any damages, cuts or cracks. If this is
the case, have them replaced.
• Do not dry-rub the external surface
of the vehicle.
• Visually inspect if there are any fluid
leaks (oil, brake and clutch fluid,
engine coolant etc.).
• Have the engine oil and filter
replaced.
• Check the fluid levels in the brake
system, as well as the engine coolant
level.
• Check the air filter and have them
replaced if necessary.
• Reconnect the battery after checking
the charge status (refer to
“Maintenance-Free Battery” in this
section) and perform the initializing
procedure if applicable. You can
consult the paragraph “Battery
Reconnection” in this chapter for
further information on this subject.
• With the transmission in N (Neutral),
let the engine idle for several
minutes.
WARNING!
The engine idle must be performed
outdoors. Exhaust gases contain
carbon monoxide which is strongly
toxic and potentially lethal.
Maintenance and Care
Battery Reconnection
• Connect the battery (refer
“Maintenance-Free Battery” in this
section).
• Unlock and lock the doors using the
key fob.
• Initialize the climate control system
by activating the system and
pressing the AUTO control as
described in chapter "Air
Conditioning Controls" in section 4.
• Turn on the MTC and set the date
and time following the instructions
given in the dedicated manual.
CAUTION!
• Every time the battery is
reconnected, wait at least 30 seconds
with the ignition switch turned to
RUN before starting the engine, in
order to allow the electronic system
that manages the motor-driven
throttles to run a self-learning cycle.
At the same time, you can run the
date and time set up procedure for
the MTC.
• Every time the battery is
reconnected the warning lights
and
flash for about 10
seconds and then go off.
7
287
Maintenance and Care
288
8 – Features and Specifications
Refilling Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
Fuel Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
Technical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
Tire Inflation Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
289
Features and Specifications
Refilling Capacities
Capacities and Approved Fluids
NOTE:
Maserati reserves the right to change or revise specifications without prior notification.
Component
Fuel tank (including 4.2
Gallons/16 litres of
reserve)
Engine (V8 Engine)
Engine (V6 Engine)
Quantity
21 Gallons (80 litres)
9 Quarts /8.6 litres (max)
(Difference among MIN and MAX
level: 1.5 Quarts /1.4 litres)
8.8 Quarts /8.3 litres (max)
(Difference among MIN and MAX
level: 1.1 Quarts /1 litres)
Windshield and headlight
washer fluid reservoir
5.3 Quarts (5 litres)
8
290
Approved Product Specifications
Premium unleaded fuel with no less than 95 RON/85
MON (91 CLC or AKI).
Entirely synthetic multigrade lubricants SAE 5W/40
that meet API SL/CF and ACEA A3, B3, B4
specifications.
Recommended oil: Pennzoil Platinum Euro 5W-40.
Mix of water and detergent fluid, in the proportions
indicated on the product package. If the temperature
is below –4°F (–20°C), use pure detergent fluid.
Detergent fluid: Mix of CUNA NC 956-II surfactants
and alcohols.
Recommended fluid: Wuerth Windshield Washer
Fluid with antifreeze or Arexons DP1.
Features and Specifications
Component
Engine cooling circuit (V8
Engine)
Engine cooling circuit (V6
Engine)
Hydraulic power steering
(*) Automatic gearbox
(*) Differential
Quantity
15 Quarts (14.2 litres)
(for dual zone air conditioning
system)
9.7 Quarts (9.2 litres)
(for dual zone air conditioning
system)
8 Quarts (7.6 litres)
1.4 Quarts (1.3 litres)
(*) Front differential (V6
Engine)
0.47 Quarts (0.45 litres)
(*) Transfer case (V6
Engine)
0.65 Quarts (0.62 litres)
Braking system
-
Approved Product Specifications
Mixture of water and coolant, proportionally 50/50%.
Coolant: protective, antifreeze action and ethylene
glycol-based with organic inhibitors compatible with
regulations:
• ASTM D 3306, ASTM D 2570
• ASTM D 4340, ASTM D 2809
• SAE J 1034
• CUNA NC 956/16
• FGA 9.55523 or equivalent.
Recommended fluid: GlycoShell/GlycoShell Long
Life.
Recommended oil: SHELL Spirax S1 ATF TASA.
Recommended oil: SHELL ATF L- 12108.
Synthetic Axle Lubricant SAE 75W-90 – FE HYPOID
GEAR LUBRICANT.
Recommended oil: SHELL TF 0951.
Recommended oil: SHELL TF 0870.
Synthetic fluid: USA FMVSS n. 116 DOT 4, ISO 4925
Class 4, JIS K 2233 Class 5, AS/NZ 1960 Class 3, SAE
J1704, CUNA NC 956-01.
Recommended fluid: PETRONAS Tutela Brake Fluid
TOP4.
8
CAUTION!
For each oil refilling and/or replacement, please contact the Authorized Maserati Dealer.
291
Features and Specifications
Component
Air conditioning system
Quantity
dual zone: 26.1 oz +/-0.7 oz
(740 gr +/-20 gr)
four-zone: 31.4 oz +/-0.7 oz
(890 gr +/-20 gr)
Approved Product Specifications
Coolant: r134a.
(*) No scheduled maintenance expected.
CAUTION!
To guarantee vehicle’s integrity and
maintain performance level always use
genuine parts approved and
recommended by Maserati.
Engine Oil Identification
Symbol
Engine Oil Viscosity (SAE
Grade)
This symbol means that the oil
has been certified by the
American Petroleum Institute
(API). Maserati only
recommends API Certified engine oils.
SAE 5W-40 engine oil is recommended
for all operating temperatures.
The engine oil filler cap also shows the
recommended engine oil viscosity for
your engine. For information on
engine oil filler cap location, refer to
chapter “Maintenance Procedures” in
section 7.
Lubricants that do not have both the
engine oil certification mark and the
correct SAE viscosity grade number
should not be used.
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your
engine oil as the chemicals can
damage your engine. Damage caused
by use of non-approved chemicals is
not covered by the new Vehicle
Limited Warranty.
8
292
Features and Specifications
Fuel Consumption
The fuel consumption values shown
(miles per gallon) are established
using EPA test guidelines.
Quattroporte GTS (V8 Engine)
Quattroporte S Q4 (V6 Engine)
City
13 MPG
15 MPG
Highway
22 MPG
24 MPG
Combined
16 MPG
18 MPG
CAUTION!
The type of route, traffic and weather
conditions, driving style, general
condition of the vehicle,
equipment/accessories in the vehicle,
use of the air conditioning system,
vehicle load and other items or
situations which may negatively affect
the vehicle aerodynamics or wind
resistance lead to consumption ratios
differing from the indicated ones.
NOTE:
The specifications described above can
change without prior notification.
8
293
Features and Specifications
Technical data
Engine
Data
Quattroporte GTS (V8 Engine)
Quattroporte S Q4 (V6 Engine)
Cylinder number and position
8 - 90° V
6- 60° V
Number of valves per cylinder
4
4
Bore x stroke
86.5 x 80.8 mm
86.5 x 84.5 mm
Total displacement
3,799 cm3
2,979 cm3
Compression ratio
9.5 : 1
9.7 : 1
Maximum power output (EC)
390 kW – 523 HP
302 kW – 404 HP
- corresponding RPM
6,700 g/min
5,500 g/min
Peak torque (EC)
480 ft-lb (650 N-m)
406 ft-lb (550 N-m)
- corresponding RPM
2,000 – 4,000 RPM
4,500 – 5,000 RPM
(*) Overboost torque (EC)
524 ft-lb (710 N-m)
406 ft-lb (550 N-m)
- corresponding RPM
2,250 – 3,500 RPM
1,750 – 5,000 RPM
(*) Overboost function is available when Sport mode is selected and throttle, load and transmission parameters are
reached.
8
294
Features and Specifications
Properties
Timing
The timing system uses two overhead camshafts with timing variator.
Timing system control
Timing chain.
Supply
Over-supplied with turbocompressor and related intercooler for each bank.
Injection – Ignition
High pressure 2900 PSI (200 bar) direct fuel injection system. Static ignition with digital
electronic control system included and controlled by a single microprocessor ECU.
Transmission
Brakes
Suspension
ZF automatic transmission with 8
gears, torque converter, lock-up clutch
and anti-slip function.
Sequential and traditional control
type.
TRANSAXLE-type transmission.
Traction system equipped with rear
self-locking differential.
4-wheel ventilated disc brakes.
Front brake disc diameter: 15 in / 380
mm (V8 Engine), 14.2 in / 360 mm (V6
Engine).
Rear brake disc diameter: 13.8 in (350
mm).
The Electric Parking Brake (EPB) acts
on the rear wheels.
Double-wishbone independent front
suspension.
Multilink independent rear
suspension.
Skyhook adaptive damping with
electronically-controlled shock
absorbers.
Steering
Speed-sensitive hydraulic power
steering with cooling system.
Turning Circle = 38.7 ft (11.8 m)
No. of steering wheel turns = 1.37 (to
the left and right).
8
295
Features and Specifications
Wheels
NOTE:
• Maserati recommends Maserati Genuine Tires marked with “MGT” logo specifically designed for its models.
• In order to maintain high performance and safety level, Maserati recommends to use tires equivalent to the original size.
WARNING!
• The maximum speed reachable with the tires is indicated by the tire manufacturer. Always comply with the regulations
in force in the Country you are driving in.
• Never exceed the maximum speed indicated for the tires: failure to respect the max. speed may damage these tires.
Danger: risk of accident!
Allowed tires size with standard wheel rims
Quattroporte GTS (V8 Engine)
Quattroporte S Q4 (V6 Engine)
Light alloy rims
20” x 8,5J (front)
20” x 10,5J (rear)
19” x 8,5J (front)
19” x 10J (rear)
- Front tires
245/40 ZR 20 (99Y) XL
245/45 ZR 19 (98Y)
- Rear tires
285/35 ZR 20 (100Y)
275/40 ZR 19 (101Y)
- Front winter tires
245/40 ZR 20 99V XL M+S
245/45 ZR 19 98V M+S
- Rear winter tires
285/35 ZR 20 100V M+S
275/40 ZR 19 101V M+S
- Front all-season tires
—
245/45 ZR 19 98V M+S
- Rear all-season tires
Light alloy spare rim
8
296
- Spare tire
—
275/40 ZR 19 101V M+S
18” x 6J
18” x 6J
175/50 R 18
175/50 R 18
Features and Specifications
Allowed tires size with optional wheel rims
For all models
Light alloy rims
19” x 8,5J (front)
19” x 10J (rear)
- Front tires
245/45 ZR 19 (98Y)
- Rear tires
275/40 ZR 19 (101Y)
- Front winter tires
245/45 ZR 19 98V M+S
- Rear winter tires
Light alloy rims
275/40 ZR 19 101V M+S
20” x 8,5J (front)
20” x 10,5J (rear)
- Front tires
245/40 ZR 20 (99Y) XL
- Rear tires
285/35 ZR 20 (100Y)
- Front winter tires
245/40 ZR 20 99V XL M+S
- Rear winter tires
Light alloy rims
285/35 ZR 20 100V M+S
21” x 8,5J (front)
21” x 10,5J (rear)
- Front tires
245/35 ZR 21 (96Y) XL
- Rear tires
285/30 ZR 21 (100Y) XL
- Front winter tires
245/35 ZR 21 96W XL M+S
- Rear winter tires
285/30 ZR 21 100W XL M+S
8
297
Features and Specifications
Performance
Quattroporte GTS (V8 Engine)
Quattroporte S Q4 (V6 Engine)
Maximum speed
191 mph (307 km/h)
176 mph (283 km/h)
Accelerations from 0 to 100 km/h
4.7 seconds
4.9 seconds
Weights
Quattroporte GTS (V8 Engine)
Quattroporte S Q4 (V6 Engine)
Unladen vehicle weight (with tank and
reservoirs filled, tools and accessories)
4,495 lb (°)
4,607 lb (°)
Approved Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR)
5,595 lb
(2,643 lb front axle – 2,952 lb rear axle)
5,595 lb
(2,643 lb front axle – 2,952 lb rear axle)
(°) Base configuration without options.
Dimensions
8
298
Wheel base
124.8 in (3,171 mm)
Total length
207.2 in (5,262 mm)
Width without mirrors
76.7 in (1,948 mm)
Width with mirrors
82.6 in (2,100 mm)
Front track
64.3 in (1,634 mm)
Rear track
64.8 in (1,647 mm)
Front overhang
38.1 in (968 mm)
Rear overhang
44.2 in (1,123 mm)
Height
58.3 in (1,481 mm)
Trunk volume
18.7 cu. ft. (530 l)
Features and Specifications
Tire Inflation Pressure
Cold tire inflation pressure value under the following loading conditions listed in the table below:
• PLC (Partial Loading Condition): considering 2 passengers + luggage.
• FLC (Full Loading Condition): considering 4 or 5 passengers + luggage.
(°) Speed driving higher than
124 mph (200 km/h)
Load
PLC
FLC
PLC - FLC
Wheel (°°)
Front and rear
Front and rear
Front and rear
Pressure
32 PSI (2.2 bar)
38 PSI (2.6 bar)
38 PSI (2.6 bar)
Spare tire pressure
51 PSI (3.5 bar)
(°) Not for winter and all-season tires.
(°°) All sizes.
NOTE:
• The pressure values indicated in the table are also reported on the driver-side door pillar information label.
• For more information about the pressure check methods, see “Tires – General Information” in section 5.
WARNING!
• Improperly inflated tires are dangerous and can cause collisions.
• Under-inflation increases tire flexing and can result in tire overheating and failure.
• Over-inflation reduces a tire's ability to cushion shock. Objects on the road and chuckholes can cause damage that
results in tire failure.
8
• Over-inflated or under-inflated tires can affect vehicle handling and can fail suddenly, resulting in loss of vehicle control.
• Unequal tire pressures can cause steering problems. You could lose control of your vehicle.
(Continued)
299
Features and Specifications
(Continued)
• Unequal tire pressures from one side of the vehicle to the other can cause the vehicle to drift to the right or left.
• Always drive with each tire inflated to the recommended cold tire inflation pressure.
• Driving over rough or damaged road surfaces, as well as debris, curbs and other obstacles can cause serious damage to
wheels, tires, and suspension parts. This is more likely to occur with low-profile tires, which provide less cushioning
between the wheel and the road. Be careful to avoid road hazards and reduce your speed, especially if your vehicle is
equipped with low-profile tires.
8
300
9 – Index
301
Index
9
302
Abbreviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
ABS (Anti Lock Brake System). . . . .203
Accessories
Aftermarket Parts and Accessories
Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
Accident, in the event of . . . . . . . .237
AFS (Advanced Frontlighting
System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Air bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Advanced Front Air Bag
Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Air Bag Deployment Result . . . . .65
Air Bag Deployment Sensors and
Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
Air Bag System Components. . . . .60
Air Bag System Maintenance . . . .65
Air Bag Warning Light. . . . . . . . .79
Front Air Bag Inflator Units . . . . .64
Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Supplemental Seat-mounted Side
Air Bags (SAB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Supplemental Side Air Bag
Inflatable Curtain (SABIC) . . . . . .62
Transport of persons with
disability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Air Conditioning System
(A/C System) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
A/C System Maintenance . . . . . .278
Air Conditioning Controls . . . . .172
Air Conditioning Distribution . . .131
Automatic Temperature Control
(ATC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
Dual-zone Controls . . . . . . . . . .173
Filter Replacement . . . . . . . . . .265
Four-Zone Climate Control . . . . .177
Four-zone Controls . . . . . . . . . .177
Alarm, Panic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
Alarm, Vehicle Security . . . . . . . . . .26
ALR (Automatic Locking Retractor). .57
Armrest, rear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92
Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Assistance, if you need . . . . . . . .11
ATC (Automatic Temperature
Control) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
Audio Controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
MTC Side Audio Controls . . . . . .160
Steering Wheel Audio Controls . .159
Audio System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . .186
Automatic Transmission Controls.187
Automatic Transmission Range . .189
Drive Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
Gear Shift Indicator Light . . . . . .196
I C E Mode excluding ESC . . . . . .197
Manual Release of Transmission .249
Transmission Malfunction. . . . . .197
Aux and USB Port . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
BAS (Brake Assist System) . . . . .
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Battery remote Posts Position .
Battery Statement. . . . . . . . .
Jump start Procedure. . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.204
.267
.247
.285
.246
Maintenance Free Battery . . . . .267
To disconnect the Battery . . . . . .268
To reconnect the Battery . . . . . .269
BeltAlert system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Bluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Bodywork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Bodywork Maintenance . . . . . . .281
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . .203
Brake and Stability Control
System (ESC). . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
Brake Assist System (BAS) . . . . . .204
Brake Fluid Level Check . . . . . . .261
Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
Manual Release of Parking
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243
Parking Brake. . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
Release after Battery
Disconnection. . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
Using the Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . .206
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Courtesy Lights (Below Door) . . .277
Front Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . .276
License Plate Lights . . . . . . . . . .277
Light Clusters Bulbs
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276
Tail-Light Clusters Light Bulbs . . .276
Trunk Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
CD / DVD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
CD / DVD Slot . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Child Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . .67
Index
Children too large for Booster
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Infants and Child Restraints . . . . .67
Installing Child Restraint Systems
using the Vehicle Seat Belt
equipped with ALR. . . . . . . . . . .69
Lower Anchors and Tether for
Children (LATCH) . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Older Children and Child
Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Tips on getting the most out
of your child restraint . . . . . . . . .69
Climate Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Clock, analog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
Central Console
Components/Features . . . . . . . . .83
Front Console Components . . . . .82
Instrument Panel on the Rear
Central Console . . . . . . . . . . . . .95
Power Outlet Inside the Central
Console. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
Electronic Speed Control
(Cruise Control) . . . . . . . . . . . .208
Cup Holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Front Seats Cup Holders . . . . . .116
Power Outlet Inside the Cup
Holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Rear Seats Cup Holders . . . . . . .117
Dashboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
Compartments . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82
Data, Technical . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Doors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Automatic Locking Doors . . . . . .39
Child Protection Door Lock
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Doors Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
Doors Manual Lock. . . . . . . . . . .38
Front Doors Components . . . . . .85
Lock/Unlock Door Flashlight . . . .32
Manual Door Lock from Outside .42
Power Doors Locking/Unlocking . .38
Rear Doors Components . . . . . . .85
Unlock Doors from the Driver
Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Unlock Doors from the Passenger
Side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Unlock Driver Door/All Doors with
Remote Key 1 Press . . . . . . . . . .32
Unlock Power Doors and Trunk Lid
with Key Fob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Unlock the Doors and Fuel Filler
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
“Drive Away Inhibit” strategy . . . .202
Driving Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . .229
Driving at Night . . . . . . . . . . . .230
Driving in Fog . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Driving in the Mountains. . . . . .231
Driving in the Rain . . . . . . . . . .230
Driving on Snow or Ice . . . . . . .231
Driving through Flooded
Sections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
Safe Driving. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
DRL (Daytime Running Light) . . . .104
EDR (Event Data Recorder) . . . . . . .66
Electronic Cruise Control. . . . . . . .208
Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
Emergency Fuel Filler Door
Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229
Emergency Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
First Aid Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
Hazard Warning Light/Flasher . .110
In the Event of an Accident . . . .237
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . .246
Tool Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
Towing a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . .249
Trunk Lid Emergency Release . . . .50
Engine
Engine Air Filter Replacement . .265
Engine Coolant Level Check . . . .260
Engine Lid. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
Engine Oil Level Check . . . . . . .263
Engine Overheating . . . . . . . . .238
Engine Start Failure . . . . . . . . .185
Engine Turn Off . . . . . . . . . . . .186
Normal Starting of the Engine . .184
Use of the Engine . . . . . . . . . . .206
Engine Lid
Open and Close the Engine Lid . .51
Trunk and Engine Lid Ajar
Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
Entertainment, Rear Seats. . . . . . .121
EPB (Electric Parking Brake). . . . . .198
9
303
Index
ESC (Electronic Stability Control). . .203
Filters
A/C System Air Filter
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Air Filter Replacement. .
Fuel
Carbon Monoxide Warning . . .
Emergency Fuel Filler Door
Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Emissions Inspection and
Maintenance Programs . . . . . .
Fuel Consumption . . . . . . . . . .
Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . .
Fuel System Warnings . . . . . . .
Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends . . .
Low Fuel Indicator . . . . . . . . .
Materials Added to Fuel. . . . . .
MMT in Gasoline. . . . . . . . . . .
Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . .
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fuses Replacement . . . . . . . . .
Integrated Power Module . . . .
Rear Power Distribution Center.
9
304
.265
.265
.227
.229
.256
.293
.225
.226
.226
.155
.226
.226
.225
.271
.271
.272
.274
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86
rear head restraints. . . . . . . . . . .92
HomeLink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Troubleshooting Tips . . . . . . . . .130
Using HomeLink . . . . . . . . . . . .130
HSA (Hill Start Assist) . . . . . . . . . .205
Illuminated Entry/ Exit . . . . . . . . . .28
Immobilizer (Sentry Key) . . . . . . . . .24
Infotainment System. . . . . . . . . . .157
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . .136
Interiors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Components between
the Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Interior Components . . . . . . . . . .82
Interior Maintenance and Care . .283
iPod connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Jump Start Procedure . . . . . . . . . .247
Key Fob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Key Fob Battery Replacement. . .
Preventing Inadvertent Locking
of key fob RKE Transmitter Inside
the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Requiring and setting Additional
Key Fobs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Unlock Power Doors and Trunk
Lid with Key Fob. . . . . . . . . . . .
Keyless Ignition Device . . . . . . . . .
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Sentry Key Immobilizer System . .
Level Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Brake Fluid Level Check . . . . . .
Coolant Transmission and
Hydraulic Steering System Fluid
Level Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Oil Level Check. . . . . . .
.23
.34
.41
.25
.33
.32
.22
.22
.24
.260
.261
.265
.260
Steering Fluid Level Check . . . . .264
Transmission Oil Check. . . . . . . .264
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Adaptive Bi-Xenon Headlights . .104
AFS Adaptive Headlights . . . . . .104
Automatic Headlights . . . . . . . .103
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . .275
Dimmer Controls. . . . . . . . . . . .109
Dome Lights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
DRL Daytime Running Lights . . .104
Entry/Exit Illumination . . . . . . . .107
Exterior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Fog Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Hazard Warning Light/Flashers . .110
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Headlights On With Wipers . . . .112
Headlight Time Delay . . . . . . . .103
High Beam and Flashing . . . . . .106
Integrated External Rear View
Mirror Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Interior Lights. . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Light Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
SmartBeam System . . . . . . . . . .104
Turn Signal. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Vehicle Headlights Switch
Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Loading the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . .122
Loading with Rear Seatbacks
Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
Vehicle Load Carrying Capacity . .122
Vehicle Loading . . . . . . . . . . . .122
Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
Index
A/C System Maintenance . . . . . .278
Air Bag System Maintenance . . . .65
Bodywork Maintenance . . . . . .281
Emissions Inspection and
Maintenance Programs . . . . . . .256
Interior Maintenance and Care. .283
Maintenance Procedures . . . . . .257
Periodic Maintenance . . . . . . . .255
Scheduled Maintenance Service .252
Scheduled Service Plan . . . . . . .253
Sunroof Maintenance . . . . . . . .126
Wheels Maintenance . . . . . . . .279
Maserati Roadside Assistance
Program. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
Messages (TFT Display) . . . . . . . . .142
MIL (Malfunction Indicator Light). .138
Mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
External Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Integrated External Rear View
Mirror Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Internal Rear View Mirror . . . . .100
Mirrors Positioning. . . . . . . . . . .99
Rear View Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . .99
Tilt Mirrors in Reverse . . . . . . . .100
MTC System (Maserati Touch
Control) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
Audio System. . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Auto-On Comfort and Remote
Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .158
Customer Programmable
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Doors and Locks . . . . . . . . . . .
Engine Off. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
MTC Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . .
MTC Side Audio Controls . . . . .
Phone/Bluetooth . . . . . . . . . .
Radio Operation. . . . . . . . . . .
Remote Audio Controls . . . . . .
Safety and Driving Assistance . .
Sirius XM Setup . . . . . . . . . . .
Steering Wheel Audio Controls
Tools and Hard Controls . . . . .
Touch Screen Keys . . . . . . . . .
.163
.164
.167
.168
.166
.162
.160
.169
.160
.159
.165
.170
.159
.158
.159
On Board Diagnostic System . . . . .207
On Board Diagnostic System —
OBD II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
ORC (Occupant Restraint
Controller) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63
Panic Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28
Park Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Enabling and Disabling . . . . . . . .75
Park Assist Sensors . . . . . . . . . . .72
Servicing Park Assist System . . . . .75
Warning Messages Display. . . . . .73
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201
Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
Deactivating Automatic
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200
Failure Indication . . . . . . . . . . .201
Manual Engagement/
Disengagement . . . . . . . . . . . .199
Manual Release of Parking
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243
Release after Battery
Disconnection . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
ParkSense. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Park Assist. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
ParkView (Camera) . . . . . . . . . . . .76
ParkView Rear Back Up Camera . . . .76
Passive Entry System . . . . . . . . . . .40
Pets, transporting . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Phone and Voice Controls on
Steering Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . .180
Phone Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . .180
Voice Commands . . . . . . . . . . .181
Phone/Bluetooth . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Electric Power Outlet . . . . . . . .114
Power Outlet Inside the Central
Console. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
Power Outlet Inside the Cup
Holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Power Outlet inside the Trunk . .115
Refillings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290
Refilling Capacities . . . . . . . . . .290
Remote Audio Controls . . . . . . . .159
Remote Start System . . . . . . . . . . .36
Restraint System . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
Child Restraint Systems . . . . . . . .67
9
305
Index
Occupant Restraint System. . . . .
RKE (Remote Keyless Entry)
Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Pairing Remote Keyless Entry
Transmitter to Seats Memory . . .
Radio Frequency RKE Transmitter
Roadside Assistance Program. . . . .
9
306
.52
.22
.90
.35
.16
Safety. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Child Restraint Systems . . . . . . . .67
NHTSA Toll-free Auto Safety
Hotline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12
Occupant Restraint System. . . . . .52
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . .12
Scheduled Maintenance Service . . .252
Scheduled Service Plan . . . . . . . . .253
SD Memory Card and CD/DVD . . . .170
Seat Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
Automatic Locking Retractor
(ALR) Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
Enhanced Seat Belt Use Reminder
System (BeltAlert) . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Passenger Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . .57
Seat Belts and Pregnant Women . .59
Seat Belts Pretensioners. . . . . . . .58
Three-Point Seat Belts . . . . . . . . .54
Three-Point Seat Belts Height
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Three-Point Seat Belts Untwisting
Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
Three-Point Seat Belts Use
Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
Using the Seat Belt in Automatic
Locking Retractor (ALR) Mode . . .57
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86
Comfort Luxury Rear Seats . . . . . .94
Components between the Rear
Seats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Driver Memory Seat . . . . . . . . . .89
Easy Entry/Exit Seats . . . . . . . . . .91
Front Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . .88
Front Power Seats. . . . . . . . . . . .86
Front Seats Cup Holders . . . . . . .116
Front Ventilated Seats . . . . . . . . .89
Memory Profiles Setting . . . . . . .90
Pairing Remote Keyless Entry
Transmitter to Seats Memory . . . .90
Power Lumbar Seats . . . . . . . . . .87
Rear Armrest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92
Rear Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . .92
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Rear Seats Cup Holders . . . . . . .117
Rear Seats Entertainment. . . . . .121
Rear Side Heated Seats . . . . . . . .93
Seat Adjustment. . . . . . . . . . . . .86
Seat Setting Devices . . . . . . . . . .94
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
SmartBeam system . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Smoking Kit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Snow Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219
Spare parts service . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
Genuine parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
Scheduled maintenance. . . . . . . .13
SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184
Engine Start Failure. . . . . . . . . .185
Normal Starting of the Engine . .184
Steering Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Steering Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Heated Steering Wheel . . . . . . . .97
Phone and Voice Controls on
Steering Wheel. . . . . . . . . . . . .180
Power Tilt/Telescoping Steering
Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Stored, Vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
Stuck Vehicle, freeing . . . . . . . . . .245
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
Closing Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . .125
Pinch Protect Feature . . . . . . . .125
Power Sunroof with Sunshade . .124
Slide Opening Sunroof. . . . . . . .125
Sunroof Maintenance . . . . . . . .126
Venting Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . .125
Sunshades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Power Sunshades . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Power Sunshades on Rear
Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Power Sunshades on the Rear
Doors Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
Danger symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
Symbols of prohibitions and
compulsory measures . . . . . . . . .14
TCS (Traction Control System). . . . .204
Technical Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
Index
Tell tales
Tell tales on Rev Counter . . . . .
TFT Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Main and Submenu . . . . . . . .
Messages on Main Display Area
TFT (Thin Film Transistor) . . . . . .
Tires
Change a Tire. . . . . . . . . . . . .
Compact spare tire . . . . . . . . .
Department of Transportation
Uniform Tire Quality Grades. . .
General Information . . . . . . . .
Inflation Pressure . . . . . . . . . .
Punctured Tire . . . . . . . . . . . .
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Snow Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire Pressure Checkup . . . . . . .
Tire Pressure Low Warning. . . .
TPMS Tire Pressure Monitoring
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . .
Winter Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tool Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Towing the Vehicle . . . . . . . . .
Vehicle Towing Conditions. . . .
TPMS System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire Pressure Low Warning. . . .
TPMS Deactivation . . . . . . . . .
Transmission Manual Release
of P (Park) Position. . . . . . . . . .
.140
.142
.143
.151
.142
.239
.219
.215
.211
.299
.239
.217
.219
.216
.216
.222
.220
.217
.218
.236
.249
.249
.249
.220
.222
.224
.245
Transmitter, RKE
Preventing Inadvertent Locking of
key fob RKE Transmitter Inside the
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Radio Frequency RKE Transmitter .35
Trunk
To enter the Trunk . . . . . . . . . . .42
To unlatch the Trunk. . . . . . . . . .33
Trunk Compartment Operation . .49
Trunk Lid Emergency Release from
inside the Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
Trunk Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
Trunk Lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Trunk and Engine Lid Ajar
Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
Trunk Lid Emergency Release from
inside the Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . .50
Updating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) .18
Labels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
Voice Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . .181
Warning icons. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Warning Lights
Air Bag Warning Light . . . . . . . .79
TFT Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Warning Lights on Analog
Instrument . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Warnings when driving . . . . . . . . .15
Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9
Warranty Information. . . . . . . . .11
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
Wheels Maintenance . . . . . . . .279
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Auto-Down Feature . . . . . . . . . .44
Auto-Up Feature with Anti-Pinch
Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Power Windows. . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Rear Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Reset Auto-Up/Down . . . . . . . . .45
Window and Sunshade Lockout
Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Windshield Wipers and Washers . .111
Adding Washer, Headlight
Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Headlight On with Wipers . . . . .112
Rain Sensing Wipers . . . . . . . . .112
Windshield and Headlight
Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Windshield and Wiper
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . .111
Wipers Blades Maintenance . . . .112
9
307
Maserati S.p.A. & Maserati North America, Inc. reserve the right to make changes and/or modifications to the
content and all technical information and specifications without prior notification.
Therefore, the user is not entitled to any claims based on the contents (texts, data, illustrations, explanations and
regulations) in this manual, which are based on the data known at the time of going to print.
© 2014. Maserati S.p.A. All rights reserved.
Publication 910040458 - 1st Edition - 10/2014
This document may not be reproduced, printed or translated, even partially, without the written consent of MASERATI S.p.A.
WWW.MASERATI .COM
M A S E R AT I S PA · V I A L E C I R O M E N O T T I , 3 2 2 · I - 4 1 1 2 1 M O D E N A